MICROCHIP DSPIC30F4013-30I

dsPIC30F3014/4013
Data Sheet
High-Performance, 16-Bit
Digital Signal Controllers
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
•
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR
WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR
OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION,
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR
FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability
arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip
devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at
the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims,
suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip
intellectual property rights.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron,
dsPIC, KEELOQ, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART,
PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC and SmartShunt are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A. and other countries.
AmpLab, FilterLab, Migratable Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB,
SEEVAL, SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions
Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, CodeGuard,
dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN,
ECONOMONITOR, FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB,
In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Linear Active
Thermistor, Mindi, MiWi, MPASM, MPLIB, MPLINK, PICkit,
PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal,
PowerInfo, PowerMate, PowerTool, REAL ICE, rfLAB,
rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total
Endurance, UNI/O, WiperLock and ZENA are trademarks of
Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other
countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
© 2007, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the
U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
Printed on recycled paper.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 certification for its worldwide
headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and
Tempe, Arizona, Gresham, Oregon and Mountain View, California. The
Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC®
MCUs and dsPIC DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial
EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog
products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and
manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
DS70138E-page ii
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
dsPIC30F3014/4013 High-Performance, 16-Bit
Digital Signal Controllers
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
High-Performance Modified RISC CPU:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Modified Harvard architecture
C compiler optimized instruction set architecture
Flexible addressing modes
83 base instructions
24-bit wide instructions, 16-bit wide data path
Up to 48 Kbytes on-chip Flash program space
2 Kbytes of on-chip data RAM
1 Kbyte of nonvolatile data EEPROM
16 x 16-bit working register array
Up to 30 MIPS operation:
- DC to 40 MHz external clock input
- 4 MHz-10 MHz oscillator input with
PLL active (4x, 8x, 16x)
• Up to 33 interrupt sources:
- 8 user selectable priority levels
- 3 external interrupt sources
- 4 processor traps
DSP Features:
• Dual data fetch
• Modulo and Bit-Reversed modes
• Two 40-bit wide accumulators with optional
saturation logic
• 17-bit x 17-bit single-cycle hardware
fractional/integer multiplier
• All DSP instructions are single cycle
- Multiply-Accumulate (MAC) operation
• Single-cycle ±16 shift
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Peripheral Features:
• High-current sink/source I/O pins: 25 mA/25 mA
• Up to five 16-bit timers/counters; optionally pair
up
16-bit timers into 32-bit timer modules
• Up to four 16-bit Capture input functions
• Up to four 16-bit Compare/PWM output functions
• Data Converter Interface (DCI) supports common
audio Codec protocols, including I2S and AC’97
• 3-wire SPI module (supports 4 Frame modes)
• I2C™ module supports Multi-Master/Slave mode
and 7-bit/10-bit addressing
• Up to two addressable UART modules with FIFO
buffers
• CAN bus module compliant with CAN 2.0B
standard
Analog Features:
• 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) with:
- 200 ksps conversion rate
- Up to 13 input channels
- Conversion available during Sleep and Idle
• Programmable Low-Voltage Detection (PLVD)
• Programmable Brown-out Reset
Special Microcontroller Features:
• Enhanced Flash program memory:
- 10,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 100K (typical)
• Data EEPROM memory:
- 100,000 erase/write cycle (min.) for
industrial temperature range, 1M (typical)
• Self-reprogrammable under software control
• Power-on Reset (POR), Power-up Timer (PWRT)
and Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• Flexible Watchdog Timer (WDT) with on-chip
low-power RC oscillator for reliable operation
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor operation:
- Detects clock failure and switches to on-chip
low-power RC oscillator
DS70138E-page 1
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Special Microcontroller Features (Cont.):
CMOS Technology:
• Programmable code protection
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
• Selectable Power Management modes:
- Sleep, Idle and Alternate Clock modes
•
•
•
•
Low-power, high-speed Flash technology
Wide operating voltage range (2.5V to 5.5V)
Industrial and Extended temperature ranges
Low-power consumption
dsPIC30F3014/4013 Controller Family
Program Memory
48K
8K
16K
2048
2048
1024
3
1024
2
5
4
CAN
dsPIC30F4013 40/44
24K
SPI
dsPIC30F3014 40/44
I2C™
Output
SRAM EEPROM Timer Input
Codec A/D 12-bit
Comp/
Bytes
Bytes
16-bit
Cap
Interface 200 Ksps
Bytes Instructions
Std PWM
Pins
UART
Device
2
-
13 ch
2
1
1
0
4
AC’97, I2S
13 ch
2
1
1
1
Pin Diagrams
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
VDD
Vss
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
INT0/RA11
IC2/INT2/RD9
RD3
Vss
DS70138E-page 2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
dsPIC30F3014
40-Pin PDIP
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
AVDD
AVss
AN9/RB9
AN10/RB10
AN11/RB11
AN12/RB12
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
VDD
Vss
RF0
RF1
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/INT1/RD8
RD2
VDD
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/NT1/RD8
RD2
VDD
VSS
RD3
IC2/INT2/RD9
INT0/RA11
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
NC
44-Pin TQFP
dsPIC30F3014
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
NC
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VDD
AN8/RB8
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/CN7/RB5
AN4/CN6/RB4
NC
NC
AN10/RB10
AN9/RB9
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
RF1
RF0
VSS
VDD
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
AN12/RB12
AN11/RB11
Note:
For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 3
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/INT1/RD8
RD2
VDD
VSS
RD3
IC2/INT2/RD9
INT0/RA11
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
44-Pin QFN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
dsPIC30F3014
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
AN8/RB8
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/CN7/RB5
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN11/RB11
NC
AN10/RB10
AN9/RB9
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
RF1
RF0
VSS
VDD
VDD
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
AN12/RB12
Note:
For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
DS70138E-page 4
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
40-Pin PDIP
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
dsPIC30F4013
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/IC8/CN7/RB5
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
VDD
VSS
OSC1/CLKI
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
INT0/RA11
IC2/INT2/RD9
OC4/RD3
VSS
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
AVDD
AVSS
AN9/CSCK/RB9
AN10/CSDI/RB10
AN11/CSDO/RB11
AN12/COFS/RB12
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
VDD
VSS
C1RX/RF0
C1TX/RF1
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/INT1/RD8
OC3/RD2
VDD
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/INT1/RD8
OC3/RD2
VDD
VSS
OC4/RD3
IC2/INT2/RD9
INT0/RA11
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
NC
44-Pin TQFP
dsPIC30F4013
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
NC
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VDD
AN8/RB8
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN4/IC7/CN6/RB4
NC
NC
AN10/CSDI/RB10
AN9/CSCK/RB9
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
C1TX/RF1
C1RX/RF0
VSS
VDD
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
AN12/COFS/RB12
AN11/CSDO/RB11
Note:
For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 5
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
IC1/NT1/RD8
OC3/RD2
VDD
VSS
OC4/RD3
IC2/INT2/RD9
INT0/RA11
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/CN0/RC14
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/CN1/RC13
44-Pin QFN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
dsPIC30F4013
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
OSC1/CLKI
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
AN8/RB8
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
AN5/IC8/CN7/RB5
AN4/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN11/CSDO/RB11
NC
AN10/CSDI/RB10
AN9/CSCK/RB9
AVSS
AVDD
MCLR
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
U2TX/CN18/RF5
U2RX/CN17/RF4
C1TX/RF1
C1RX/RF0
VSS
VDD
VDD
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
AN12/COFS/RB12
For descriptions of individual pins, see Section 1.0 “Device Overview”.
DS70138E-page 6
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview ......................................................................................................................................................................... 9
2.0 CPU Architecture Overview ....................................................................................................................................................... 13
3.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................ 23
4.0 Address Generator Units ........................................................................................................................................................... 35
5.0 Flash Program Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 41
6.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................ 47
7.0 I/O Ports .................................................................................................................................................................................... 51
8.0 Interrupts ................................................................................................................................................................................... 55
9.0 Timer1 Module .......................................................................................................................................................................... 63
10.0 Timer2/3 Module ....................................................................................................................................................................... 67
11.0 Timer4/5 Module ...................................................................................................................................................................... 73
12.0 Input Capture Module ................................................................................................................................................................ 77
13.0 Output Compare Module ........................................................................................................................................................... 81
14.0 I2C™ Module ............................................................................................................................................................................ 85
15.0 SPI Module ................................................................................................................................................................................ 93
16.0 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) Module ............................................................................................... 97
17.0 CAN Module ............................................................................................................................................................................ 105
18.0 Data Converter Interface (DCI) Module ................................................................................................................................... 115
19.0 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ................................................................................................................... 125
20.0 System Integration .................................................................................................................................................................. 135
21.0 Instruction Set Summary ......................................................................................................................................................... 153
22.0 Development Support .............................................................................................................................................................. 161
23.0 Electrical Characteristics ......................................................................................................................................................... 165
24.0 Packaging Information ............................................................................................................................................................. 203
Index ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 209
The Microchip Web Site .................................................................................................................................................................... 215
Customer Change Notification Service ............................................................................................................................................. 215
Customer Support ............................................................................................................................................................................. 215
Reader Response ............................................................................................................................................................................. 216
Product Identification System ........................................................................................................................................................... 217
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
• Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
• Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 7
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 8
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
This document contains specific information for the
dsPIC30F3014/4013 Digital Signal Controller (DSC)
devices. The dsPIC30F3014/4013 devices contain
extensive Digital Signal Processor (DSP) functionality
within a high-performance 16-bit microcontroller (MCU)
architecture. Figure 1-1 and Figure 1-2 show device
block diagrams for dsPIC30F3014 and dsPIC30F4013,
respectively.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
FIGURE 1-1:
dsPIC30F3014 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
24 Control Block 8
Data Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
24
Program Memory
(24 Kbytes)
INT0/RA11
PORTA
16
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
Loop
Stack
Control
Control
Logic
Logic
Data Latch
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
16
24
Address Latch
16
16
16
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/CN6/RB4
AN5/CN7/RB5
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
AN9/RB9
AN10/RB10
AN11/RB11
AN12/RB12
16
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
Effective Address
16
Data Latch
ROM Latch
16
24
PORTB
IR
16
16
Decode
Instruction
Decode and
Control
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/
CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16 16
PORTC
Control Signals
to Various Blocks
OSC1/CLKI
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/
CN1/RC13
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Power-up
Timer
DSP
Engine
Divide
Unit
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Timing
Generation
ALU<16>
POR/BOR
Reset
MCLR
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
Watchdog
Timer
Low-Voltage
Detect
16
16
PORTD
12-bit ADC
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
Timers
DCI
SPI1
UART1,
UART2
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
RD2
RD3
IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
RF0
RF1
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
PORTF
DS70138E-page 9
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 1-2:
dsPIC30F4013 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Y Data Bus
X Data Bus
16
16
Interrupt
Controller
PSV & Table
Data Access
24 Control Block
8
Data Latch
Y Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
24
Program Memory
(48 Kbytes)
INT0/RA11
PORTA
16
X RAGU
X WAGU
Y AGU
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
Loop
Stack
Control
Control
Logic
Logic
Data Latch
X Data
RAM
(1 Kbyte)
Address
Latch
16
16
24
Address Latch
16
16
AN0/VREF+/CN2/RB0
AN1/VREF-/CN3/RB1
AN2/SS1/LVDIN/CN4/RB2
AN3/CN5/RB3
AN4/IC7/CN6/RB4
AN5/IC8/CN7/RB5
PGC/EMUC/AN6/OCFA/RB6
PGD/EMUD/AN7/RB7
AN8/RB8
AN9/CSCK/RB9
AN10/CSDI/RB10
AN11/CSDO/RB11
AN12/COFS/RB12
16
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
Effective Address
16
Data Latch
ROM Latch
16
24
PORTB
IR
16
16
Decode
Instruction
Decode &
Control
PORTC
Power-up
Timer
DSP
Engine
EMUC2/OC1/RD0
EMUD2/OC2/RD1
OC3/RD2
OC4/RD3
ALU<16>
POR/BOR
Reset
MCLR
VDD, VSS
AVDD, AVSS
DS70138E-page 10
Divide
Unit
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Timing
Generation
CAN1
EMUC1/SOSCO/T1CK/U1ARX/
CN0/RC14
OSC2/CLKO/RC15
16 16
Control Signals
to Various Blocks
OSC1/CLKI
EMUD1/SOSCI/T2CK/U1ATX/
CN1/RC13
16 x 16
W Reg Array
Watchdog
Timer
Low-Voltage
Detect
IC1/INT1/RD8
IC2/INT2/RD9
16
16
PORTD
12-bit ADC
Input
Capture
Module
Output
Compare
Module
I2C™
Timers
DCI
SPI1
UART1,
UART2
C1RX/RF0
C1TX/RF1
U1RX/SDI1/SDA/RF2
EMUD3/U1TX/SDO1/SCL/RF3
U2RX/CN17/RF4
U2TX/CN18/RF5
EMUC3/SCK1/RF6
PORTF
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Table 1-1 provides a brief description of device I/O
pinouts and the functions that may be multiplexed to a
port pin. Multiple functions may exist on one port pin.
When multiplexing occurs, the peripheral module’s
functional requirements may force an override of the
data direction of the port pin.
TABLE 1-1:
PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
AN0-AN12
I
Analog
Pin Name
Description
Analog input channels. AN6 and AN7 are also used for device
programming data and clock inputs, respectively.
AVDD
P
P
Positive supply for analog module.
AVSS
P
P
Ground reference for analog module.
CLKI
I
ST/CMOS
CLKO
O
—
CN0-CN7, CN17-CN18
I
ST
Input change notification inputs. Can be software programmed
for internal weak pull-ups on all inputs.
COFS
CSCK
CSDI
CSDO
I/O
I/O
I
O
ST
ST
ST
—
Data Converter Interface Frame Synchronization pin.
Data Converter Interface Serial Clock input/output pin.
Data Converter Interface Serial data input pin.
Data Converter Interface Serial data output pin.
C1RX
C1TX
I
O
ST
—
CAN1 bus receive pin.
CAN1 bus transmit pin.
EMUD
EMUC
EMUD1
EMUC1
EMUD2
EMUC2
EMUD3
EMUC3
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ST
ICD Primary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Primary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Secondary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Tertiary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel data input/output pin.
ICD Quaternary Communication Channel clock input/output pin.
External clock source input. Always associated with OSC1 pin
function.
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in
Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC
and EC modes. Always associated with OSC2 pin function.
IC1, IC2, IC7, IC8
I
ST
Capture inputs 1,2, 7 and 8.
INT0
INT1
INT2
I
I
I
ST
ST
ST
External interrupt 0.
External interrupt 1.
External interrupt 2.
LVDIN
I
Analog
MCLR
I/P
ST
Master Clear (Reset) input or programming voltage input. This
pin is an active-low Reset to the device.
OCFA
OC1-OC4
I
O
ST
—
Compare Fault A input (for Compare channels 1, 2, 3 and 4).
Compare outputs 1 through 4.
OSC1
I
ST/CMOS
OSC2
I/O
—
Oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC mode;
CMOS otherwise.
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in
Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC
and EC modes.
PGD
PGC
I/O
I
ST
ST
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ data input/output pin.
In-Circuit Serial Programming clock input pin.
Low-Voltage Detect Reference Voltage Input pin.
Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST
= Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Analog = Analog input
O
= Output
P
= Power
DS70138E-page 11
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 1-1:
PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
RA11
I/O
ST
PORTA is a bidirectional I/O port.
RB0-RB12
I/O
ST
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port.
RC13-RC15
I/O
ST
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
RD0-RD3, RD8, RD9
I/O
ST
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
RF0-RF5
I/O
ST
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
SCK1
SDI1
SDO1
SS1
I/O
I
O
I
ST
ST
—
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI1.
SPI1 data in.
SPI1 data out.
SPI1 slave synchronization.
SCL
SDA
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C™.
Synchronous serial data input/output for I2C.
SOSCO
SOSCI
O
I
—
ST/CMOS
T1CK
T2CK
I
I
ST
ST
Timer1 external clock input.
Timer2 external clock input.
U1RX
U1TX
U1ARX
U1ATX
I
O
I
O
ST
—
ST
—
UART1 receive.
UART1 transmit.
UART1 alternate receive.
UART1 alternate transmit.
VDD
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
VSS
P
—
VREF+
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (high) input.
VREF-
I
Analog
Analog voltage reference (low) input.
Pin Name
Description
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal output.
32 kHz low-power oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when
configured in RC mode; CMOS otherwise.
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST
= Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
I
= Input
DS70138E-page 12
Analog = Analog input
O
= Output
P
= Power
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
2.0
CPU ARCHITECTURE
OVERVIEW
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
2.1
Core Overview
This section contains a brief overview of the CPU
architecture of the dsPIC30F.
The core has a 24-bit instruction word. The Program
Counter (PC) is 23 bits wide with the Least Significant
bit (LSb) always clear (refer to Section 3.1 “Program
Address Space”), and the Most Significant bit (MSb)
is ignored during normal program execution, except for
certain specialized instructions. Thus, the PC can
address up to 4M instruction words of user program
space. An instruction prefetch mechanism is used to
help maintain throughput. Program loop constructs,
free from loop count management overhead, are
supported using the DO and REPEAT instructions, both
of which are interruptible at any point.
The working register array consists of 16-bit x 16-bit
registers, each of which can act as data, address or offset registers. One working register (W15) operates as
a software Stack Pointer for interrupts and calls.
The data space is 64 Kbytes (32K words) and is split
into two blocks, referred to as X and Y data memory.
Each block has its own independent Address Generation Unit (AGU). Most instructions operate solely
through the X memory, AGU, which provides the
appearance of a single, unified data space. The
Multiply-Accumulate (MAC) class of dual source DSP
instructions operate through both the X and Y AGUs,
splitting the data address space into two parts (see
Section 3.2 “Data Address Space”). The X and Y
data space boundary is device-specific and cannot be
altered by the user. Each data word consists of 2 bytes,
and most instructions can address data either as words
or bytes.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
There are two methods of accessing data stored in
program memory:
• The upper 32 Kbytes of data space memory can
be mapped into the lower half (user space) of program space at any 16K program word boundary,
defined by the 8-bit Program Space Visibility Page
(PSVPAG) register. This lets any instruction
access program space as if it were data space,
with a limitation that the access requires an additional cycle. Moreover, only the lower 16 bits of
each instruction word can be accessed using this
method.
• Linear indirect access of 32K word pages within
program space is also possible using any working
register, via table read and write instructions.
Table read and write instructions can be used to
access all 24 bits of an instruction word.
Overhead-free circular buffers (Modulo Addressing)
are supported in both X and Y address spaces. This is
primarily intended to remove the loop overhead for
DSP algorithms.
The X AGU also supports Bit-Reversed Addressing on
destination Effective Addresses to greatly simplify input
or output data reordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms.
Refer to Section 4.0 “Address Generator Units” for
details on Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing.
The core supports Inherent (no operand), Relative,
Literal, Memory Direct, Register Direct, Register
Indirect, Register Offset and Literal Offset Addressing
modes. Instructions are associated with predefined
addressing modes, depending upon their functional
requirements.
For most instructions, the core is capable of executing
a data (or program data) memory read, a working register (data) read, a data memory write and a program
(instruction) memory read per instruction cycle. As a
result, 3-operand instructions are supported, allowing
C = A+B operations to be executed in a single cycle.
A DSP engine has been included to significantly
enhance the core arithmetic capability and throughput.
It features a high-speed, 17-bit x 17-bit multiplier, a 40bit ALU, two 40-bit saturating accumulators and a 40bit bidirectional barrel shifter. Data in the accumulator,
or any working register, can be shifted up to 15 bits
right, or 16 bits left in a single cycle. The DSP instructions operate seamlessly with all other instructions and
have been designed for optimal real-time performance.
The MAC class of instructions can concurrently fetch
two data operands from memory while multiplying two
W registers. To enable this concurrent fetching of data
operands, the data space has been split for these
instructions and linear is for all others. This has been
achieved in a transparent and flexible manner by
dedicating certain working registers to each address
space for the MAC class of instructions.
DS70138E-page 13
dsPIC30F3014/4013
The core does not support a multi-stage instruction
pipeline. However, a single-stage instruction prefetch
mechanism is used, which accesses and partially
decodes instructions a cycle ahead of execution, in
order to maximize available execution time. Most
instructions execute in a single cycle with certain
exceptions.
The core features a vectored exception processing
structure for traps and interrupts, with 62 independent
vectors. The exceptions consist of up to 8 traps (of
which 4 are reserved) and 54 interrupts. Each interrupt
is prioritized based on a user-assigned priority between
1 and 7 (1 being the lowest priority and 7 being the
highest), in conjunction with a predetermined ‘natural
order’. Traps have fixed priorities ranging from 8 to 15.
2.2
Programmer’s Model
The programmer’s model is shown in Figure 2-1 and
consists of 16 x 16-bit working registers (W0 through
W15), 2 x 40-bit accumulators (AccA and AccB),
STATUS register (SR), Data Table Page register
(TBLPAG), Program Space Visibility Page register
(PSVPAG), DO and REPEAT registers (DOSTART,
DOEND, DCOUNT and RCOUNT) and Program
Counter (PC). The working registers can act as data,
address or offset registers. All registers are memory
mapped. W0 acts as the W register for file register
addressing.
Some of these registers have a shadow register associated with each of them, as shown in Figure 2-1. The
shadow register is used as a temporary holding register
and can transfer its contents to or from its host register
upon the occurrence of an event. None of the shadow
registers are accessible directly. The following rules
apply for transfer of registers into and out of shadows.
• PUSH.S and POP.S
W0, W1, W2, W3, SR (DC, N, OV, Z and C bits
only) are transferred.
• DO instruction
DOSTART, DOEND, DCOUNT shadows are
pushed on loop start and popped on loop end.
2.2.1
SOFTWARE STACK POINTER/
FRAME POINTER
The dsPIC® DSC devices contain a software stack.
W15 is the dedicated Software Stack Pointer (SP) and
is automatically modified by exception processing and
subroutine calls and returns. However, W15 can be referenced by any instruction in the same manner as all
other W registers. This simplifies the reading, writing
and manipulation of the Stack Pointer (e.g., creating
Stack Frames).
Note:
In order to protect against misaligned
stack accesses, W15<0> is always clear.
W15 is initialized to 0x0800 during a Reset. The user
may reprogram the SP during initialization to any
location within data space.
W14 has been dedicated as a Stack Frame Pointer, as
defined by the LNK and ULNK instructions. However,
W14 can be referenced by any instruction in the same
manner as all other W registers.
2.2.2
STATUS REGISTER
The dsPIC DSC core has a 16-bit STATUS register
(SR), the Least Significant Byte (LSB) of which is
referred to as the SR Low byte (SRL) and the Most
Significant Byte (MSB) as the SR High byte (SRH). See
Figure 2-1 for SR layout.
SRL contains all the MCU ALU operation status flags
(including the Z bit), as well as the CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bits, IPL<2:0> and the Repeat Active
Status bit, RA. During exception processing, SRL is
concatenated with the MSB of the PC to form a
complete word value which is then stacked.
The upper byte of the STATUS register contains the
DSP adder/subtracter Status bits, the DO Loop Active
bit (DA) and the Digit Carry (DC) Status bit.
2.2.3
PROGRAM COUNTER
The program counter is 23 bits wide; bit 0 is always
clear. Therefore, the PC can address up to 4M
instruction words.
When a byte operation is performed on a working
register, only the Least Significant Byte of the target
register is affected. However, a benefit of memory
mapped working registers is that both the Least and
Most Significant Bytes can be manipulated through
byte-wide data memory space accesses.
DS70138E-page 14
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 2-1:
PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
D15
D0
W0/WREG
PUSH.S Shadow
W1
DO Shadow
W2
W3
Legend
W4
DSP Operand
Registers
W5
W6
W7
Working Registers
W8
W9
DSP Address
Registers
W10
W11
W12/DSP Offset
W13/DSP Write-Back
W14/Frame Pointer
W15/Stack Pointer
SPLIM
AD39
Stack Pointer Limit Register
AD15
AD31
AD0
AccA
DSP
Accumulators
AccB
PC22
PC0
Program Counter
0
0
7
TABPAG
TBLPAG
7
Data Table Page Address
0
PSVPAG
Program Space Visibility Page Address
15
0
RCOUNT
REPEAT Loop Counter
15
0
DCOUNT
DO Loop Counter
22
0
DOSTART
DO Loop Start Address
DOEND
DO Loop End Address
22
15
0
Core Configuration Register
CORCON
OA
OB
SA
SB OAB SAB DA
SRH
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DC IPL2 IPL1 IPL0 RA
N
OV
Z
C
STATUS Register
SRL
DS70138E-page 15
dsPIC30F3014/4013
2.3
Divide Support
The dsPIC DSC devices feature a 16/16-bit signed
fractional divide operation, as well as 32/16-bit and 16/
16-bit signed and unsigned integer divide operations, in
the form of single instruction iterative divides. The
following instructions and data sizes are supported:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
DIVF – 16/16 signed fractional divide
DIV.sd – 32/16 signed divide
DIV.ud – 32/16 unsigned divide
DIV.s– 16/16 signed divide
DIV.u – 16/16 unsigned divide
The divide instructions must be executed within a
REPEAT loop. Any other form of execution (e.g., a
series of discrete divide instructions) will not function
correctly because the instruction flow depends on
RCOUNT. The divide instruction does not automatically
set up the RCOUNT value and it must, therefore, be
explicitly and correctly specified in the REPEAT instruction, as shown in Table 2-1 (REPEAT will execute the
target instruction {operand value+1} times). The
REPEAT loop count must be setup for 18 iterations of
the DIV/DIVF instruction. Thus, a complete divide
operation requires 19 cycles.
The 16/16 divides are similar to the 32/16 (same number
of iterations), but the dividend is either zero-extended or
sign-extended during the first iteration.
TABLE 2-1:
Note:
The divide flow is interruptible. However,
the user needs to save the context as
appropriate.
DIVIDE INSTRUCTIONS
Instruction
Function
DIVF
Signed fractional divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.sd
Signed divide: (Wm+1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.s
Signed divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.ud
Unsigned divide: (Wm+1:Wm)/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DIV.u
Unsigned divide: Wm/Wn → W0; Rem → W1
DS70138E-page 16
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
2.4
DSP Engine
The DSP engine consists of a high-speed, 17-bit x
17-bit multiplier, a barrel shifter and a 40-bit adder/
subtracter (with two target accumulators, round and
saturation logic).
The DSP engine also has the capability to perform
inherent
accumulator-to-accumulator
operations,
which require no additional data. These instructions are
ADD, SUB and NEG.
The dsPIC30F is a single-cycle instruction flow architecture, therefore, concurrent operation of the DSP
engine with MCU instruction flow is not possible.
However, some MCU ALU and DSP engine resources
may be used concurrently by the same instruction (e.g.,
ED, EDAC). (See Table 2-2 for DSP instructions.)
TABLE 2-2:
The DSP engine has various options selected through
various bits in the CPU Core Configuration register
(CORCON), as listed below:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Fractional or integer DSP multiply (IF).
Signed or unsigned DSP multiply (US).
Conventional or convergent rounding (RND).
Automatic saturation on/off for AccA (SATA).
Automatic saturation on/off for AccB (SATB).
Automatic saturation on/off for writes to data
memory (SATDW).
Accumulator Saturation mode selection
(ACCSAT).
7.
Note:
For CORCON layout, see Table 3-3.
A block diagram of the DSP engine is shown in
Figure 2-2.
DSP INSTRUCTION SUMMARY
Instruction
Algebraic Operation
CLR
A=0
ED
A = (x – y)2
ACC WB?
Yes
No
2
EDAC
A = A + (x – y)
No
MAC
A = A + (x * y)
Yes
MAC
A = A + x2
No
No change in A
Yes
MOVSAC
MPY
MPY.N
MSC
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
A=x*y
No
A=–x*y
No
A=A–x*y
Yes
DS70138E-page 17
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 2-2:
DSP ENGINE BLOCK DIAGRAM
40
S
a
40 Round t 16
u
Logic r
a
t
e
40-bit Accumulator A
40-bit Accumulator B
Carry/Borrow Out
Carry/Borrow In
Saturate
Adder
Negate
40
40
40
16
X Data Bus
Barrel
Shifter
40
Y Data Bus
Sign-Extend
32
16
Zero Backfill
32
33
17-bit
Multiplier/Scaler
16
16
To/From W Array
DS70138E-page 18
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
2.4.1
MULTIPLIER
The 17-bit x 17-bit multiplier is capable of signed or
unsigned operation and can multiplex its output using a
scaler to support either 1.31 fractional (Q31) or 32-bit
integer results. Unsigned operands are zero-extended
into the 17th bit of the multiplier input value. Signed
operands are sign-extended into the 17th bit of the
multiplier input value. The output of the 17-bit x 17-bit
multiplier/scaler is a 33-bit value, which is signextended to 40 bits. Integer data is inherently represented as a signed two’s complement value, where the
MSB is defined as a sign bit. Generally speaking, the
range of an N-bit two’s complement integer is -2N-1 to
2N-1 – 1. For a 16-bit integer, the data range is -32768
(0x8000) to 32767 (0x7FFF) including ‘0’. For a 32-bit
integer, the data range is -2,147,483,648
(0x8000 0000) to 2,147,483,645 (0x7FFF FFFF).
When the multiplier is configured for fractional multiplication, the data is represented as a two’s complement
fraction, where the MSB is defined as a sign bit and the
radix point is implied to lie just after the sign bit (QX format). The range of an N-bit two’s complement fraction
with this implied radix point is -1.0 to (1 – 21-N). For a
16-bit fraction, the Q15 data range is -1.0 (0x8000) to
0.999969482 (0x7FFF) including ‘0’ and has a precision of 3.01518x10-5. In Fractional mode, the 16x16
multiply operation generates a 1.31 product, which has
a precision of 4.65661 x 10-10.
The same multiplier is used to support the MCU multiply instructions, which include integer 16-bit signed,
unsigned and mixed sign multiplies.
2.4.2.1
The adder/subtracter is a 40-bit adder with an optional
zero input into one side and either true or complement
data into the other input. In the case of addition, the
carry/borrow input is active high and the other input is
true data (not complemented), whereas in the case of
subtraction, the carry/borrow input is active low and the
other input is complemented. The adder/subtracter
generates overflow Status bits SA/SB and OA/OB,
which are latched and reflected in the STATUS register:
• Overflow from bit 39: this is a catastrophic
overflow in which the sign of the accumulator is
destroyed.
• Overflow into guard bits 32 through 39: this is a
recoverable overflow. This bit is set whenever all
the guard bits are not identical to each other.
The adder has an additional saturation block which
controls accumulator data saturation if selected. It uses
the result of the adder, the overflow Status bits
described above, and the SATA/B (CORCON<7:6>)
and ACCSAT (CORCON<4>) mode control bits to
determine when and to what value to saturate.
Six STATUS register bits have been provided to
support saturation and overflow. They are:
1.
2.
3.
The MUL instruction can be directed to use byte or
word-sized operands. Byte operands direct a 16-bit
result, and word operands direct a 32-bit result to the
specified register(s) in the W array.
2.4.2
DATA ACCUMULATORS AND
ADDER/SUBTRACTER
The data accumulator consists of a 40-bit adder/
subtracter with automatic sign extension logic. It can
select one of two accumulators (A or B) as its preaccumulation source and post-accumulation destination. For the ADD and LAC instructions, the data to be
accumulated or loaded can be optionally scaled via the
barrel shifter prior to accumulation.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Adder/Subtracter, Overflow and
Saturation
4.
5.
6.
OA:
AccA overflowed into guard bits
OB:
AccB overflowed into guard bits
SA:
AccA saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
AccA overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
SB:
AccB saturated (bit 31 overflow and saturation)
or
AccB overflowed into guard bits and saturated
(bit 39 overflow and saturation)
OAB:
Logical OR of OA and OB
SAB:
Logical OR of SA and SB
The OA and OB bits are modified each time data
passes through the adder/subtracter. When set, they
indicate that the most recent operation has overflowed
into the accumulator guard bits (bits 32 through 39).
The OA and OB bits can also optionally generate an
arithmetic warning trap when set and the corresponding overflow trap flag enable bit (OVATE, OVBTE) in
the INTCON1 register (refer to Section 8.0 “Interrupts”) is set. This allows the user to take immediate
action, for example, to correct system gain.
DS70138E-page 19
dsPIC30F3014/4013
The SA and SB bits are modified each time data
passes through the adder/subtracter but can only be
cleared by the user. When set, they indicate that the
accumulator has overflowed its maximum range (bit 31
for 32-bit saturation or bit 39 for 40-bit saturation) and
will be saturated if saturation is enabled. When
saturation is not enabled, SA and SB default to bit 39
overflow and, thus, indicate that a catastrophic overflow has occurred. If the COVTE bit in the INTCON1
register is set, SA and SB bits generate an arithmetic
warning trap when saturation is disabled.
The overflow and saturation Status bits can optionally
be viewed in the STATUS register (SR) as the logical
OR of OA and OB (in bit OAB) and the logical OR of SA
and SB (in bit SAB). This allows programmers to check
one bit in the STATUS register to determine if either
accumulator has overflowed, or one bit to determine if
either accumulator has saturated. This would be useful
for complex number arithmetic which typically uses
both the accumulators.
The device supports three saturation and overflow
modes:
1.
2.
3.
Bit 39 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 39 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic loads the maximally positive 9.31
(0x7FFFFFFFFF), or maximally negative 9.31
value (0x8000000000) into the target accumulator. The SA or SB bit is set and remains set until
cleared by the user. This is referred to as ‘super
saturation’ and provides protection against erroneous data or unexpected algorithm problems
(e.g., gain calculations).
Bit 31 Overflow and Saturation:
When bit 31 overflow and saturation occurs, the
saturation logic then loads the maximally positive 1.31 value (0x007FFFFFFF), or maximally
negative 1.31 value (0x0080000000) into the
target accumulator. The SA or SB bit is set and
remains set until cleared by the user. When this
Saturation mode is in effect, the guard bits are
not used, so the OA, OB or OAB bits are never
set.
Bit 39 Catastrophic Overflow:
The bit 39 overflow Status bit from the adder is
used to set the SA or SB bit which remain set
until cleared by the user. No saturation operation
is performed and the accumulator is allowed to
overflow (destroying its sign). If the COVTE bit in
the INTCON1 register is set, a catastrophic
overflow can initiate a trap exception.
DS70138E-page 20
2.4.2.2
Accumulator ‘Write-Back’
The MAC class of instructions (with the exception of
MPY, MPY.N, ED and EDAC) can optionally write a
rounded version of the high word (bits 31 through 16)
of the accumulator that is not targeted by the instruction
into data space memory. The write is performed across
the X bus into combined X and Y address space. The
following addressing modes are supported:
1.
2.
W13, Register Direct:
The rounded contents of the non-target
accumulator are written into W13 as a 1.15
fraction.
[W13]+=2, Register Indirect with Post-Increment:
The rounded contents of the non-target accumulator are written into the address pointed to by
W13 as a 1.15 fraction. W13 is then
incremented by 2 (for a word write).
2.4.2.3
Round Logic
The round logic is a combinational block which performs a conventional (biased) or convergent (unbiased) round function during an accumulator write
(store). The Round mode is determined by the state of
the RND bit in the CORCON register. It generates a 16bit, 1.15 data value, which is passed to the data space
write saturation logic. If rounding is not indicated by the
instruction, a truncated 1.15 data value is stored and
the least significant word (lsw) is simply discarded.
Conventional rounding takes bit 15 of the accumulator,
zero-extends it and adds it to the ACCxH word (bits 16
through 31 of the accumulator). If the ACCxL word
(bits 0 through 15 of the accumulator) is between
0x8000 and 0xFFFF (0x8000 included), ACCxH is
incremented. If ACCxL is between 0x0000 and 0x7FFF,
ACCxH is left unchanged. A consequence of this algorithm is that over a succession of random rounding
operations, the value tends to be biased slightly positive.
Convergent (or unbiased) rounding operates in the
same manner as conventional rounding, except when
ACCxL equals 0x8000. If this is the case, the Least Significant bit (LSb) (bit 16 of the accumulator) of ACCxH
is examined. If it is ‘1’, ACCxH is incremented. If it is ‘0’,
ACCxH is not modified. Assuming that bit 16 is
effectively random in nature, this scheme removes any
rounding bias that may accumulate.
The SAC and SAC.R instructions store either a truncated (SAC) or rounded (SAC.R) version of the contents
of the target accumulator to data memory via the X bus
(subject to data saturation, see Section 2.4.2.4 “Data
Space Write Saturation”). Note that for the MAC class
of instructions, the accumulator write-back operation
functions in the same manner, addressing combined
MCU (X and Y) data space though the X bus. For this
class of instructions, the data is always subject to
rounding.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
2.4.2.4
Data Space Write Saturation
2.4.3
BARREL SHIFTER
In addition to adder/subtracter saturation, writes to data
space may also be saturated but without affecting the
contents of the source accumulator. The data space
write saturation logic block accepts a 16-bit, 1.15
fractional value from the round logic block as its input,
together with overflow status from the original source
(accumulator) and the 16-bit round adder. These are
combined and used to select the appropriate 1.15
fractional value as output to write to data space
memory.
The barrel shifter is capable of performing up to 16-bit
arithmetic or logic right shifts, or up to 16-bit left shifts
in a single cycle. The source can be either of the two
DSP accumulators, or the X bus (to support multi-bit
shifts of register or memory data).
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is set, data
(after rounding or truncation) is tested for overflow and
adjusted accordingly. For input data greater than
0x007FFF, data written to memory is forced to the
maximum positive 1.15 value, 0x7FFF. For input data
less than 0xFF8000, data written to memory is forced
to the maximum negative 1.15 value, 0x8000. The
Most Significant bit (MSb) of the source (bit 39) is used
to determine the sign of the operand being tested.
The barrel shifter is 40 bits wide, thereby obtaining a
40-bit result for DSP shift operations and a 16-bit result
for MCU shift operations. Data from the X bus is
presented to the barrel shifter between bit positions 16
to 31 for right shifts, and bit positions 0 to 16 for left
shifts.
The shifter requires a signed binary value to determine
both the magnitude (number of bits) and direction of the
shift operation. A positive value shifts the operand right.
A negative value shifts the operand left. A value of ‘0’
does not modify the operand.
If the SATDW bit in the CORCON register is not set, the
input data is always passed through unmodified under
all conditions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 21
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 22
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
3.1
User program space access is restricted to the lower
4M instruction word address range (0x000000 to
0x7FFFFE) for all accesses other than TBLRD/TBLWT,
which use TBLPAG<7> to determine user or configuration space access. In Table 3-1, Program Space
Address Construction, bit 23 allows access to the
Device ID, the User ID and the Configuration bits.
Otherwise, bit 23 is always clear.
FIGURE 3-2:
Program Address Space
The program address space is 4M instruction words. It
is addressable by a 24-bit value from either the 23-bit
PC, table instruction Effective Address (EA), or data
space EA, when program space is mapped into data
space as defined by Table 3-1. Note that the program
space address is incremented by two between successive program words in order to provide compatibility
with data space addressing.
Reset – GOTO Instruction
Reset – Target Address
Reserved
000000
000002
000004
Interrupt Vector Table
Reserved
00007E
000080
000084
000084
0000FE
000100
0000FE
000100
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
Data EEPROM
(1 Kbyte)
7FFFFE
800000
Reserved
8005BE
8005C0
UNITID (32 instr.)
007FFE
004000
7FFBFE
7FFC00
7FFFFE
800000
003FFE
004000
Reserved
Configuration Memory
Space
User Memory
Space
User Flash
Program Memory
(8K instructions)
7FFBFE
7FFC00
User Flash
Program Memory
(16K instructions)
Reserved
(Read ‘0’s)
Alternate Vector Table
Reserved
(Read ‘0’s)
00007E
000080
Alternate Vector Table
User Memory
Space
Reset – GOTO Instruction
Reset – Target Address
000000
000002
000004
Interrupt Vector Table
dsPIC30F3014 PROGRAM
SPACE MEMORY MAP
Vector Tables
FIGURE 3-1:
dsPIC30F4013 PROGRAM
SPACE MEMORY MAP
Vector Tables
3.0
8005BE
8005C0
UNITID (32 instr.)
8005FE
800600
Reserved
Device Configuration
Registers
8005FE
800600
F7FFFE
F80000
F8000E
F80010
Configuration Memory
Space
Reserved
Reserved
Device Configuration
Registers
F7FFFE
F80000
F8000E
F80010
DEVID (2)
FEFFFE
FF0000
FF0002
Reserved
DEVID (2)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
FEFFFE
FF0000
FF0002
DS70138E-page 23
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 3-1:
PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS CONSTRUCTION
Program Space Address
Access
Space
Access Type
<23>
<22:16>
<15>
<14:1>
Instruction Access
User
TBLRD/TBLWT
User
(TBLPAG<7> = 0)
TBLPAG<7:0>
Data EA<15:0>
TBLRD/TBLWT
Configuration
(TBLPAG<7> = 1)
TBLPAG<7:0>
Data EA<15:0>
Program Space Visibility
User
FIGURE 3-3:
<0>
PC<22:1>
0
0
PSVPAG<7:0>
0
Data EA<14:0>
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS GENERATION
23 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
Select
Using
Program
Space
Visibility
0
1
0
EA
PSVPAG Reg
8 bits
15 bits
EA
Using
Table
Instruction
1/0
User/
Configuration
Space
Select
Note:
DS70138E-page 24
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
16 bits
24-bit EA
Byte
Select
Program space visibility cannot be used to access bits <23:16> of a word in program memory.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
3.1.1
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING TABLE
INSTRUCTIONS
A set of table instructions are provided to move byte or
word-sized data to and from program space. (See
Figure 3-4 and Figure 3-5.)
1.
This architecture fetches 24-bit wide program memory.
Consequently, instructions are always aligned.
However, as the architecture is modified Harvard, data
can also be present in program space.
There are two methods by which program space can
be accessed: via special table instructions, or through
the remapping of a 16K word program space page into
the upper half of data space (see Section 3.1.2 “Data
Access from Program Memory Using Program
Space Visibility”). The TBLRDL and TBLWTL instructions offer a direct method of reading or writing the lsw
of any address within program space, without going
through data space. The TBLRDH and TBLWTH instructions are the only method whereby the upper 8 bits of a
program space word can be accessed as data.
2.
3.
The PC is incremented by two for each successive
24-bit program word. This allows program memory
addresses to directly map to data space addresses.
Program memory can thus be regarded as two 16-bit
word wide address spaces, residing side by side, each
with the same address range. TBLRDL and TBLWTL
access the space which contains the least significant
data word, and TBLRDH and TBLWTH access the space
which contains the MS Data Byte.
4.
TBLRDL: Table Read Low
Word: Read the lsw of the program address;
P<15:0> maps to D<15:0>.
Byte: Read one of the LSBs of the program
address;
P<7:0> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 0;
P<15:8> maps to the destination byte when byte
select = 1.
TBLWTL: Table Write Low (refer to Section 5.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
Programming)
TBLRDH: Table Read High
Word: Read the most significant word (msw) of
the program address; P<23:16> maps to D<7:0>;
D<15:8> will always be = 0.
Byte: Read one of the MSBs of the program
address;
P<23:16> maps to the destination byte when
byte select = 0;
The destination byte will always be = 0 when
byte select = 1.
TBLWTH: Table Write High (refer to Section 5.0
“Flash Program Memory” for details on Flash
Programming)
Figure 3-3 shows how the EA is created for table operations and data space accesses (PSV = 1). Here,
P<23:0> refers to a program space word, whereas
D<15:0> refers to a data space word.
FIGURE 3-4:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (LEAST SIGNIFICANT WORD)
PC Address
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
23
16
8
0
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDL.W
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 0)
TBLRDL.B (Wn<0> = 1)
DS70138E-page 25
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 3-5:
PROGRAM DATA TABLE ACCESS (MSB)
TBLRDH.W
PC Address
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
0x000006
23
16
8
0
00000000
00000000
00000000
00000000
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 0)
Program Memory
‘Phantom’ Byte
(read as ‘0’)
3.1.2
TBLRDH.B (Wn<0> = 1)
DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM
MEMORY USING PROGRAM
SPACE VISIBILITY
The upper 32 Kbytes of data space may optionally be
mapped into any 16K word program space page. This
provides transparent access of stored constant data
from X data space without the need to use special
instructions (i.e., TBLRDL/H, TBLWTL/H instructions).
Program space access through the data space occurs
if the MSb of the data space EA is set and program
space visibility is enabled by setting the PSV bit in the
Core Control register (CORCON). The functions of
CORCON are discussed in Section 2.4 “DSP
Engine”.
Data accesses to this area add an additional cycle to
the instruction being executed, since two program
memory fetches are required.
Note that the upper half of addressable data space is
always part of the X data space. Therefore, when a
DSP operation uses program space mapping to access
this memory region, Y data space should typically contain state (variable) data for DSP operations, whereas
X data space should typically contain coefficient
(constant) data.
Although each data space address, 0x8000 and higher,
maps directly into a corresponding program memory
address (see Figure 3-6), only the lower 16 bits of the
24-bit program word are used to contain the data. The
upper 8 bits should be programmed to force an illegal
instruction to maintain machine robustness. Refer to
the “dsPIC30F/33F Programmer’s Reference Manual”
(DS70157) for details on instruction encoding.
DS70138E-page 26
Note that by incrementing the PC by 2 for each
program memory word, the LS 15 bits of data space
addresses directly map to the LS 15 bits in the corresponding program space addresses. The remaining
bits are provided by the Program Space Visibility Page
register, PSVPAG<7:0>, as shown in Figure 3-6.
Note:
PSV access is temporarily disabled during
table reads/writes.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
outside a REPEAT loop:
• The following instructions require one instruction
cycle in addition to the specified execution time:
- MAC class of instructions with data operand
prefetch
- MOV instructions
- MOV.D instructions
• All other instructions require two instruction cycles
in addition to the specified execution time of the
instruction.
For instructions that use PSV which are executed
inside a REPEAT loop:
• The following instances require two instruction
cycles in addition to the specified execution time
of the instruction:
- Execution in the first iteration
- Execution in the last iteration
- Execution prior to exiting the loop due to an
interrupt
- Execution upon re-entering the loop after an
interrupt is serviced
• Any other iteration of the REPEAT loop allows the
instruction accessing data, using PSV, to execute
in a single cycle.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 3-6:
DATA SPACE WINDOW INTO PROGRAM SPACE OPERATION
Data Space
Program Space
0x0000
0x000100
PSVPAG(1)
0x00
8
15
EA<15> = 0
Data 16
Space
15
EA
EA<15> = 1
0x8000
15
Address
Concatenation 23
23
15
0
0x000200
Upper Half of Data
Space is Mapped
into Program Space
0x007FFF
0xFFFF
BSET
MOV
MOV
MOV
CORCON,#2
#0x00, W0
W0, PSVPAG
0x8200, W0
; PSV bit set
; Set PSVPAG register
; Access program memory location
; using a data space access
Data Read
Note:
PSVPAG is an 8-bit register, containing bits <22:15> of the program space address (i.e., it defines
the page in program space to which the upper half of data space is being mapped).
The memory map shown here is for a dsPIC30F4013 device.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 27
dsPIC30F3014/4013
3.2
Data Address Space
The core has two data spaces. The data spaces can be
considered either separate (for some DSP instructions), or as one unified linear address range (for MCU
instructions). The data spaces are accessed using two
Address Generation Units (AGUs) and separate data
paths.
3.2.1
DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
The data space memory is split into two blocks, X and
Y data space. A key element of this architecture is that
Y space is a subset of X space, and is fully contained
within X space. In order to provide an apparent Linear
Addressing space, X and Y spaces have contiguous
addresses.
DS70138E-page 28
When executing any instruction other than one of the
MAC class of instructions, the X block consists of the 64Kbyte data address space (including all Y addresses).
When executing one of the MAC class of instructions,
the X block consists of the 64-Kbyte data address
space excluding the Y address block (for data reads
only). In other words, all other instructions regard the
entire data memory as one composite address space.
The MAC class instructions extract the Y address space
from data space and address it using EAs sourced from
W10 and W11. The remaining X data space is
addressed using W8 and W9. Both address spaces are
concurrently accessed only with the MAC class
instructions.
The data space memory map is shown in Figure 3-7.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 3-7:
dsPIC30F3014/dsPIC30F4013 DATA SPACE MEMORY MAP
MSB
Address
MSB
2 Kbyte
SFR Space
LSB
Address
16 bits
LSB
0x0000
0x0001
SFR Space
0x07FE
0x0800
0x07FF
0x0801
X Data RAM (X)
2 Kbyte
SRAM Space
0x0BFF
0x0C01
8 Kbyte
Near
Data
Space
Y Data RAM (Y)
0x0FFF
0x1001
0x0FFE
0x1000
0x1FFF
0x1FFE
0x8001
0x8000
X Data
Unimplemented (X)
Optionally
Mapped
into Program
Memory
0xFFFF
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
0x0BFE
0x0C00
0xFFFE
DS70138E-page 29
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DATA SPACE FOR MCU AND DSP (MAC CLASS) INSTRUCTIONS EXAMPLE
SFR SPACE
SFR SPACE
X SPACE
FIGURE 3-8:
Y SPACE
UNUSED
X SPACE
(Y SPACE)
X SPACE
UNUSED
UNUSED
Non-MAC Class Ops (Read/Write)
MAC Class Ops (Write)
Indirect EA using any W
DS70138E-page 30
MAC Class Ops (Read)
Indirect EA using W8, W9
Indirect EA using W10, W11
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
3.2.2
DATA SPACES
3.2.3
The X data space is used by all instructions and supports all addressing modes. There are separate read
and write data buses. The X read data bus is the return
data path for all instructions that view data space as
combined X and Y address space. It is also the X
address space data path for the dual operand read
instructions (MAC class). The X write data bus is the
only write path to data space for all instructions.
The X data space also supports Modulo Addressing for
all instructions, subject to addressing mode restrictions. Bit-Reversed Addressing is only supported for
writes to X data space.
The Y data space is used in concert with the X data
space by the MAC class of instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MOVSAC, MPY, MPY.N and MSC) to
provide two concurrent data read paths. No writes
occur across the Y bus. This class of instructions dedicates two W register pointers, W10 and W11, to always
address Y data space, independent of X data space,
whereas W8 and W9 always address X data space.
Note that during accumulator write-back, the data
address space is considered a combination of X and Y
data spaces, so the write occurs across the X bus.
Consequently, the write can be to any address in the
entire data space.
The Y data space can only be used for the data
prefetch operation associated with the MAC class of
instructions. It also supports Modulo Addressing for
automated circular buffers. Of course, all other instructions can access the Y data address space through the
X data path as part of the composite linear space.
The boundary between the X and Y data spaces is
defined as shown in Figure 3-7 and is not user programmable. Should an EA point to data outside its own
assigned address space, or to a location outside physical memory, an all zero word/byte is returned. For
example, although Y address space is visible by all
non-MAC instructions using any addressing mode, an
attempt by a MAC instruction to fetch data from that
space using W8 or W9 (X space pointers) returns
0x0000.
TABLE 3-2:
EFFECT OF INVALID
MEMORY ACCESSES
Attempted Operation
Data Returned
EA = an unimplemented address
0x0000
W8 or W9 used to access Y data
space in a MAC instruction
0x0000
W10 or W11 used to access X
data space in a MAC instruction
0x0000
DATA SPACE WIDTH
The core data width is 16 bits. All internal registers are
organized as 16-bit wide words. Data space memory is
organized in byte addressable, 16-bit wide blocks.
3.2.4
DATA ALIGNMENT
To help maintain backward compatibility with PIC®
MCU devices and improve data space memory usage
efficiency, the dsPIC30F instruction set supports both
word and byte operations. Data is aligned in data memory and registers as words, but all data space EAs
resolve to bytes. Data byte reads read the complete
word which contains the byte, using the LSb of any EA
to determine which byte to select. The selected byte is
placed onto the LSB of the X data path (no byte
accesses are possible from the Y data path as the MAC
class of instruction can only fetch words). That is, data
memory and registers are organized as two parallel
byte-wide entities with shared (word) address decode
but separate write lines. Data byte writes only write to
the corresponding side of the array or register which
matches the byte address.
As a consequence of this byte accessibility, all Effective
Address calculations (including those generated by the
DSP operations which are restricted to word-sized
data) are internally scaled to step through word aligned
memory. For example, the core would recognize that
Post-Modified Register Indirect Addressing mode
[Ws++] will result in a value of Ws + 1 for byte
operations and Ws + 2 for word operations.
All word accesses must be aligned to an even address.
Misaligned word data fetches are not supported so
care must be taken when mixing byte and word operations, or translating from 8-bit MCU code. Should a misaligned read or write be attempted, an address error
trap is generated. If the error occurred on a read, the
instruction underway is completed, whereas if it
occurred on a write, the instruction is executed but the
write does not occur. In either case, a trap is then executed, allowing the system and/or user to examine the
machine state prior to execution of the address Fault.
FIGURE 3-9:
15
DATA ALIGNMENT
MSB
87
LSB
0
0001
Byte 1
Byte 0
0000
0003
Byte 3
Byte 2
0002
0005
Byte 5
Byte 4
0004
All Effective Addresses are 16 bits wide and point to
bytes within the data space. Therefore, the data space
address range is 64 Kbytes or 32K words.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 31
dsPIC30F3014/4013
All byte loads into any W register are loaded into the
LSB. The MSB is not modified.
A Sign-Extend (SE) instruction is provided to allow
users to translate 8-bit signed data to 16-bit signed
values. Alternatively, for 16-bit unsigned data, users
can clear the MSB of any W register by executing a
Zero-Extend (ZE) instruction on the appropriate
address.
Although most instructions are capable of operating on
word or byte data sizes, it should be noted that some
instructions, including the DSP instructions, operate
only on words.
3.2.5
NEAR DATA SPACE
An 8-Kbyte ‘near’ data space is reserved in X address
memory space between 0x0000 and 0x1FFF, which is
directly addressable via a 13-bit absolute address field
within all memory direct instructions. The remaining X
address space and all of the Y address space is
addressable indirectly. Additionally, the whole of X data
space is addressable using MOV instructions, which
support memory direct addressing with a 16-bit
address field.
There is a Stack Pointer Limit register (SPLIM) associated with the Stack Pointer. SPLIM is uninitialized at
Reset. As is the case for the Stack Pointer, SPLIM<0>
is forced to ‘0’ because all stack operations must be
word aligned. Whenever an Effective Address (EA) is
generated, using W15 as a source or destination
pointer, the address thus generated is compared with
the value in SPLIM. If the contents of the Stack Pointer
(W15) and the SPLIM register are equal and a push
operation is performed, a stack error trap does not
occur. The stack error trap occurs on a subsequent
push operation. Thus, for example, if it is desirable to
cause a stack error trap when the stack grows beyond
address 0x2000 in RAM, initialize the SPLIM with the
value, 0x1FFE.
Similarly, a Stack Pointer underflow (stack error) trap is
generated when the Stack Pointer address is found to
be less than 0x0800, thus preventing the stack from
interfering with the Special Function Register (SFR)
space.
A write to the SPLIM register should not be immediately
followed by an indirect read operation using W15.
FIGURE 3-10:
3.2.6
SOFTWARE STACK
0x0000
CALL STACK FRAME
15
0
The Stack Pointer always points to the first available
free word and grows from lower addresses towards
higher addresses. It pre-decrements for stack pops
and post-increments for stack pushes as shown in
Figure 3-10. Note that for a PC push during any CALL
instruction, the MSB of the PC is zero-extended before
the push, ensuring that the MSB is always clear.
Note:
A PC push during exception processing
concatenates the SRL register to the MSB
of the PC prior to the push.
DS70138E-page 32
Stack Grows Towards
Higher Address
The dsPIC DSC devices contain a software stack. W15
is used as the Stack Pointer.
PC<15:0>
000000000 PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
W15 (before CALL)
W15 (after CALL)
POP : [--W15]
PUSH : [W15++]
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 3-3:
SFR Name
CORE REGISTER MAP
Address
(Home)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
W0
0000
W0/WREG
0000 0000 0000 0000
W1
0002
W1
0000 0000 0000 0000
W2
0004
W2
0000 0000 0000 0000
W3
0006
W3
0000 0000 0000 0000
W4
0008
W4
0000 0000 0000 0000
W5
000A
W5
0000 0000 0000 0000
W6
000C
W6
0000 0000 0000 0000
W7
000E
W7
0000 0000 0000 0000
0010
W8
0000 0000 0000 0000
0012
W9
0000 0000 0000 0000
W10
0014
W10
0000 0000 0000 0000
W11
0016
W11
0000 0000 0000 0000
W12
0018
W12
0000 0000 0000 0000
W13
001A
W13
0000 0000 0000 0000
W14
001C
W14
0000 0000 0000 0000
W15
001E
W15
0000 1000 0000 0000
SPLIM
0020
SPLIM
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAL
0022
ACCAL
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAH
0024
ACCAH
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCAU
0026
ACCBL
0028
ACCBL
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCBH
002A
ACCBH
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACCBU
002C
PCL
002E
PCH
0030
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TBLPAG
0032
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TBLPAG
0000 0000 0000 0000
PSVPAG
0034
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PSVPAG
0000 0000 0000 0000
RCOUNT
0036
RCOUNT
DCOUNT
0038
DCOUNT
DOSTARTL
003A
DOSTARTH
003C
DOENDL
003E
Sign Extension (ACCA<39>)
ACCAU
Sign Extension (ACCB<39>)
ACCBU
0000 0000 0000 0000
PCL
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
PCH
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
DOSTARTL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0
—
DOSTARTH
0
DOENDH
0040
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0042
OA
OB
SA
SB
OAB
SAB
DA
DC
IPL2
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
DOENDH
IPL1
IPL0
RA
N
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
DOENDL
SR
Legend:
1:
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
0000 0000 0uuu uuuu
OV
Z
C
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 33
W8
W9
SFR Name
CORE REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Address
(Home)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
EDT
DL2
DL1
DL0
SATA
SATB
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
IPL3
PSV
RND
IF
0000 0000 0010 0000
CORCON
0044
—
—
—
US
MODCON
0046
XMODEN
YMODEN
—
—
XMODSRT
0048
XS<15:1>
0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
XMODEND
004A
XE<15:1>
1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
YMODSRT
004C
YS<15:1>
0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu0
YMODEND
004E
YE<15:1>
1
XBREV
0050
BREN
0052
—
DISICNT
Legend:
1:
BWM<3:0>
SATDW ACCSAT
Bit 3
YWM<3:0>
XB<14:0>
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
DISICNT<13:0>
XWM<3:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuu1
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 34
TABLE 3-3:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
4.0
ADDRESS GENERATOR UNITS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The dsPIC DSC core contains two independent
address generator units: the X AGU and Y AGU. The Y
AGU supports word-sized data reads for the DSP MAC
class of instructions only. The dsPIC DSC AGUs support three types of data addressing:
• Linear Addressing
• Modulo (Circular) Addressing
• Bit-Reversed Addressing
FILE REGISTER INSTRUCTIONS
Most file register instructions use a 13-bit address field
(f) to directly address data present in the first 8192
bytes of data memory (near data space). Most file
register instructions employ a working register, W0,
which is denoted as WREG in these instructions. The
destination is typically either the same file register or
WREG (with the exception of the MUL instruction),
which writes the result to a register or register pair. The
MOV instruction allows additional flexibility and can
access the entire data space during file register
operation.
4.1.2
MCU INSTRUCTIONS
The three-operand MCU instructions are of the form:
Operand 3 = Operand 1 <function> Operand 2
Linear and Modulo Data Addressing modes can be
applied to data space or program space. Bit-Reversed
Addressing is only applicable to data space addresses.
4.1
4.1.1
Instruction Addressing Modes
The addressing modes in Table 4-1 form the basis of
the addressing modes optimized to support the specific
features of individual instructions. The addressing
modes provided in the MAC class of instructions are
somewhat different from those in the other instruction
types.
where Operand 1 is always a working register (i.e., the
addressing mode can only be register direct), which is
referred to as Wb. Operand 2 can be a W register,
fetched from data memory or a 5-bit literal. The result
location can be either a W register or an address
location. The following addressing modes are
supported by MCU instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
Register Direct
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-modified
Register Indirect Pre-modified
5-bit or 10-bit Literal
Note:
TABLE 4-1:
Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
FUNDAMENTAL ADDRESSING MODES SUPPORTED
Addressing Mode
Description
File Register Direct
The address of the File register is specified explicitly.
Register Direct
The contents of a register are accessed directly.
Register Indirect
The contents of Wn forms the EA.
Register Indirect Post-modified
The contents of Wn forms the EA. Wn is post-modified (incremented or
decremented) by a constant value.
Register Indirect Pre-modified
Wn is pre-modified (incremented or decremented) by a signed constant value
to form the EA.
Register Indirect with Register Offset The sum of Wn and Wb forms the EA.
Register Indirect with Literal Offset
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The sum of Wn and a literal forms the EA.
DS70138E-page 35
dsPIC30F3014/4013
4.1.3
MOVE AND ACCUMULATOR
INSTRUCTIONS
Move instructions and the DSP accumulator class of
instructions provide a greater degree of addressing
flexibility than other instructions. In addition to the
addressing modes supported by most MCU instructions, move and accumulator instructions also support
Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing
mode, also referred to as Register Indexed mode.
Note:
For the MOV instructions, the addressing
mode specified in the instruction can differ
for the source and destination EA.
However, the 4-bit Wb (register offset)
field is shared between both source and
destination (but typically only used by
one).
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by move and accumulator instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Register Direct
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-modified
Register Indirect Pre-modified
Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
Register Indirect with Literal Offset
8-bit Literal
16-bit Literal
Note:
4.1.4
Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual
instructions may support different subsets
of these addressing modes.
MAC INSTRUCTIONS
The dual source operand DSP instructions (CLR, ED,
EDAC, MAC, MPY, MPY.N, MOVSAC and MSC), also
referred to as MAC instructions, utilize a simplified set of
addressing modes to allow the user to effectively
manipulate the data pointers through register indirect
tables.
The two source operand prefetch registers must be a
member of the set {W8, W9, W10, W11}. For data
reads, W8 and W9 is always directed to the X RAGU,
and W10 and W11 are always directed to the Y AGU.
The Effective Addresses generated (before and after
modification) must, therefore, be valid addresses within
X data space for W8 and W9 and Y data space for W10
and W11.
Note:
In summary, the following addressing modes are
supported by the MAC class of instructions:
•
•
•
•
•
Register Indirect
Register Indirect Post-modified by 2
Register Indirect Post-modified by 4
Register Indirect Post-modified by 6
Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed)
4.1.5
OTHER INSTRUCTIONS
Besides the various addressing modes outlined above,
some instructions use literal constants of various sizes.
For example, BRA (branch) instructions use 16-bit
signed literals to specify the branch destination directly,
whereas the DISI instruction uses a 14-bit unsigned
literal field. In some instructions, such as ADD Acc, the
source of an operand or result is implied by the opcode
itself. Certain operations, such as NOP, do not have any
operands.
4.2
Modulo Addressing
Modulo Addressing is a method of providing an
automated means to support circular data buffers using
hardware. The objective is to remove the need for
software to perform data address boundary checks
when executing tightly looped code, as is typical in
many DSP algorithms.
Modulo Addressing can operate in either data or
program space (since the data pointer mechanism is
essentially the same for both). One circular buffer can
be supported in each of the X (which also provides the
pointers into program space) and Y data spaces.
Modulo Addressing can operate on any W register
pointer. However, it is not advisable to use W14 or W15
for Modulo Addressing since these two registers are
used as the Stack Frame Pointer and Stack Pointer,
respectively.
In general, any particular circular buffer can only be
configured to operate in one direction, as there are
certain restrictions on the buffer start address (for incrementing buffers), or end address (for decrementing
buffers) based upon the direction of the buffer.
The only exception to the usage restrictions is for
buffers that have a power-of-2 length. As these buffers
satisfy the start and end address criteria, they may
operate in a Bidirectional mode (i.e., address boundary
checks are performed on both the lower and upper
address boundaries).
Register Indirect with Register Offset
addressing is only available for W9 (in X
space) and W11 (in Y space).
DS70138E-page 36
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
4.2.1
START AND END ADDRESS
4.2.2
The Modulo Addressing scheme requires that a starting and an ending address be specified and loaded
into the 16-bit Modulo Buffer Address registers:
XMODSRT, XMODEND, YMODSRT and YMODEND
(see Table 3-3).
Note:
Y space Modulo Addressing EA calculations assume word-sized data (LSb of
every EA is always clear).
The length of a circular buffer is not directly specified. It
is determined by the difference between the
corresponding start and end addresses. The maximum
possible length of the circular buffer is 32K words
(64 Kbytes).
W ADDRESS REGISTER
SELECTION
The Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing Control register MODCON<15:0> contains enable flags as well as
a W register field to specify the W address registers.
The XWM and YWM fields select which registers operate with Modulo Addressing. If XWM = 15, X RAGU
and X WAGU Modulo Addressing is disabled. Similarly,
if YWM = 15, Y AGU Modulo Addressing is disabled.
The X Address Space Pointer W register (XWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<3:0> (see Table 3-3). Modulo Addressing is
enabled for X data space when XWM is set to any value
other than ‘15’ and the XMODEN bit is set at
MODCON<15>.
The Y Address Space Pointer W register (YWM), to
which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in
MODCON<7:4>. Modulo Addressing is enabled for Y
data space when YWM is set to any value other than
‘15’ and the YMODEN bit is set at MODCON<14>.
FIGURE 4-1:
MODULO ADDRESSING OPERATION EXAMPLE
Byte
Address
0x0800
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
#0x800,W0
W0,XMODSRT
#0x863,W0
W0,MODEND
#0x8001,W0
W0,MODCON
MOV
MOV
#0x0000,W0
#0x800,W1
DO
AGAIN,#0x31
MOV
W0,[W1++]
AGAIN: INC W0,W0
;set modulo start address
;set modulo end address
;enable W1, X AGU for modulo
;W0 holds buffer fill value
;point W1 to buffer
;fill the 50 buffer locations
;fill the next location
;increment the fill value
0x0863
Start Addr = 0x0800
End Addr = 0x0863
Length = 0x0032 words
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 37
dsPIC30F3014/4013
4.2.3
MODULO ADDRESSING
APPLICABILITY
Modulo Addressing can be applied to the Effective
Address (EA) calculation associated with any W register. It is important to realize that the address boundaries check for addresses less than or greater than the
upper (for incrementing buffers) and lower (for decrementing buffers) boundary addresses (not just equal
to). Address changes may, therefore, jump beyond
boundaries and still be adjusted correctly.
Note:
4.3
The modulo corrected Effective Address is
written back to the register only when PreModify or Post-Modify Addressing mode is
used to compute the Effective Address.
When an address offset (e.g., [W7+W2]) is
used, modulo address correction is performed but the contents of the register
remain unchanged.
Bit-Reversed Addressing
Bit-Reversed Addressing is intended to simplify data
re-ordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms. It is supported
by the X AGU for data writes only.
The modifier, which may be a constant value or register
contents, is regarded as having its bit order reversed. The
address source and destination are kept in normal order.
Thus, the only operand requiring reversal is the modifier.
4.3.1
2.
3.
XB<14:0> is the bit-reversed address modifier or ‘pivot
point’ which is typically a constant. In the case of an
FFT computation, its value is equal to half of the FFT
data buffer size.
Note:
BWM (W register selection) in the MODCON
register is any value other than ‘15’ (the stack
cannot be accessed using Bit-Reversed
Addressing) and
the BREN bit is set in the XBREV register and
the addressing mode used is Register Indirect
with Pre-Increment or Post-Increment.
FIGURE 4-2:
All bit-reversed EA calculations assume
word-sized data (LSb of every EA is
always clear). The XB value is scaled
accordingly to generate compatible (byte)
addresses.
When enabled, Bit-Reversed Addressing is only executed for Register Indirect with Pre-Increment or PostIncrement addressing and word-sized data writes. It
does not function for any other addressing mode or for
byte sized data. Normal addresses are generated
instead. When Bit-Reversed Addressing is active, the
W Address Pointer is always added to the address
modifier (XB) and the offset associated with the Register Indirect Addressing mode is ignored. In addition, as
word-sized data is a requirement, the LSb of the EA is
ignored (and always clear).
Note:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING
IMPLEMENTATION
Bit-Reversed Addressing is enabled when:
1.
If the length of a bit-reversed buffer is M = 2N bytes,
then the last ‘N’ bits of the data buffer start address
must be zeros.
Modulo Addressing and Bit-Reversed
Addressing should not be enabled
together. In the event that the user attempts
to do this, Bit-Reversed Addressing
assumes priority when active for the X
WAGU, and X WAGU Modulo Addressing
is disabled. However, Modulo Addressing
continues to function in the X RAGU.
If Bit-Reversed Addressing has already been enabled
by setting the BREN (XBREV<15>) bit, then a write to
the XBREV register should not be immediately followed
by an indirect read operation using the W register that
has been designated as the Bit-Reversed Pointer.
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS EXAMPLE
Sequential Address
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8
b7 b6 b5 b4
b3 b2 b1
0
Bit Locations Swapped Left-to-Right
Around Center of Binary Value
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8
b7 b6 b5 b1
b2 b3 b4
0
Bit-Reversed Address
Pivot Point
XB = 0x0008 for a 16-word Bit-Reversed Buffer
DS70138E-page 38
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 4-2:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS SEQUENCE (16-ENTRY)
Normal Address
A3
A2
A1
A0
Bit-Reversed Address
Decimal
A3
A2
A1
A0
Decimal
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
8
0
0
1
0
2
0
1
0
0
4
0
0
1
1
3
1
1
0
0
12
0
1
0
0
4
0
0
1
0
2
0
1
0
1
5
1
0
1
0
10
0
1
1
0
6
0
1
1
0
6
0
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
0
14
1
0
0
0
8
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
9
1
0
0
1
9
1
0
1
0
10
0
1
0
1
5
1
0
1
1
11
1
1
0
1
13
1
1
0
0
12
0
0
1
1
3
1
1
0
1
13
1
0
1
1
11
1
1
1
0
14
0
1
1
1
7
1
1
1
1
15
1
1
1
1
15
TABLE 4-3:
BIT-REVERSED ADDRESS MODIFIER VALUES FOR XBREV REGISTER
Buffer Size (Words)
XB<14:0> Bit-Reversed Address Modifier Value
1024
0x0200
512
0x0100
256
0x0080
128
0x0040
64
0x0020
32
0x0010
16
0x0008
8
0x0004
4
0x0002
2
0x0001
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 39
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 40
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
5.0
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
5.2
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
RTSP is accomplished using TBLRD (table read) and
TBLWT (table write) instructions.
With RTSP, the user may erase program memory, 32
instructions (96 bytes) at a time and can write program
memory data, 32 instructions (96 bytes) at a time.
The dsPIC30F family of devices contains internal
program Flash memory for executing user code. There
are two methods by which the user can program this
memory:
1.
2.
5.1
5.3
Table Instruction Operation
Summary
The TBLRDL and the TBLWTL instructions are used to
read or write to bits<15:0> of program memory.
TBLRDL and TBLWTL can access program memory in
Word or Byte mode.
Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP)
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™)
The TBLRDH and TBLWTH instructions are used to read
or write to bits<23:16> of program memory. TBLRDH
and TBLWTH can access program memory in Word or
Byte mode.
In-Circuit Serial Programming
(ICSP)
dsPIC30F devices can be serially programmed while in
the end application circuit. This is simply done with two
lines for Programming Clock and Programming Data
(which are named PGC and PGD, respectively), and
three other lines for Power (VDD), Ground (VSS) and
Master Clear (MCLR). This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then
program the microcontroller just before shipping the
product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a
custom firmware to be programmed.
FIGURE 5-1:
Run-Time Self-Programming
(RTSP)
A 24-bit program memory address is formed using
bits<7:0> of the TBLPAG register and the Effective
Address (EA) from a W register specified in the table
instruction, as shown in Figure 5-1.
ADDRESSING FOR TABLE AND NVM REGISTERS
24 bits
Using
Program
Counter
Program Counter
0
0
NVMADR Reg EA
Using
NVMADR
Addressing
1/0
NVMADRU Reg
8 bits
16 bits
Working Reg EA
Using
Table
Instruction
User/Configuration
Space Select
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
1/0
TBLPAG Reg
8 bits
16 bits
24-bit EA
Byte
Select
DS70138E-page 41
dsPIC30F3014/4013
5.4
RTSP Operation
The dsPIC30F Flash program memory is organized
into rows and panels. Each row consists of 32 instructions or 96 bytes. Each panel consists of 128 rows or
4K x 24 instructions. RTSP allows the user to erase one
row (32 instructions) at a time and to program four
instructions at one time. RTSP may be used to program
multiple program memory panels, but the Table Pointer
must be changed at each panel boundary.
Each panel of program memory contains write latches
that hold 32 instructions of programming data. Prior to
the actual programming operation, the write data must
be loaded into the panel write latches. The data to be
programmed into the panel is loaded in sequential
order into the write latches; instruction 0, instruction 1,
etc. The instruction words loaded must always be from
a 32 address boundary.
The basic sequence for RTSP programming is to set up
a Table Pointer, then do a series of TBLWT instructions
to load the write latches. Programming is performed by
setting the special bits in the NVMCON register. 32
TBLWTL and four TBLWTH instructions are required to
load the 32 instructions. If multiple panel programming
is required, the Table Pointer needs to be changed and
the next set of multiple write latches written.
All of the table write operations are single-word writes
(2 instruction cycles), because only the table latches
are written. A programming cycle is required for
programming each row.
The Flash Program Memory is readable, writable and
erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD
range.
5.5
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are:
•
•
•
•
NVMCON
NVMADR
NVMADRU
NVMKEY
5.5.1
NVMCON REGISTER
The NVMCON register controls which blocks are to be
erased, which memory type is to be programmed, and
start of the programming cycle.
5.5.2
NVMADR REGISTER
The NVMADR register is used to hold the lower two
bytes of the Effective Address. The NVMADR register
captures the EA<15:0> of the last table instruction that
has been executed and selects the row to write.
5.5.3
NVMADRU REGISTER
The NVMADRU register is used to hold the upper byte
of the Effective Address. The NVMADRU register captures the EA<23:16> of the last table instruction that
has been executed.
5.5.4
NVMKEY REGISTER
NVMKEY is a write-only register that is used for write
protection. To start a programming or an erase
sequence, the user must consecutively write 0x55 and
0xAA to the NVMKEY register. Refer to Section 5.6
“Programming Operations” for further details.
Note:
DS70138E-page 42
Control Registers
The user can also directly write to the
NVMADR and NVMADRU registers to
specify a program memory address for
erasing or programming.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
5.6
Programming Operations
A complete programming sequence is necessary for
programming or erasing the internal Flash in RTSP
mode. A programming operation is nominally 2 msec in
duration and the processor stalls (waits) until the operation is finished. Setting the WR bit (NVMCON<15>)
starts the operation and the WR bit is automatically
cleared when the operation is finished.
5.6.1
4.
5.
PROGRAMMING ALGORITHM FOR
PROGRAM FLASH
The user can erase or program one row of program
Flash memory at a time. The general process is:
1.
2.
3.
Read one row of program Flash (32 instruction
words) and store into data RAM as a data
“image”.
Update the data image with the desired new
data.
Erase program Flash row.
a) Setup NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, erase, and set WREN bit.
b) Write address of row to be erased into
NVMADRU/NVMDR.
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This begins erase cycle.
f) CPU stalls for the duration of the erase cycle.
g) The WR bit is cleared when erase cycle
ends.
EXAMPLE 5-1:
6.
Write 32 instruction words of data from data
RAM “image” into the program Flash write
latches.
Program 32 instruction words into program
Flash.
a) Setup NVMCON register for multi-word,
program Flash, program, and set WREN
bit.
b) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
c) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
d) Set the WR bit. This begins program cycle.
e) CPU stalls for duration of the program cycle.
f) The WR bit is cleared by the hardware
when program cycle ends.
Repeat steps 1 through 5 as needed to program
desired amount of program Flash memory.
5.6.2
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM
MEMORY
Example 5-1 shows a code sequence that can be used
to erase a row (32 instructions) of program memory.
ERASING A ROW OF PROGRAM MEMORY
; Setup NVMCON for erase operation, multi word
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
#0x4041,W0
;
;
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Init pointer to row to be ERASED
MOV
#tblpage(PROG_ADDR),W0
;
;
MOV
W0,NVMADRU
MOV
#tbloffset(PROG_ADDR),W0
;
MOV
W0, NVMADR
;
DISI
#5
;
;
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
;
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
;
NOP
;
NOP
;
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
write
Init NVMCON SFR
Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
Intialize in-page EA[15:0] pointer
Initialize NVMADR SFR
Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
next 5 instructions
Write the 0x55 key
Write the 0xAA key
Start the erase sequence
Insert two NOPs after the erase
command is asserted
DS70138E-page 43
dsPIC30F3014/4013
5.6.3
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
5.6.4
Example 5-2 shows a sequence of instructions that
can be used to load the 96 bytes of write latches. 32
TBLWTL and 32 TBLWTH instructions are needed to
load the write latches selected by the Table Pointer.
EXAMPLE 5-2:
INITIATING THE PROGRAMMING
SEQUENCE
For protection, the write initiate sequence for NVMKEY
must be used to allow any erase or program operation
to proceed. After the programming command has been
executed, the user must wait for the programming time
until programming is complete. The two instructions
following the start of the programming sequence
should be NOPs as shown in Example 5-3.
LOADING WRITE LATCHES
; Set up a pointer to the first program memory location to be written
; program memory selected, and writes enabled
MOV
#0x0000,W0
;
; Initialize PM Page Boundary SFR
MOV
W0,TBLPAG
MOV
#0x6000,W0
; An example program memory address
; Perform the TBLWT instructions to write the latches
; 0th_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_0,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_0,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2,[W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3,[W0++]
; 1st_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_1,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_1,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2,[W0]
TBLWTH W3,[W0++]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
; 2nd_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_2,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_2,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2, [W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3, [W0++]
•
•
•
; 31st_program_word
MOV
#LOW_WORD_31,W2
;
MOV
#HIGH_BYTE_31,W3
;
; Write PM low word into program latch
TBLWTL W2, [W0]
; Write PM high byte into program latch
TBLWTH W3, [W0++]
Note: In Example 5-2, the contents of the upper byte of W3 has no effect.
EXAMPLE 5-3:
INITIATING A PROGRAMMING SEQUENCE
DISI
#5
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0,NVMKEY
#0xAA,W1
W1,NVMKEY
NVMCON,#WR
DS70138E-page 44
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
next 5 instructions
Write the 0x55 key
Write the 0xAA key
Start the erase sequence
Insert two NOPs after the erase
command is asserted
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 5-1:
File Name
NVM REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
NVMCON
0760
WR
WREN
WRERR
NVMADR
0762
NVMADRU
0764
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
NVMADR<23:16>
0000 0000 uuuu uuuu
0766
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
KEY<7:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
NVMKEY
Legend:
2:
Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10
—
—
—
Bit 9
—
Bit 8
Bit 7
TWRI
—
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
PROGOP<6:0>
NVMADR<15:0>
Bit 1
Bit 0
All RESETS
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 45
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 46
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
6.0
DATA EEPROM MEMORY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The data EEPROM memory is readable and writable
during normal operation over the entire VDD range. The
data EEPROM memory is directly mapped in the
program memory address space.
The four SFRs used to read and write the program
Flash memory are used to access data EEPROM
memory, as well. As described in Section 5.5 “Control
Registers”, these registers are:
•
•
•
•
NVMCON
NVMADR
NVMADRU
NVMKEY
The EEPROM data memory allows read and write of
single words and 16-word blocks. When interfacing to
data memory, NVMADR, in conjunction with the
NVMADRU register, are used to address the
EEPROM location being accessed. TBLRDL and
TBLWTL instructions are used to read and write data
EEPROM. The dsPIC30F devices have up to 8 Kbytes
(4K words) of data EEPROM with an address range
from 0x7FF000 to 0x7FFFFE.
Control bit WR initiates write operations similar to
program Flash writes. This bit cannot be cleared, only
set, in software. They are cleared in hardware at the
completion of the write operation. The inability to clear
the WR bit in software prevents the accidental or
premature termination of a write operation.
The WREN bit, when set, allows a write operation. On
power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is set
when a write operation is interrupted by a MCLR Reset
or a WDT Time-out Reset during normal operation. In
these situations, following Reset, the user can check
the WRERR bit and rewrite the location. The address
register NVMADR remains unchanged.
Note:
6.1
Interrupt flag bit NVMIF in the IFS0 register is set when write is complete. It must be
cleared in software.
Reading the Data EEPROM
A TBLRD instruction reads a word at the current
program word address. This example uses W0 as a
pointer to data EEPROM. The result is placed in
register W4 as shown in Example 6-1.
EXAMPLE 6-1:
MOV
MOV
MOV
TBLRDL
DATA EEPROM READ
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0 ; Init Pointer
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
W1,TBLPAG
[ W0 ], W4
; read data EEPROM
A word write operation should be preceded by an erase
of the corresponding memory location(s). The write
typically requires 2 ms to complete, but the write time
varies with voltage and temperature.
A program or erase operation on the data EEPROM
does not stop the instruction flow. The user is responsible for waiting for the appropriate duration of time
before initiating another data EEPROM write/erase
operation. Attempting to read the data EEPROM while
a programming or erase operation is in progress results
in unspecified data.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 47
dsPIC30F3014/4013
6.2
6.2.1
Erasing Data EEPROM
ERASING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
In order to erase a block of data EEPROM, the
NVMADRU and NVMADR registers must initially point
to the block of memory to be erased. Configure
NVMCON for erasing a block of data EEPROM and
set the WR and WREN bits in the NVMCON register.
Setting the WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in
Example 6-2.
EXAMPLE 6-2:
6.2.2
ERASING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
The NVMADRU and NVMADR registers must point to
the block. Select a block of data Flash and set the WR
and WREN bits in the NVMCON register. Setting the
WR bit initiates the erase, as shown in Example 6-3.
DATA EEPROM BLOCK ERASE
; Select data EEPROM block, WR, WREN bits
MOV
#4045,W0
; Initialize NVMCON SFR
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
; Write the 0x55 key
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
; Write the 0xAA key
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
; Initiate erase sequence
NOP
NOP
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
EXAMPLE 6-3:
DATA EEPROM WORD ERASE
; Select data EEPROM word, WR, WREN bits
MOV
#4044,W0
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Start erase cycle by setting WR after writing key sequence
DISI
#5
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
#0x55,W0
;
; Write the 0x55 key
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
;
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
; Write the 0xAA key
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
; Initiate erase sequence
NOP
NOP
; Erase cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Erase Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine erasure complete
DS70138E-page 48
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
6.3
Writing to the Data EEPROM
To write an EEPROM data location, the following
sequence must be followed:
1.
2.
3.
Erase data EEPROM word.
a) Select word, data EEPROM erase, and set
WREN bit in NVMCON register.
b) Write address of word to be erased into
NVMADR.
c) Enable NVM interrupt (optional).
d) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
e) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
f) Set the WR bit. This begins erase cycle.
g) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVMIF
interrupt.
h) The WR bit is cleared when the erase cycle
ends.
Write data word into data EEPROM write
latches.
Program 1 data word into data EEPROM.
a) Select word, data EEPROM program, and
set WREN bit in NVMCON register.
b) Enable NVM write done interrupt (optional).
c) Write ‘55’ to NVMKEY.
d) Write ‘AA’ to NVMKEY.
e) Set the WR bit. This begins program cycle.
f) Either poll NVMIF bit or wait for NVM
interrupt.
g) The WR bit is cleared when the write cycle
ends.
EXAMPLE 6-4:
The write does not initiate if the above sequence is not
exactly followed (write 0x55 to NVMKEY, write 0xAA to
NVMCON, then set WR bit) for each word. It is strongly
recommended that interrupts be disabled during this
code segment.
Additionally, the WREN bit in NVMCON must be set to
enable writes. This mechanism prevents accidental
writes to data EEPROM due to unexpected code execution. The WREN bit should be kept clear at all times
except when updating the EEPROM. The WREN bit is
not cleared by hardware.
After a write sequence has been initiated, clearing the
WREN bit does not affect the current write cycle. The
WR bit is inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit
is set. The WREN bit must be set on a previous instruction. Both WR and WREN cannot be set with the same
instruction.
At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is
cleared in hardware and the Nonvolatile Memory Write
Complete Interrupt Flag bit (NVMIF) is set. The user
may either enable this interrupt or poll this bit. NVMIF
must be cleared by software.
6.3.1
WRITING A WORD OF DATA
EEPROM
Once the user has erased the word to be programmed,
then a table write instruction is used to write one write
latch, as shown in Example 6-4.
6.3.2
WRITING A BLOCK OF DATA
EEPROM
To write a block of data EEPROM, write to all sixteen
latches first, then set the NVMCON register and
program the block, as shown in Example 6-5.
DATA EEPROM WORD WRITE
; Point to data memory
MOV
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0
MOV
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
MOV
W1,TBLPAG
MOV
#LOW(WORD),W2
TBLWTL
W2,[ W0]
; The NVMADR captures last table access address
; Select data EEPROM for 1 word op
MOV
#0x4004,W0
MOV
W0,NVMCON
; Operate key to allow write operation
DISI
#5
; Init pointer
; Get data
; Write data
; Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
; next 5 instructions
MOV
#0x55,W0
; Write the 0x55 key
MOV
W0,NVMKEY
MOV
#0xAA,W1
MOV
W1,NVMKEY
; Write the 0xAA key
BSET
NVMCON,#WR
; Initiate program sequence
NOP
NOP
; Write cycle will complete in 2mS. CPU is not stalled for the Data Write Cycle
; User can poll WR bit, use NVMIF or Timer IRQ to determine write complete
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 49
dsPIC30F3014/4013
EXAMPLE 6-5:
6.4
DATA EEPROM BLOCK WRITE
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
TBLWTL
MOV
MOV
DISI
#5
#LOW_ADDR_WORD,W0
#HIGH_ADDR_WORD,W1
W1,TBLPAG
#data1,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data2,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data3,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data4,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data5,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data6,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data7,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data8,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data9,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data10,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data11,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data12,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data13,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data14,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data15,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#data16,W2
W2,[ W0]++
#0x400A,W0
W0,NVMCON
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
BSET
NOP
NOP
#0x55,W0
W0,NVMKEY
#0xAA,W1
W1,NVMKEY
NVMCON,#WR
; Init pointer
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Get 1st data
write data
Get 2nd data
write data
Get 3rd data
write data
Get 4th data
write data
Get 5th data
write data
Get 6th data
write data
Get 7th data
write data
Get 8th data
write data
Get 9th data
write data
Get 10th data
write data
Get 11th data
write data
Get 12th data
write data
Get 13th data
write data
Get 14th data
write data
Get 15th data
write data
Get 16th data
write data. The NVMADR captures last table access address.
Select data EEPROM for multi word op
Operate Key to allow program operation
Block all interrupts with priority <7 for
next 5 instructions
; Write the 0x55 key
; Write the 0xAA key
; Start write cycle
Write Verify
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the memory should be verified against the original value. This
should be used in applications where excessive writes
can stress bits near the specification limit.
6.5
Protection Against Spurious Write
There are conditions when the device may not want to
write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against
spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have
been built-in. On power-up, the WREN bit is cleared;
also, the Power-up Timer prevents EEPROM write.
The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together
help prevent an accidental write during brown-out,
power glitch or software malfunction.
DS70138E-page 50
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
7.0
I/O PORTS
Reads from the latch (LATx), read the latch. Writes to
the latch, write the latch (LATx). Reads from the port
(PORTx), read the port pins and writes to the port pins,
write the latch (LATx).
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
Any bit and its associated data and control registers
that are not valid for a particular device are disabled,
which means the corresponding LATx and TRISx
registers and the port pin read as zeros.
All of the device pins (except VDD, VSS, MCLR and
OSC1/CLKI) are shared between the peripherals and
the parallel I/O ports.
When a pin is shared with another peripheral or function that is defined as an input only, it is nevertheless
regarded as a dedicated port because there is no
other competing source of outputs. An example is the
INT4 pin.
All I/O input ports feature Schmitt Trigger inputs for
improved noise immunity.
7.1
Parallel I/O (PIO) Ports
A parallel I/O (PIO) port that shares a pin with a peripheral is, in general, subservient to the peripheral. The
peripheral’s output buffer data and control signals are
provided to a pair of multiplexers. The multiplexers
select whether the peripheral or the associated port
has ownership of the output data and control signals of
the I/O pad cell. Figure 7-2 shows how ports are shared
with other peripherals and the associated I/O cell (pad)
to which they are connected. Table 7-1 shows the
formats of the registers for the shared ports, PORTB
through PORTF.
When a peripheral is enabled and the peripheral is
actively driving an associated pin, the use of the pin as
a general purpose output pin is disabled. The I/O pin
can be read, but the output driver for the parallel port bit
is disabled. If a peripheral is enabled but the peripheral
is not actively driving a pin, that pin can be driven by a
port.
All port pins have three registers directly associated
with the operation of the port pin. The Data Direction
register (TRISx) determines whether the pin is an input
or an output. If the data direction bit is a ‘1’, then the pin
is an input. All port pins are defined as inputs after a
Reset.
FIGURE 7-1:
Note:
The actual bits in use vary between
devices.
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A DEDICATED PORT STRUCTURE
Dedicated Port Module
Read TRIS
I/O Cell
TRIS Latch
Data Bus
D
WR TRIS
CK
Q
Data Latch
D
WR LAT +
WR Port
Q
I/O Pad
CK
Read LAT
Read Port
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 51
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 7-2:
BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A SHARED PORT STRUCTURE
Output Multiplexers
Peripheral Module
Peripheral Input Data
Peripheral Module Enable
I/O Cell
Peripheral Output Enable
1 Output Enable
0
Peripheral Output Data
1
PIO Module
Output Data
0
Read TRIS
I/O Pad
Data Bus
D
WR TRIS
CK
Q
TRIS Latch
D
WR LAT +
WR Port
Q
CK
Data Latch
Read LAT
Input Data
Read Port
7.2
Configuring Analog Port Pins
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared
(output), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) is
converted.
When the PORT register is read, all pins configured as
analog input channels are read as cleared (a low level).
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an
analog input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as
a digital input (including the ANx pins) may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
DS70138E-page 52
7.2.1
I/O PORT WRITE/READ TIMING
One instruction cycle is required between a port
direction change or port write operation and a read
operation of the same port. Typically, this instruction
would be a NOP.
EXAMPLE 7-1:
MOV
0xFF00, W0
MOV
NOP
W0, TRISB
btss
PORTB, #11
PORT WRITE/READ
EXAMPLE
;
;
;
;
Configure PORTB<15:8>
as inputs
and PORTB<7:0> as outputs
additional instruction
cylcle
; bit test RB11 and skip if
set
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 7-1:
SFR Name Addr.
dsPIC30F3014/4013 PORT REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TRISA
02C0
—
—
—
—
TRISA11
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 1000 0000 0000
PORTA
02C2
—
—
—
—
RA11
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
LATA11
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATA
02C4
—
—
—
TRISB
02C6
—
—
—
TRISB12 TRISB11 TRISB10 TRISB9 TRISB8 TRISB7 TRISB6 TRISB5 TRISB4 TRISB3 TRISB2 TRISB1 TRISB0 0001 1111 1111 1111
PORTB
02C8
—
—
—
RB12
RB11
RB10
RB9
RB8
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATB
02CB
—
—
—
LATB12
LATB11
LATB10
LATB9
LATB8
LATB7
LATB6
LATB5
LATB4
LATB3
LATB2
LATB1
LATB0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISC
02CC TRISC15 TRISC14 TRISC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1110 0000 0000 0000
PORTC
02CE
RC15
RC14
RC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATC
02D0
LATC15
LATC14
LATC13
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISD
02D2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTD
02D4
—
—
—
—
—
—
RD9
RD8
—
—
—
—
RD3
RD2
RD1
RD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATD
02D6
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATD9
LATD8
—
—
—
—
LATD3
LATD2
LATD1
LATD0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISF
02DE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PORTF
02E0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
RF6
RF5
RF4
RF3
RF2
RF1
RF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
LATF
02E2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
LATF6
LATF5
LATF4
LATF3
LATF2
LATF1
LATF0
0000 0000 0000 0000
TRISD9 TRISD8
TRISD3 TRISD2 TRISD1 TRISD0 0000 0011 0000 1111
TRISF6 TRISF5 TRISF4 TRISF3 TRISF2 TRISF1 TRISF0 0000 0000 0111 1111
Legend: u = uninitialized bit
3: Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 53
dsPIC30F3014/4013
7.3
Input Change Notification Module
The input change notification module provides the
dsPIC30F devices the ability to generate interrupt
requests to the processor, in response to a change of
state on selected input pins. This module is capable of
detecting input change of states even in Sleep mode,
when the clocks are disabled. There are up to 24 external signals (CN0 through CN23) that may be selected
(enabled) for generating an interrupt request on a
change of state.
TABLE 7-2:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F3014 (BITS 15-8)
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Reset State
CNEN1
00C0
CN15IE
CN14IE
CN13IE
CN12IE
CN11IE
CN10IE
CN9IE
CN8IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNEN2
00C2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU1
00C4
CN15PUE
CN14PUE
CN13PUE
CN12PUE
CN11PUE
CN10PUE
CN9PUE
CN8PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU2
00C6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 7-3:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F3014 (BITS 7-0)
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
CNEN1
00C0
CN7IE
CN6IE
CN5IE
CN4IE
CN3IE
CN2IE
CNEN2
00C2
—
—
—
—
—
CN18IE
CNPU1
00C4
CN7PUE
CN6PUE
CN5PUE
CN4PUE
CN3PUE
CN2PUE
CNPU2
00C6
—
—
—
—
—
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 7-4:
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CN1IE
CN0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN17IE
CN16IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN1PUE
CN0PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN18PUE CN17PUE
CN16PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F4013 (BITS 15-8)
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Reset State
CNEN1
00C0
CN15IE
CN14IE
CN13IE
CN12IE
CN11IE
CN10IE
CN9IE
CN8IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNEN2
00C2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU1
00C4
CN9PUE
CN8PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CNPU2
00C6
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
u = uninitialized bit
1:
CN15PUE CN14PUE CN13PUE CN12PUE CN11PUE CN10PUE
—
—
—
—
—
—
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 7-5:
INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION REGISTER MAP FOR dsPIC30F4013 (BITS 7-0)
SFR
Name
Addr.
CNEN1
00C0
CN7IE
CN6IE
CN5IE
CN4IE
CN3IE
CN2IE
CNEN2
00C2
CN23IE
CN22IE
CN21IE
CN20IE
CN19IE
CN18IE
CNPU1
00C4
CN7PUE
CN6PUE
CN5PUE
CN4PUE
CN3PUE
CN2PUE
CNPU2
00C6
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
DS70138E-page 54
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
CN1IE
CN0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN17IE
CN16IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN1PUE
CN0PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
CN23PUE CN22PUE CN21PUE CN20PUE CN19PUE CN18PUE CN17PUE
CN16PUE
0000 0000 0000 0000
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
8.0
INTERRUPTS
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
• INTCON1<15:0>, INTCON2<15:0>
Global interrupt control functions are derived from
these two registers. INTCON1 contains the control and status flags for the processor exceptions.
The INTCON2 register controls the external
interrupt request signal behavior and the use of
the alternate vector table.
Note:
The dsPIC30F sensor and general purpose families
have up to 41 interrupt sources and 4 processor exceptions (traps) which must be arbitrated based on a
priority scheme.
The CPU is responsible for reading the Interrupt Vector
Table (IVT) and transferring the address contained in
the interrupt vector to the program counter. The interrupt vector is transferred from the program data bus
into the program counter via a 24-bit wide multiplexer
on the input of the program counter.
The Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) and Alternate Interrupt
Vector Table (AIVT) are placed near the beginning of
program memory (0x000004). The IVT and AIVT are
shown in Figure 8-1.
The interrupt controller is responsible for preprocessing the interrupts and processor exceptions
prior to them being presented to the processor core.
The peripheral interrupts and traps are enabled,
prioritized and controlled using centralized Special
Function Registers:
• IFS0<15:0>, IFS1<15:0>, IFS2<15:0>
All interrupt request flags are maintained in these
three registers. The flags are set by their respective peripherals or external signals and they are
cleared via software.
• IEC0<15:0>, IEC1<15:0>, IEC2<15:0>
All interrupt enable control bits are maintained in
these three registers. These control bits are used
to individually enable interrupts from the
peripherals or external signals.
• IPC0<15:0>... IPC10<7:0>
The user assignable priority level associated with
each of these 41 interrupts is held centrally in
these eleven registers.
• IPL<3:0>
The current CPU priority level is explicitly stored
in the IPL bits. IPL<3> is present in the CORCON
register, whereas IPL<2:0> are present in the
STATUS register (SR) in the processor core.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Interrupt flag bits get set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an
interrupt.
All interrupt sources can be user assigned to one of 7
priority levels, 1 through 7, via the IPCx registers. Each
interrupt source is associated with an interrupt vector,
as shown in Table 8-1. Levels 7 and 1 represent the
highest and lowest maskable priorities, respectively.
Note:
Assigning a priority level of ‘0’ to an interrupt source is equivalent to disabling that
interrupt.
If the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1<15>) is set, nesting of
interrupts is prevented. Thus, if an interrupt is currently
being serviced, processing of a new interrupt is prevented even if the new interrupt is of higher priority than
the one currently being serviced.
Note:
The IPL bits become read-only whenever
the NSTDIS bit has been set to ‘1’.
Certain interrupts have specialized control bits for
features like edge or level triggered interrupts, interrupt-on-change, etc. Control of these features remains
within the peripheral module which generates the
interrupt.
The DISI instruction can be used to disable the
processing of interrupts of priorities 6 and lower for a
certain number of instructions, during which the DISI bit
(INTCON2<14>) remains set.
When an interrupt is serviced, the PC is loaded with the
address stored in the vector location in program memory that corresponds to the interrupt. There are 63 different vectors within the IVT (refer to Table 8-1) These
vectors are contained in locations 0x000004 through
0x0000FE of program memory (refer to Table 8-1).
These locations contain 24-bit addresses. In order to
preserve robustness, an address error trap takes place
should the PC attempt to fetch any of these words during normal execution. This prevents execution of random data as a result of accidentally decrementing a PC
into vector space, accidentally mapping a data space
address into vector space, or the PC rolling over to
0x000000 after reaching the end of implemented program memory space. Execution of a GOTO instruction
to this vector space also generates an address error
trap.
DS70138E-page 55
dsPIC30F3014/4013
8.1
Interrupt Priority
The user assignable interrupt priority (IP<2:0>) bits for
each individual interrupt source are located in the LS
3 bits of each nibble within the IPCx register(s). Bit 3 of
each nibble is not used and is read as a ‘0’. These bits
define the priority level assigned to a particular interrupt
by the user.
Note:
The user selectable priority levels start at
0 as the lowest priority and level 7 as the
highest priority.
Natural Order Priority is determined by the position of
an interrupt in the vector table, and only affects
interrupt operation when multiple interrupts with the
same user-assigned priority become pending at the
same time.
Table 8-1 and Table 8-2 list the interrupt numbers,
corresponding interrupt sources and associated vector
numbers for the dsPIC30F3014 and dsPIC30F4013
devices, respectively.
Note 1: The natural order priority scheme has 0
as the highest priority and 53 as the
lowest priority.
2: The natural order priority number is the
same as the INT number.
The ability for the user to assign every interrupt to one
of seven priority levels means that the user can assign
a very high overall priority level to an interrupt with a
low natural order priority. For example, the PLVD (LowVoltage Detect) can be given a priority of 7. The INT0
(External Interrupt 0) may be assigned to priority level
1, thus giving it a very low effective priority.
DS70138E-page 56
TABLE 8-1:
INT
Number
dsPIC30F3014 INTERRUPT
VECTOR TABLE
Vector
Number
Interrupt Source
Highest Natural Order Priority
0
8
INT0 – External Interrupt 0
1
9
IC1 – Input Capture 1
2
10
OC1 – Output Compare 1
3
4
5
6
7
11
12
13
14
15
8
9
10
11
12
13
16
17
18
19
20
21
T1 – Timer 1
IC2 – Input Capture 2
OC2 – Output Compare 2
T2 – Timer 2
T3 – Timer 3
SPI1
U1RX – UART1 Receiver
U1TX – UART1 Transmitter
ADC – ADC Convert Done
NVM – NVM Write Complete
SI2C – I2C™ Slave Interrupt
14
22
MI2C – I2C Master Interrupt
15
23
Input Change Interrupt
16
24
INT1 – External Interrupt 1
17-22
25-30 Reserved
23
31
INT2 – External Interrupt 2
24
32
U2RX – UART2 Receiver
25
33
U2TX – UART2 Transmitter
26
34
Reserved
27
35
C1 – Combined IRQ for CAN1
28-41
36-49 Reserved
42
50
LVD – Low-Voltage Detect
43-53
51-61 Reserved
Lowest Natural Order Priority
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 8-2:
INT
Number
dsPIC30F4013 INTERRUPT
VECTOR TABLE
Vector
Number
Interrupt Source
Highest Natural Order Priority
0
8
INT0 – External Interrupt 0
1
9
IC1 – Input Capture 1
2
10
OC1 – Output Compare 1
3
4
5
6
7
11
12
13
14
15
8
9
10
11
12
13
16
17
18
19
20
21
T1 – Timer 1
IC2 – Input Capture 2
OC2 – Output Compare 2
T2 V Timer 2
T3 – Timer 3
SPI1
U1RX – UART1 Receiver
U1TX – UART1 Transmitter
ADC – ADC Convert Done
NVM – NVM Write Complete
SI2C – I2C™ Slave Interrupt
14
22
MI2C – I2C Master Interrupt
15
23
Input Change Interrupt
16
24
INT1 – External Interrupt 1
17
25
IC7 – Input Capture 7
18
26
IC8 – Input Capture 8
19
27
OC3 – Output Compare 3
20
28
OC4 – Output Compare 4
21
29
T4 – Timer 4
22
30
T5 – Timer 5
23
31
INT2 – External Interrupt 2
24
32
U2RX – UART2 Receiver
25
33
U2TX – UART2 Transmitter
26
34
Reserved
27
35
C1 – Combined IRQ for CAN1
28-40
36-48 Reserved
41
49
DCI – CODEC Transfer Done
42
50
LVD – Low-Voltage Detect
43-53
51-61 Reserved
Lowest Natural Order Priority
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
8.2
Reset Sequence
A Reset is not a true exception because the interrupt
controller is not involved in the Reset process. The processor initializes its registers in response to a Reset
which forces the PC to zero. The processor then begins
program execution at location 0x000000. A GOTO
instruction is stored in the first program memory location immediately followed by the address target for the
GOTO instruction. The processor executes the GOTO to
the specified address and then begins operation at the
specified target (start) address.
8.2.1
RESET SOURCES
In addition to external Reset and Power-on Reset
(POR), these sources of error conditions ‘trap’ to the
Reset vector:
• Watchdog Time-out:
The watchdog has timed out, indicating that the
processor is no longer executing the correct flow
of code.
• Uninitialized W Register Trap:
An attempt to use an uninitialized W register as
an Address Pointer causes a Reset.
• Illegal Instruction Trap:
Attempted execution of any unused opcodes
results in an illegal instruction trap. Note that a
fetch of an illegal instruction does not result in an
illegal instruction trap if that instruction is flushed
prior to execution due to a flow change.
• Brown-out Reset (BOR):
A momentary dip in the power supply to the
device has been detected which may result in
malfunction.
• Trap Lockout:
Occurrence of multiple trap conditions
simultaneously causes a Reset.
DS70138E-page 57
dsPIC30F3014/4013
8.3
Traps
Traps can be considered as non-maskable interrupts
indicating a software or hardware error, which adhere
to a predefined priority as shown in Figure 8-1. They
are intended to provide the user a means to correct
erroneous operation during debug and when operating
within the application.
Note:
If the user does not intend to take corrective action in the event of a trap error
condition, these vectors must be loaded
with the address of a default handler that
simply contains the RESET instruction. If,
on the other hand, one of the vectors
containing an invalid address is called, an
address error trap is generated.
Note that many of these trap conditions can only be
detected when they occur. Consequently, the questionable instruction is allowed to complete prior to trap
exception processing. If the user chooses to recover
from the error, the result of the erroneous action that
caused the trap may have to be corrected.
Address Error Trap:
This trap is initiated when any of the following
circumstances occurs:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Note:
5.
6.
There are 8 fixed priority levels for traps: Level 8
through Level 15, which means that the IPL3 is always
set during processing of a trap.
If the user is not currently executing a trap, and he sets
the IPL<3:0> bits to a value of ‘0111’ (Level 7), then all
interrupts are disabled, but traps can still be processed.
8.3.1
Math Error Trap:
The math error trap executes under these circumstances:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Should an attempt be made to divide by zero,
the divide operation aborts on a cycle boundary
and the trap is taken.
If enabled, a math error trap is taken when an
arithmetic operation on either accumulator A or
B causes an overflow from bit 31 and the accumulator guard bits are not utilized.
If enabled, a math error trap is taken when an
arithmetic operation on either accumulator A or
B causes a catastrophic overflow from bit 39 and
all saturation is disabled.
If the shift amount specified in a shift instruction
is greater than the maximum allowed shift
amount, a trap occurs.
DS70138E-page 58
In the MAC class of instructions, wherein
the data space is split into X and Y data
space, unimplemented X space includes
all of Y space, and unimplemented Y
space includes all of X space.
Execution of a “BRA #literal” instruction or a
“GOTO #literal” instruction, where literal
is an unimplemented program memory address.
Executing instructions after modifying the PC to
point to unimplemented program memory
addresses. The PC may be modified by loading
a value into the stack and executing a RETURN
instruction.
Stack Error Trap:
This trap is initiated under the following conditions:
1.
TRAP SOURCES
The following traps are provided with increasing priority. However, since all traps can be nested, priority has
little effect.
A misaligned data word access is attempted.
A data fetch from our unimplemented data
memory location is attempted.
A data access of an unimplemented program
memory location is attempted.
An instruction fetch from vector space is
attempted.
2.
The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is greater than the (user programmable) limit
value written into the SPLIM register (stack
overflow).
The Stack Pointer is loaded with a value which
is less than 0x0800 (simple stack underflow).
Oscillator Fail Trap:
This trap is initiated if the external oscillator fails and
operation becomes reliant on an internal RC backup.
8.3.2
HARD AND SOFT TRAPS
It is possible that multiple traps can become active
within the same cycle (e.g., a misaligned word stack
write to an overflowed address). In such a case, the
fixed priority shown in Figure 8-2 is implemented,
which may require the user to check if other traps are
pending, in order to completely correct the Fault.
‘Soft’ traps include exceptions of priority level 8 through
level 11, inclusive. The arithmetic error trap (level 11)
falls into this category of traps.
‘Hard’ traps include exceptions of priority level 12
through level 15, inclusive. The address error (level
12), stack error (level 13) and oscillator error (level 14)
traps fall into this category.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
The device is automatically Reset in a hard trap conflict
condition. The TRAPR Status bit (RCON<15>) is set
when the Reset occurs so that the condition may be
detected in software.
Decreasing
Priority
FIGURE 8-1:
IVT
AIVT
8.4
TRAP VECTORS
Reset - GOTO Instruction
Reset - GOTO Address
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Oscillator Fail Trap Vector
Stack Error Trap Vector
Address Error Trap Vector
Math Error Trap Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Reserved Vector
Interrupt 0 Vector
Interrupt 1 Vector
—
—
—
Interrupt 52 Vector
Interrupt 53 Vector
0x000000
0x000002
0x000004
FIGURE 8-2:
0x0000 15
INTERRUPT STACK FRAME
0
PC<15:0>
SRL IPL3 PC<22:16>
<Free Word>
W15 (before CALL)
W15 (after CALL)
POP : [--W15]
PUSH: [W15++]
0x000014
0x00007E
0x000080
0x000082
0x000084
Note 1: The user can always lower the priority
level by writing a new value into SR. The
Interrupt Service Routine must clear the
interrupt flag bits in the IFSx register
before lowering the processor interrupt
priority, in order to avoid recursive
interrupts.
2: The IPL3 bit (CORCON<3>) is always
clear when interrupts are being processed. It is set only during execution of
traps.
0x000094
0x0000FE
Interrupt Sequence
All interrupt event flags are sampled in the beginning of
each instruction cycle by the IFSx registers. A pending
Interrupt Request (IRQ) is indicated by the flag bit
being equal to a ‘1’ in an IFSx register. The IRQ causes
an interrupt to occur if the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable (IECx) register is set. For the remainder of
the instruction cycle, the priorities of all pending interrupt requests are evaluated.
If there is a pending IRQ with a priority level greater
than the current processor priority level in the IPL bits,
the processor is interrupted.
The processor then stacks the current program counter
and the low byte of the processor STATUS register
(SRL), as shown in Figure 8-2. The low byte of the
STATUS register contains the processor priority level at
the time prior to the beginning of the interrupt cycle.
The processor then loads the priority level for this inter-
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
rupt into the STATUS register. This action disables all
lower priority interrupts until the completion of the
Interrupt Service Routine.
Stack Grows Towards
Higher Address
Each hard trap that occurs must be acknowledged
before code execution of any type may continue. If a
lower priority hard trap occurs while a higher priority
trap is pending, acknowledged, or is being processed,
a hard trap conflict occurs.
The RETFIE (return from interrupt) instruction unstacks
the program counter and STATUS registers to return
the processor to its state prior to the interrupt
sequence.
8.5
Alternate Vector Table
In program memory, the Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) is
followed by the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT),
as shown in Figure 8-1. Access to the alternate vector
table is provided by the ALTIVT bit in the INTCON2 register. If the ALTIVT bit is set, all interrupt and exception
processes use the alternate vectors instead of the
default vectors. The alternate vectors are organized in
the same manner as the default vectors. The AIVT supports emulation and debugging efforts by providing a
means to switch between an application and a support
environment without requiring the interrupt vectors to
be reprogrammed. This feature also enables switching
between applications for evaluation of different
software algorithms at run time.
If the AIVT is not required, the program memory
allocated to the AIVT may be used for other purposes.
AIVT is not a protected section and may be freely
programmed by the user.
DS70138E-page 59
dsPIC30F3014/4013
8.6
Fast Context Saving
A context saving option is available using shadow registers. Shadow registers are provided for the DC, N,
OV, Z and C bits in SR, and the registers W0 through
W3. The shadows are only one level deep. The shadow
registers are accessible using the PUSH.S and POP.S
instructions only.
When the processor vectors to an interrupt, the
PUSH.S instruction can be used to store the current
value of the aforementioned registers into their
respective shadow registers.
If an ISR of a certain priority uses the PUSH.S and
POP.S instructions for fast context saving, then a
higher priority ISR should not include the same instructions. Users must save the key registers in software
during a lower priority interrupt if the higher priority ISR
uses fast context saving.
DS70138E-page 60
8.7
External Interrupt Requests
The interrupt controller supports up to five external
interrupt request signals, INT0-INT4. These inputs are
edge sensitive; they require a low-to-high or a high-tolow transition to generate an interrupt request. The
INTCON2 register has three bits, INT0EP-INT2EP, that
select the polarity of the edge detection circuitry.
8.8
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle
The interrupt controller may be used to wake-up the
processor from either Sleep or Idle modes, if Sleep or
Idle mode is active when the interrupt is generated.
If an enabled interrupt request of sufficient priority is
received by the interrupt controller, then the standard
interrupt request is presented to the processor. At the
same time, the processor wakes up from Sleep or Idle
and begins execution of the Interrupt Service Routine
(ISR) needed to process the interrupt request.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 8-3:
SFR
Name
ADR
dsPIC30F3014 INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
STKERR OSCFAIL
Bit 0
Reset State
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
INTCON1
0080 NSTDIS
—
—
—
—
OVATE
OVBTE
COVTE
—
—
—
MATHERR
ADDRERR
INTCON2
0082 ALTIVT
DISI
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT2EP
INT1EP
IFS0
0084
CNIF
MI2CIF
SI2CIF
NVMIF
ADIF
U1TXIF
U1RXIF
SPI1IF
T3IF
T2IF
OC2IF
IC2IF
T1IF
OC1IF
IC1IF
INT0IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
INT0EP 0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS1
0086
—
—
—
—
C1IF
—
U2TXIF
U2RXIF
INT2IF
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT1IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS2
0088
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
IEC0
008C
CNIE
MI2CIE
SI2CIE
NVMIE
ADIE
SPI1IE
T3IE
T2IE
OC2IE
IC2IE
T1IE
OC1IE
IC1IE
INT0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
IEC1
008E
—
—
—
—
C1IE
—
U2TXIE
U2RXIE
INT2IE
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT1IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
IEC2
0090
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IPC0
0094
—
T1IP<2:0>
—
IPC1
0096
—
T31P<2:0>
IPC2
0098
—
ADIP<2:0>
IPC3
009A
—
CNIP<2:0>
IPC4
009C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IPC5
009E
—
INT2IP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
IPC6
00A0
—
C1IP<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
IPC7
00A2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0100 0100 0100 0100
IPC8
00A4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0100 0100 0100 0100
IPC9
00A6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0100 0100 0100
IPC10
00A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0100 0100 0000
2:
—
—
OC1IP<2:0>
—
—
T2IP<2:0>
—
U1TXIP<2:0>
—
MI2CIP<2:0>
LVDIP<2:0>
IC1IP<2:0>
—
—
OC2IP<2:0>
—
U1RXIP<2:0>
—
SI2CIP<2:0>
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
U2TXIP<2:0>
DCIIP<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
INT0IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
IC2IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
SPI1IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
NVMIP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
INT1IP<2:0>
—
—
—
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
U2RXIP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
0100 0100 0100 0100
DS70138E-page 61
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Legend:
—
U1TXIE U1RXIE
SFR
Name
ADR
dsPIC30F4013 INTERRUPT CONTROLLER REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
INTCON1
0080 NSTDIS
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
—
—
—
—
OVATE
OVBTE
COVTE
—
—
—
MATHERR
ADDRERR
Bit 2
Bit 1
STKERR OSCFAIL
Bit 0
Reset State
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
INTCON2
0082 ALTIVT
DISI
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
INT2EP
INT1EP
IFS0
0084
CNIF
MI2CIF
SI2CIF
NVMIF
ADIF
U1TXIF
U1RXIF
SPI1IF
T3IF
T2IF
OC2IF
IC2IF
T1IF
OC1IF
IC1IF
INT0IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS1
0086
—
—
—
—
C1IF
—
U2TXIF
U2RXIF
INT2IF
T5IF
T4IF
OC4IF
OC3IF
IC8IF
IC7IF
INT1IF
0000 0000 0000 0000
IFS2
0088
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIF
DCIIF
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
IEC0
008C
CNIE
MI2CIE
SI2CIE
NVMIE
ADIE
IEC1
008E
—
—
—
—
C1IE
—
IEC2
0090
—
—
—
—
—
LVDIE
IPC0
0094
—
T1IP<2:0>
—
IPC1
0096
—
T31P<2:0>
IPC2
0098
—
ADIP<2:0>
IPC3
009A
—
IPC4
009C
IPC5
U1TXIE U1RXIE
INT0EP 0000 0000 0000 0000
SPI1IE
T3IE
T2IE
OC2IE
IC2IE
T1IE
OC1IE
IC1IE
INT0IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
U2TXIE
U2RXIE
INT2IE
T5IE
T4IE
OC4IE
OC3IE
IC8IE
IC7IE
INT1IE
0000 0000 0000 0000
DCIIE
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
T2IP<2:0>
—
U1TXIP<2:0>
CNIP<2:0>
—
—
OC3IP<2:0>
009E
—
INT2IP<2:0>
IPC6
00A0
—
IPC7
00A2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0100 0100 0100 0100
IPC8
00A4
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0100 0100 0100 0100
IPC9
00A6
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0100 0100 0100
IPC10
00A8
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 0100 0100 0000
Legend:
1:
C1IP<2:0>
IC1IP<2:0>
—
—
OC2IP<2:0>
—
U1RXIP<2:0>
MI2CIP<2:0>
—
—
IC8IP<2:0>
—
T5IP<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
OC1IP<2:0>
—
SPI2IP<2:0>
LVDIP<2:0>
INT0IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
IC2IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
SPI1IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
SI2CIP<2:0>
—
NVMIP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
IC7IP<2:0>
—
INT1IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
T4IP<2:0>
—
OC4IP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
—
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
U2TXIP<2:0>
DCIIP<2:0>
—
U2RXIP<2:0>
0100 0100 0100 0100
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 62
TABLE 8-4:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
9.0
TIMER1 MODULE
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit SFR, T1CON. Figure 9-1
presents a block diagram of the 16-bit timer module.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
16-bit Timer Mode: In the 16-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle up to a match
value preloaded into the Period register PR1, then
resets to ‘0’ and continues to count.
This section describes the 16-bit general purpose
Timer1 module and associated operational modes.
Figure 9-1 depicts the simplified block diagram of the
16-bit Timer1 module.
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless the TSIDL (T1CON<13>) bit = 0.
If TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic resumes the incrementing sequence upon termination of the CPU Idle
mode.
The following sections provide a detailed description
including setup and control registers, along with
associated block diagrams for the operational modes of
the timers.
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in
PR1, then resets to ‘0’ and continues.
The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer which can serve as
the time counter for the real-time clock, or operate as a
free-running interval timer/counter. The 16-bit timer
has the following modes:
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless the respective TSIDL bit = 0. If
TSIDL = 1, the timer module logic resumes the incrementing sequence upon termination of the CPU Idle
mode.
• 16-bit Timer
• 16-bit Synchronous Counter
• 16-bit Asynchronous Counter
Further, the following operational characteristics are
supported:
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode: In the 16-bit
Asynchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
every rising edge of the applied external clock signal.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in
PR1, then resets to ‘0’ and continues.
• Timer gate operation
• Selectable prescaler settings
• Timer operation during CPU Idle and Sleep
modes
• Interrupt on 16-bit Period register match or falling
edge of external gate signal
FIGURE 9-1:
When the timer is configured for the Asynchronous
mode of operation and the CPU goes into the Idle
mode, the timer stops incrementing if TSIDL = 1.
16-BIT TIMER1 MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR1
Equal
Comparator x 16
TSYNC
1
Reset
Sync
TMR1
0
T1IF
Event Flag
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
TGATE
TON
SOSCO/
T1CK
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
LPOSCEN
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
SOSCI
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 63
dsPIC30F3014/4013
9.1
Timer Gate Operation
The 16-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accumulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input signal (T1CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T1CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. The
timer must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock
source set to internal (TCS = 0).
When the CPU goes into the Idle mode, the timer stops
incrementing unless TSIDL = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer
resumes the incrementing sequence upon termination
of the CPU Idle mode.
9.2
Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the 16-bit
Timer has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64 and 1:256,
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T1CON<5:4>).
The prescaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
• a write to the TMR1 register
• a write to the T1CON register
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
timer prescaler cannot be reset since the prescaler
clock is halted.
TMR1 is not cleared when T1CON is written. It is
cleared by writing to the TMR1 register.
9.3
9.4
Timer Interrupt
The 16-bit timer has the ability to generate an interrupton-period match. When the timer count matches the
Period register, the T1IF bit is asserted and an interrupt
is generated, if enabled. The T1IF bit must be cleared in
software. The timer interrupt flag, T1IF, is located in the
IFS0 Control register in the interrupt controller.
When the Gated Time Accumulation mode is enabled,
an interrupt is also generated on the falling edge of the
gate signal (at the end of the accumulation cycle).
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective timer interrupt enable bit, T1IE. The timer interrupt
enable bit is located in the IEC0 Control register in the
interrupt controller.
9.5
Real-Time Clock
Timer1, when operating in Real-Time Clock (RTC)
mode, provides time of day and event time-stamping
capabilities. Key operational features of the RTC are:
•
•
•
•
Operation from 32 kHz LP oscillator
8-bit prescaler
Low power
Real-Time Clock interrupts
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the T1CON Control register.
FIGURE 9-2:
RECOMMENDED
COMPONENTS FOR
TIMER1 LP OSCILLATOR
RTC
Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
During CPU Sleep mode, the timer operates if:
• The timer module is enabled (TON = 1) and
• The timer clock source is selected as external
(TCS = 1) and
• The TSYNC bit (T1CON<2>) is asserted to a logic
‘0’ which defines the external clock source as
asynchronous.
C1
SOSCI
32.768 kHz
XTAL
dsPIC30FXXXX
SOSCO
C2
R
When all three conditions are true, the timer continues
to count up to the Period register and is reset to
0x0000.
When a match between the timer and the Period
register occurs, an interrupt can be generated if the
respective timer interrupt enable bit is asserted.
DS70138E-page 64
C1 = C2 = 18 pF; R = 100K
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
9.5.1
RTC OSCILLATOR OPERATION
When the TON = 1, TCS = 1 and TGATE = 0, the timer
increments on the rising edge of the 32 kHz LP oscillator output signal, up to the value specified in the Period
register and is then reset to ‘0’.
The TSYNC bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’
(Asynchronous mode) for correct operation.
Enabling LPOSCEN (OSCCON<1>) disables the normal Timer and Counter modes and enable a timer
carry-out wake-up event.
9.5.2
RTC INTERRUPTS
When an interrupt event occurs, the respective interrupt
flag, T1IF, is asserted and an interrupt is generated, if
enabled. The T1IF bit must be cleared in software. The
respective Timer interrupt flag, T1IF, is located in the
IFS0 STATUS register in the interrupt controller.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective timer interrupt enable bit, T1IE. The timer interrupt
enable bit is located in the IEC0 Control register in the
interrupt controller.
When the CPU enters Sleep mode, the RTC continues
to operate, provided the 32 kHz external crystal oscillator is active and the control bits have not been
changed. The TSIDL bit should be cleared to ‘0’ in
order for RTC to continue operation in Idle mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 65
SFR Name
Addr.
TMR1
0100
PR1
0102
T1CON
0104
Legend:
2:
dsPIC30F3014/4013 TIMER1 REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Timer1 Register
Period Register 1
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TGATE
Reset State
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
1111 1111 1111 1111
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
—
TSYNC
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 66
TABLE 9-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
10.0
TIMER2/3 MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
This section describes the 32-bit general purpose
Timer module (Timer2/3) and associated operational
modes. Figure 10-1 depicts the simplified block diagram of the 32-bit Timer2/3 module. Figure 10-2 and
Figure 10-3 show Timer2/3 configured as two
independent 16-bit timers, Timer2 and Timer3,
respectively.
The Timer2/3 module is a 32-bit timer (which can be
configured as two 16-bit timers) with selectable
operating modes. These timers are utilized by other
peripheral modules, such as:
• Input Capture
• Output Compare/Simple PWM
The following sections provide a detailed description,
including setup and control registers, along with
associated block diagrams for the operational modes of
the timers.
The 32-bit timer has the following modes:
• Two independent 16-bit timers (Timer2 and
Timer3) with all 16-bit operating modes (except
Asynchronous Counter mode)
• Single 32-bit timer operation
• Single 32-bit synchronous counter
Further, the following operational characteristics are
supported:
•
•
•
•
•
ADC event trigger
Timer gate operation
Selectable prescaler settings
Timer operation during Idle and Sleep modes
Interrupt on a 32-bit period register match
16-bit Timer Mode: In the 16-bit mode, Timer2 and
Timer3 can be configured as two independent 16-bit
timers. Each timer can be set up in either 16-bit Timer
mode or 16-bit Synchronous Counter mode. See
Section 9.0 “Timer1 Module” for details on these two
operating modes.
The only functional difference between Timer2 and
Timer3 is that Timer2 provides synchronization of the
clock prescaler output. This is useful for high-frequency
external clock inputs.
32-bit Timer Mode: In the 32-bit Timer mode, the timer
increments on every instruction cycle, up to a match
value preloaded into the combined 32-bit Period
register, PR3/PR2, then resets to ‘0’ and continues to
count.
For synchronous 32-bit reads of the Timer2/Timer3
pair, reading the lsw (TMR2 register) causes the msw
to be read and latched into a 16-bit holding register,
termed TMR3HLD.
For synchronous 32-bit writes, the holding register
(TMR3HLD) must first be written to. When followed by
a write to the TMR2 register, the contents of TMR3HLD
is transferred and latched into the MSB of the 32-bit
timer (TMR3).
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode: In the 32-bit
Synchronous Counter mode, the timer increments on
the rising edge of the applied external clock signal
which is synchronized with the internal phase clocks.
The timer counts up to a match value preloaded in the
combined 32-bit period register, PR3/PR2, then resets
to ‘0’ and continues.
When the timer is configured for the Synchronous
Counter mode of operation and the CPU goes into the
Idle mode, the timer stops incrementing unless the
TSIDL (T2CON<13>) bit = 0. If TSIDL = 1, the timer
module logic resumes the incrementing sequence
upon termination of the CPU Idle mode.
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit T2CON and T3CON
SFRs.
For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer2 is the lsw
and Timer3 is the msw of the 32-bit timer.
Note:
For 32-bit timer operation, T3CON control
bits are ignored. Only T2CON control bits
are used for setup and control. Timer2
clock and gate inputs are utilized for the
32-bit timer module, but an interrupt is
generated with the Timer3 interrupt flag
(T3IF) and the interrupt is enabled with the
Timer3 interrupt enable bit (T3IE).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 67
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 10-1:
32-BIT TIMER2/3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<15:0>
TMR3HLD
16
16
Write TMR2
Read TMR2
16
Reset
TMR3
TMR2
MSB
LSB
Sync
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Comparator x 32
PR3
T3IF
Event Flag
PR2
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE (T2CON<6>)
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
(T2CON<6>)
TON
T2CK
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Timer Configuration bit T32 (T2CON<3>) must be set to ‘1’ for a 32-bit timer/counter operation. All control
bits are respective to the T2CON register.
DS70138E-page 68
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 10-2:
16-BIT TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR2
Equal
Reset
T2IF
Event Flag
Comparator x 16
TMR2
Sync
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
TON
T2CK
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
FIGURE 10-3:
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
16-BIT TIMER3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR3
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Comparator x 16
TMR3
Reset
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
T3CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
T3IF
Event Flag
Sync
TON
1x
01
TCY
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
00
T3CK pin does not exist on dsPIC30F3014/4013 devices. The block diagram shown here illustrates the
schematic of Timer3 as implemented on the dsPIC30F6014 device.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 69
dsPIC30F3014/4013
10.1
Timer Gate Operation
The 32-bit timer can be placed in the Gated Time Accumulation mode. This mode allows the internal TCY to
increment the respective timer when the gate input
signal (T2CK pin) is asserted high. Control bit, TGATE
(T2CON<6>), must be set to enable this mode. When
in this mode, Timer2 is the originating clock source.
The TGATE setting is ignored for Timer3. The timer
must be enabled (TON = 1) and the timer clock source
set to internal (TCS = 0).
The falling edge of the external signal terminates the
count operation but does not reset the timer. The user
must reset the timer in order to start counting from zero.
10.2
ADC Event Trigger
When a match occurs between the 32-bit timer (TMR3/
TMR2) and the 32-bit combined period register (PR3/
PR2), a special ADC trigger event signal is generated
by Timer3.
10.3
10.4
Timer Operation During Sleep
Mode
During CPU Sleep mode, the timer does not operate
because the internal clocks are disabled.
10.5
Timer Interrupt
The 32-bit timer module can generate an interrupt-onperiod match or on the falling edge of the external gate
signal. When the 32-bit timer count matches the
respective 32-bit period register, or the falling edge of
the external “gate” signal is detected, the T3IF bit
(IFS0<7>) is asserted and an interrupt is generated, if
enabled. In this mode, the T3IF interrupt flag is used as
the source of the interrupt. The T3IF bit must be
cleared in software.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the
respective timer interrupt enable bit, T3IE (IEC0<7>).
Timer Prescaler
The input clock (FOSC/4 or external clock) to the timer
has a prescale option of 1:1, 1:8, 1:64, and 1:256,
selected by control bits, TCKPS<1:0> (T2CON<5:4>
and T3CON<5:4>). For the 32-bit timer operation, the
originating clock source is Timer2. The prescaler operation for Timer3 is not applicable in this mode. The
prescaler counter is cleared when any of the following
occurs:
• a write to the TMR2/TMR3 register
• a write to the T2CON/T3CON register
• device Reset, such as POR and BOR
However, if the timer is disabled (TON = 0), then the
Timer 2 prescaler cannot be reset since the prescaler
clock is halted.
TMR2/TMR3 is not cleared when T2CON/T3CON is
written.
DS70138E-page 70
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 10-1:
dsPIC30F3014/4013 TIMER2/3 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TMR2
0106
Timer2 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR3HLD
0108
Timer3 Holding Register (for 32-bit timer operations only)
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR3
010A
Timer3 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
PR2
010C
Period Register 2
1111 1111 1111 1111
PR3
010E
Period Register 3
T2CON
0110
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
T32
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
T3CON
0112
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1 TCKPS0
—
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
3:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
1111 1111 1111 1111
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 71
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 72
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
11.0
TIMER4/5 MODULE
The operating modes of the Timer4/5 module are determined by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the 16-bit
T4CON and T5CON SFRs.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual (DS70046).
For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer4 is the lsw
and Timer5 is the msw of the 32-bit timer.
Note:
This section describes the second 32-bit general
purpose Timer module (Timer4/5) and associated
operational modes. Figure 11-1 depicts the simplified
block diagram of the 32-bit Timer4/5 module.
Figure 11-2 and Figure 11-3 show Timer4/5 configured
as two independent 16-bit timers, Timer4 and Timer5,
respectively.
For 32-bit timer operation, T5CON control
bits are ignored. Only T4CON control bits
are used for setup and control. Timer4
clock and gate inputs are utilized for the
32-bit timer module but an interrupt is
generated with the Timer5 interrupt flag
(T5IF) and the interrupt is enabled with the
Timer5 interrupt enable bit (T5IE).
The Timer4/5 module is similar in operation to the
Timer2/3 module. However, there are some
differences which are listed:
• The Timer4/5 module does not support the ADC
event trigger feature
• Timer4/5 can not be utilized by other peripheral
modules, such as input capture and output compare
FIGURE 11-1:
32-BIT TIMER4/5 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<15:0>
TMR5HLD
16
16
Write TMR4
Read TMR4
16
Reset
Equal
TMR5
TMR4
MSB
LSB
Sync
Comparator x 32
PR5
PR4
0
T5IF
Event Flag
1
Q
Q
D
TGATE (T4CON<6>)
CK
TCS
TGATE
TGATE
(T4CON<6>)
TON
T4CK
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
Timer Configuration bit T32 (T4CON<3>) must be set to ‘1’ for a 32-bit timer/counter operation. All control
bits are respective to the T4CON register.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 73
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 11-2:
16-BIT TIMER4 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR4
Equal
Reset
TMR4
Sync
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
T4IF
Event Flag
Comparator x 16
TGATE
TON
T4CK
FIGURE 11-3:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
1x
Gate
Sync
01
TCY
00
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
16-BIT TIMER5 BLOCK DIAGRAM
PR5
ADC Event Trigger
Equal
Reset
TMR5
0
1
Q
D
Q
CK
TGATE
TCS
TGATE
T5IF
Event Flag
Comparator x 16
TGATE
T5CK
TON
Sync
1x
01
TCY
Note:
TCKPS<1:0>
2
Prescaler
1, 8, 64, 256
00
In the dsPIC30F3014 device, there is no T5CK pin. Therefore, in this device the following modes should
not be used for Timer5:
4: TCS = 1 (16-bit counter)
5: TCS = 0, TGATE = 1 (gated time accumulation)
DS70138E-page 74
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 11-1:
SFR Name
Addr.
dsPIC30F4013 TIMER4/5 REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
TMR4
0114
Timer 4 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR5HLD
0116
Timer 5 Holding Register (for 32-bit operations only)
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TMR5
0118
Timer 5 Register
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
PR4
011A
Period Register 4
1111 1111 1111 1111
PR5
011C
Period Register 5
T4CON
011E
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1
TCKPS0
T32
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
0120
TON
—
TSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
TGATE
TCKPS1
TCKPS0
—
—
TCS
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
T5CON
Legend:
1:
1111 1111 1111 1111
u = uninitialized
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 75
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 76
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
12.0
INPUT CAPTURE MODULE
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits in the ICxCON register (where
x = 1,2,...,N). The dsPIC DSC devices contain up to 8
capture channels (i.e., the maximum value of N is 8).
The dsPIC30F3014 device contains 2 capture
channels while the dsPIC30F4013 device contains 4
capture channels.
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
This section describes the input capture module and
associated operational modes. The features provided
by this module are useful in applications requiring frequency (period) and pulse measurement. Figure 12-1
depicts a block diagram of the input capture module.
Input capture is useful for such modes as:
12.1
Simple Capture Event Mode
The simple capture events in the dsPIC30F product
family are:
•
•
•
•
•
• Frequency/Period/Pulse Measurements
• Additional Sources of External Interrupts
The key operational features of the input capture
module are:
Capture every falling edge
Capture every rising edge
Capture every 4th rising edge
Capture every 16th rising edge
Capture every rising and falling edge
These simple Input Capture modes are configured by
setting the appropriate bits, ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>).
• Simple Capture Event mode
• Timer2 and Timer3 mode selection
• Interrupt on input capture event
12.1.1
CAPTURE PRESCALER
There are four input capture prescaler settings specified by bits ICM<2:0> (ICxCON<2:0>). Whenever the
capture channel is turned off, the prescaler counter is
cleared. In addition, any Reset clears the prescaler
counter.
FIGURE 12-1:
INPUT CAPTURE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
From GP Timer Module
T3_CNT
T2_CNT
16
1
ICx pin
Prescaler
1, 4, 16
3
Clock
Synchronizer
Edge
Detection
Logic
16
0
ICTMR
FIFO
R/W
Logic
ICM<2:0>
Mode Select
ICxBUF
ICBNE, ICOV
ICI<1:0>
ICxCON
Data Bus
Note:
Interrupt
Logic
Set Flag
ICxIF
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers or bits associated to the respective input capture
channels 1 through N.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 77
dsPIC30F3014/4013
12.1.2
CAPTURE BUFFER OPERATION
Each capture channel has an associated FIFO buffer
which is four 16-bit words deep. There are two status
flags which provide status on the FIFO buffer:
• ICBNE – Input Capture Buffer Not Empty
• ICOV – Input Capture Overflow
The ICBFNE is set on the first input capture event and
remain set until all capture events have been read from
the FIFO. As each word is read from the FIFO, the
remaining words are advanced by one position within
the buffer.
In the event that the FIFO is full with four capture
events and a fifth capture event occurs prior to a read
of the FIFO, an overflow condition occurs and the ICOV
bit is set to a logic ‘1’. The fifth capture event is lost and
is not stored in the FIFO. No additional events are
captured until all four events have been read from the
buffer.
If a FIFO read is performed after the last read and no
new capture event has been received, the read will
yield indeterminate results.
12.1.3
TIMER2 AND TIMER3 SELECTION
MODE
The input capture module consists of up to 8 input capture channels. Each channel can select between one of
two timers for the time base, Timer2 or Timer3.
Selection of the timer resource is accomplished
through SFR bit, ICTMR (ICxCON<7>). Timer3 is the
default timer resource available for the input capture
module.
12.1.4
HALL SENSOR MODE
When the input capture module is set for capture on
every edge, rising and falling, ICM<2:0> = 001, the
following operations are performed by the input capture
logic:
• The input capture interrupt flag is set on every
edge, rising and falling.
• The interrupt on Capture mode setting bits,
ICI<1:0>, is ignored since every capture
generates an interrupt.
• A capture overflow condition is not generated in
this mode.
12.2
Input Capture Operation During
Sleep and Idle Modes
An input capture event generates a device wake-up or
interrupt, if enabled, if the device is in CPU Idle or Sleep
mode.
Independent of the timer being enabled, the input capture module wakes up from the CPU Sleep or Idle mode
when a capture event occurs if ICM<2:0> = 111 and the
interrupt enable bit is asserted. The same wake-up can
generate an interrupt if the conditions for processing the
interrupt have been satisfied. The wake-up feature is
useful as a method of adding extra external pin
interrupts.
12.2.1
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU SLEEP
MODE
CPU Sleep mode allows input capture module operation with reduced functionality. In the CPU Sleep mode,
the ICI<1:0> bits are not applicable and the input capture module can only function as an external interrupt
source.
The capture module must be configured for interrupt
only on rising edge (ICM<2:0> = 111) in order for the
input capture module to be used while the device is in
Sleep mode. The prescale settings of 4:1 or 16:1 are
not applicable in this mode.
12.2.2
INPUT CAPTURE IN CPU IDLE
MODE
CPU Idle mode allows input capture module operation
with full functionality. In the CPU Idle mode, the Interrupt mode selected by the ICI<1:0> bits is applicable,
as well as the 4:1 and 16:1 capture prescale settings
which are defined by control bits ICM<2:0>. This mode
requires the selected timer to be enabled. Moreover,
the ICSIDL bit must be asserted to a logic ‘0’.
If the input capture module is defined as
ICM<2:0> = 111 in CPU Idle mode, the input capture
pin serves only as an external interrupt pin.
12.3
Input Capture Interrupts
The input capture channels have the ability to generate
an interrupt based upon the selected number of
capture events. The selection number is set by control
bits, ICI<1:0> (ICxCON<6:5>).
Each channel provides an interrupt flag (ICxIF) bit. The
respective capture channel interrupt flag is located in
the corresponding IFSx STATUS register.
Enabling an interrupt is accomplished via the respective capture channel interrupt enable (ICxIE) bit. The
capture interrupt enable bit is located in the
corresponding IEC Control register.
DS70138E-page 78
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 12-1:
SFR Name
Addr.
IC1BUF
0140
IC1CON
0142
IC2BUF
0144
IC2CON
0146
Legend:
1:
dsPIC30F3014 INPUT CAPTURE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
—
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 0
Input 1 Capture Register
—
ICTMR
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
Input 2 Capture Register
—
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
Reset State
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 12-2:
SFR Name
Addr.
IC1BUF
0140
IC1CON
0142
IC2BUF
0144
IC2CON
0146
IC7BUF
0158
IC7CON
015A
IC8BUF
015C
IC8CON
015E
Legend:
dsPIC30F4013 INPUT CAPTURE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 1
Input 1 Capture Register
—
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
—
ICSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
ICTMR
ICI<1:0>
ICOV
ICBNE
ICM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
Input 8 Capture Register
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
Input 7 Capture Register
—
Reset State
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
Input 2 Capture Register
—
Bit 0
0000 0000 0000 0000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
0000 0000 0000 0000
u = uninitialized bit
1:
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 79
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 80
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
13.0
OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
This section describes the output compare module and
associated operational modes. The features provided
by this module are useful in applications requiring
operational modes, such as:
• Generation of Variable Width Output Pulses
• Power Factor Correction
Figure 13-1 depicts a block diagram of the output
compare module.
The key operational features of the output compare
module include:
• Timer2 and Timer3 Selection mode
• Simple Output Compare Match mode
• Dual Output Compare Match mode
FIGURE 13-1:
• Simple PWM mode
• Output Compare During Sleep and Idle modes
• Interrupt on Output Compare/PWM Event
These operating modes are determined by setting the
appropriate bits in the 16-bit OCxCON SFR (where
x = 1,2,3,...,N). The dsPIC DSC devices contain up to
8 compare channels (i.e., the maximum value of N is 8).
The dsPIC30F3014 device contains 2 compare
channels while the dsPIC30F4013 device contains 4
compare channels.
OCxRS and OCxR in Figure 13-1 represent the Dual
Compare registers. In the Dual Compare mode, the
OCxR register is used for the first compare and OCxRS
is used for the second compare.
13.1
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode
Each output compare channel can select between one
of two 16-bit timers, Timer2 or Timer3.
The selection of the timers is controlled by the OCTSEL
bit (OCxCON<3>). Timer2 is the default timer resource
for the output compare module.
OUTPUT COMPARE MODE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Set Flag bit
OCxIF
OCxRS
Output
Logic
OCxR
3
1
OCTSEL
0
1
Note:
OCx
OCFA
(for x = 1, 2, 3 or 4)
or OCFB
(for x = 5, 6, 7 or 8)
From GP
Timer Module
TMR2<15:0
Output
Enable
OCM<2:0>
Mode Select
Comparator
0
S Q
R
TMR3<15:0> T2P2_MATCH
T3P3_MATCH
Where ‘x’ is shown, reference is made to the registers associated with the respective output compare
channels 1 through N.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 81
dsPIC30F3014/4013
13.2
Simple Output Compare Match
Mode
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 001,
010 or 011, the selected output compare channel is
configured for one of three simple Output Compare
Match modes:
13.3.2
CONTINUOUS PULSE MODE
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a continuous stream of output pulses, the following
steps are required:
The OCxR register is used in these modes. The OCxR
register is loaded with a value and is compared to the
selected incrementing timer count. When a compare
occurs, one of these Compare Match modes occurs. If
the counter resets to zero before reaching the value in
OCxR, the state of the OCx pin remains unchanged.
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse value based on TCY.
• Calculate timer to Start pulse width from timer
start value of 0x0000.
• Write pulse width Start and Stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS (x denotes channel 1, 2, ...,N)
Compare registers, respectively.
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to or
greater than value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 101.
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
13.3
13.4
• Compare forces I/O pin low
• Compare forces I/O pin high
• Compare toggles I/O pin
Dual Output Compare Match Mode
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 100
or 101, the selected output compare channel is configured for one of two Dual Output Compare modes,
which are:
• Single Output Pulse mode
• Continuous Output Pulse mode
13.3.1
SINGLE PULSE MODE
For the user to configure the module for the generation
of a single output pulse, the following steps are
required (assuming timer is off):
• Determine instruction cycle time TCY.
• Calculate desired pulse width value based on TCY.
• Calculate time to Start pulse from timer start value
of 0x0000.
• Write pulse width start and stop times into OCxR
and OCxRS Compare registers (x denotes
channel 1, 2, ...,N).
• Set Timer Period register to value equal to or
greater than value in OCxRS Compare register.
• Set OCM<2:0> = 100.
• Enable timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
To initiate another single pulse, issue another write to
set OCM<2:0> = 100.
Simple PWM Mode
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 110
or 111, the selected output compare channel is configured for the PWM mode of operation. When configured
for the PWM mode of operation, OCxR is the main latch
(read-only) and OCxRS is the secondary latch. This
enables glitchless PWM transitions.
The user must perform the following steps in order to
configure the output compare module for PWM
operation:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Set the PWM period by writing to the appropriate
period register.
Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the OCxRS
register.
Configure the output compare module for PWM
operation.
Set the TMRx prescale value and enable the
Timer, TON (TxCON<15>) = 1.
13.4.1
INPUT PIN FAULT PROTECTION
FOR PWM
When control bits OCM<2:0> (OCxCON<2:0>) = 111,
the selected output compare channel is again configured for the PWM mode of operation with the additional
feature of input Fault protection. While in this mode, if
a logic ‘0’ is detected on the OCFA/B pin, the respective
PWM output pin is placed in the high-impedance input
state. The OCFLT bit (OCxCON<4>) indicates whether
a Fault condition has occurred. This state is maintained
until both of the following events have occurred:
• The external Fault condition has been removed.
• The PWM mode has been re-enabled by writing
to the appropriate control bits.
DS70138E-page 82
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
13.4.2
PWM PERIOD
When the selected TMRx is equal to its respective
period register, PRx, the following four events occur on
the next increment cycle:
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PRx
register. The PWM period can be calculated using
Equation 13-1.
• TMRx is cleared.
• The OCx pin is set.
- Exception 1: If PWM duty cycle is 0x0000,
the OCx pin remains low.
- Exception 2: If duty cycle is greater than PRx,
the pin remains high.
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from OCxRS into
OCxR.
• The corresponding timer interrupt flag is set.
EQUATION 13-1:
PWM period = [(PRx) + 1] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMRx prescale value)
PWM frequency is defined as 1/[PWM period].
See Figure 13-2 for key PWM period comparisons.
Timer3 is referred to in Figure 13-2 for clarity.
FIGURE 13-2:
PWM OUTPUT TIMING
Period
Duty Cycle
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
OCxR = OCxRS
TMR3 = PR3
T3IF = 1
(Interrupt Flag)
OCxR = OCxRS
TMR3 = Duty Cycle
(OCxR)
13.5
Output Compare Operation During
CPU Sleep Mode
When the CPU enters Sleep mode, all internal clocks
are stopped. Therefore, when the CPU enters the
Sleep state, the output compare channel drives the pin
to the active state that was observed prior to entering
the CPU Sleep state.
For example, if the pin was high when the CPU entered
the Sleep state, the pin remains high. Likewise, if the
pin was low when the CPU entered the Sleep state, the
pin remains low. In either case, the output compare
module resumes operation when the device wakes up.
13.6
Output Compare Operation During
CPU Idle Mode
When the CPU enters the Idle mode, the output
compare module can operate with full functionality.
The output compare channel operates during the CPU
Idle mode if the OCSIDL bit (OCxCON<13>) is at logic
‘0’ and the selected time base (Timer2 or Timer3) is
enabled and the TSIDL bit of the selected timer is set
to logic ‘0’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TMR3 = Duty Cycle
(OCxR)
13.7
Output Compare Interrupts
The output compare channels have the ability to generate an interrupt on a compare match, for whichever
Match mode has been selected.
For all modes, except the PWM mode, when a compare event occurs, the respective interrupt flag (OCxIF)
is asserted and an interrupt is generated, if enabled.
The OCxIF bit is located in the corresponding IFS
STATUS register and must be cleared in software. The
interrupt is enabled via the respective compare interrupt enable (OCxIE) bit located in the corresponding
IEC Control register.
For the PWM mode, when an event occurs, the respective timer interrupt flag (T2IF or T3IF) is asserted and
an interrupt is generated, if enabled. The IF bit is
located in the IFS0 STATUS register and must be
cleared in software. The interrupt is enabled via the
respective timer interrupt enable bit (T2IE or T3IE)
located in the IEC0 Control register. The output
compare interrupt flag is never set during the PWM
mode of operation.
DS70138E-page 83
SFR Name
Addr.
OC1RS
0180
OC1R
0182
OC1CON
0184
dsPIC30F3014 OUTPUT COMPARE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
—
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
Bit 1
Bit 0
0186
Output Compare 2 Secondary Register
Output Compare 2 Main Register
OC2CON
018A
—
—
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
Reset State
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
0188
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
—
OCFLT
OCTSE
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 13-2:
Addr.
dsPIC30F4013 OUTPUT COMPARE REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
OC1RS
0180
Output Compare 1 Secondary Register
OC1R
0182
Output Compare 1 Main Register
OC1CON
0184
OC2RS
0186
Output Compare 2 Secondary Register
OC2R
0188
Output Compare 2 Main Register
OC2CON
018A
OC3RS
018C
Output Compare 3 Secondary Register
OC3R
018E
Output Compare 3 Main Register
OC3CON
0190
OC4RS
0192
Output Compare 4 Secondary Register
OC4R
0194
Output Compare 4 Main Register
OC4CON
0196
Legend:
1:
Bit 2
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OC2R
SFR Name
Bit 3
Output Compare 1 Main Register
—
OC2RS
Legend:
1:
Bit 4
Output Compare 1 Secondary Register
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
OCSIDL
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
—
—
—
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSE
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
OCFLT
OCTSEL
OCM<2:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 84
TABLE 13-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
14.0
I2C MODULE
14.1.1
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the 'dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual' (DS70046).
2
The following types of I2C operation are supported:
•
•
•
I2C slave operation with 7-bit address
I2C slave operation with 10-bit address
I2C master operation with 7 or 10-bit address
See the I2C programmer’s model in Figure 14-1.
TM
The Inter-Integrated Circuit (I C ) module provides
complete hardware support for both Slave and MultiMaster modes of the I2C serial communication
standard, with a 16-bit interface.
This module offers the following key features:
• I2C interface supporting both master and slave
operation.
• I2C Slave mode supports 7 and 10-bit address.
• I2C Master mode supports 7 and 10-bit address.
• I2C port allows bidirectional transfers between
master and slaves.
• Serial clock synchronization for I2C port can be
used as a handshake mechanism to suspend and
resume serial transfer (SCLREL control).
• I2C supports multi-master operation; detects bus
collision and arbitrates accordingly.
14.1
Operating Function Description
The hardware fully implements all the master and slave
functions of the I2C Standard and Fast mode
specifications, as well as 7 and 10-bit addressing.
Thus, the I2C module can operate either as a slave or
a master on an I2C bus.
14.1.2
PIN CONFIGURATION IN I2C MODE
I2C has a 2-pin interface: the SCL pin is clock and the
SDA pin is data.
14.1.3
I2C REGISTERS
I2CCON and I2CSTAT are control and STATUS registers, respectively. The I2CCON register is readable and
writable. The lower 6 bits of I2CSTAT are read-only.
The remaining bits of the I2CSTAT are read/write.
I2CRSR is the shift register used for shifting data,
whereas I2CRCV is the buffer register to which data
bytes are written, or from which data bytes are read.
I2CRCV is the receive buffer as shown in Figure 14-1.
I2CTRN is the transmit register to which bytes are
written during a transmit operation, as shown in
Figure 14-2.
The I2CADD register holds the slave address. A Status
bit, ADD10, indicates 10-bit Address mode. The
I2CBRG acts as the Baud Rate Generator reload
value.
In receive operations, I2CRSR and I2CRCV together
form a double-buffered receiver. When I2CRSR
receives a complete byte, it is transferred to I2CRCV
and an interrupt pulse is generated. During
transmission, the I2CTRN is not double-buffered.
Note:
FIGURE 14-1:
VARIOUS I2C MODES
Following a Restart condition in 10-bit
mode, the user only needs to match the
first 7-bit address.
PROGRAMMER’S MODEL
I2CRCV (8 bits)
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 0
I2CTRN (8 bits)
I2CBRG (9 bits)
Bit 8
Bit 0
I2CCON (16 bits)
Bit 15
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 0
I2CSTAT (16 bits)
I2CADD (10 bits)
Bit 9
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Bit 0
DS70138E-page 85
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 14-2:
I2C™ BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
I2CRCV
Read
SCL
Shift
Clock
I2CRSR
LSB
SDA
Addr_Match
Match Detect
Write
I2CADD
Read
Start and
Stop bit Detect
I2CSTAT
Write
Control Logic
Start, Restart,
Stop bit Generate
Write
I2CCON
Collision
Detect
Acknowledge
Generation
Clock
Stretching
Read
Read
Write
I2CTRN
LSB
Shift
Clock
Read
Reload
Control
BRG Down
Counter
DS70138E-page 86
Write
I2CBRG
FCY
Read
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
14.2
I2C Module Addresses
The I2CADD register contains the Slave mode
addresses. The register is a 10-bit register.
If the A10M bit (I2CCON<10>) is ‘0’, the address is
interpreted by the module as a 7-bit address. When an
address is received, it is compared to the 7 LSbs of the
I2CADD register.
If the A10M bit is ‘1’, the address is assumed to be a
10-bit address. When an address is received, it is compared with the binary value, ‘11110 A9 A8’ (where A9
and A8 are two Most Significant bits of I2CADD). If that
value matches, the next address is compared with the
Least Significant 8 bits of I2CADD, as specified in the
10-bit addressing protocol.
TABLE 14-1:
General call address or start byte
0x01-0x03
Reserved
0x04-0x07
Hs-mode Master codes
0x08-0x77
Valid 7-bit addresses
0x78-0x7b
Valid 10-bit addresses (lower 7 bits)
0x7c-0x7f
Reserved
I2C 7-bit Slave Mode Operation
Once enabled (I2CEN = 1), the slave module waits for
a Start bit to occur (i.e., the I2C module is ‘Idle’). Following the detection of a Start bit, 8 bits are shifted into
I2CRSR, and the address is compared against
I2CADD. In 7-bit mode (A10M = 0), bits I2CADD<6:0>
are compared against I2CRSR<7:1> and I2CRSR<0>
is the R_W bit. All incoming bits are sampled on the
rising edge of SCL.
If an address match occurs, an acknowledgement is
sent and the slave event interrupt flag (SI2CIF) is set
on the falling edge of the ninth (ACK) bit. The address
match does not affect the contents of the I2CRCV
buffer or the RBF bit.
14.3.1
SLAVE TRANSMISSION
If the R_W bit received is a ‘1’, the serial port goes into
Transmit mode. It sends ACK on the ninth bit and then
holds SCL to ‘0’ until the CPU responds by writing to
I2CTRN. SCL is released by setting the SCLREL bit,
and 8 bits of data are shifted out. Data bits are shifted
out on the falling edge of SCL, such that SDA is valid
during SCL high. The interrupt pulse is sent on the
falling edge of the ninth clock pulse, regardless of the
status of the ACK received from the master.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
SLAVE RECEPTION
If the R_W bit received is a ‘0’ during an address
match, then Receive mode is initiated. Incoming bits
are sampled on the rising edge of SCL. After 8 bits are
received, if I2CRCV is not full or I2COV is not set,
I2CRSR is transferred to I2CRCV. ACK is sent on the
ninth clock.
If the RBF flag is set, indicating that I2CRCV is still
holding data from a previous operation (RBF = 1), then
ACK is not sent; however, the interrupt pulse is generated. In the case of an overflow, the contents of the
I2CRSR are not loaded into the I2CRCV.
Note:
7-BIT I2C™ SLAVE
ADDRESSES SUPPORTED BY
dsPIC30F
0x00
14.3
14.3.2
14.4
The I2CRCV is loaded if the I2COV bit = 1
and the RBF flag = 0. In this case, a read
of the I2CRCV was performed but the user
did not clear the state of the I2COV bit
before the next receive occurred. The
acknowledgement is not sent (ACK = 1)
and the I2CRCV is updated.
I2C 10-bit Slave Mode Operation
In 10-bit mode, the basic receive and transmit operations are the same as in the 7-bit mode. However, the
criteria for address match is more complex.
The I2C specification dictates that a slave must be
addressed for a write operation with two address bytes
following a Start bit.
The A10M bit is a control bit that signifies that the
address in I2CADD is a 10-bit address rather than a 7-bit
address. The address detection protocol for the first byte
of a message address is identical for 7-bit and 10-bit
messages, but the bits being compared are different.
I2CADD holds the entire 10-bit address. Upon receiving an address following a Start bit, I2CRSR <7:3> is
compared against a literal ‘11110’ (the default 10-bit
address) and I2CRSR<2:1> are compared against
I2CADD<9:8>. If a match occurs and if R_W = 0, the
interrupt pulse is sent. The ADD10 bit is cleared to indicate a partial address match. If a match fails or R_W =
1, the ADD10 bit is cleared and the module returns to
the Idle state.
The low byte of the address is then received and compared with I2CADD<7:0>. If an address match occurs,
the interrupt pulse is generated and the ADD10 bit is
set, indicating a complete 10-bit address match. If an
address match did not occur, the ADD10 bit is cleared
and the module returns to the Idle state.
14.4.1
10-BIT MODE SLAVE TRANSMISSION
Once a slave is addressed in this fashion with the full
10-bit address (we refer to this state as
“PRIOR_ADDR_MATCH”), the master can begin
sending data bytes for a slave reception operation.
DS70138E-page 87
dsPIC30F3014/4013
14.4.2
10-BIT MODE SLAVE RECEPTION
Once addressed, the master can generate a Repeated
Start, reset the high byte of the address and set the
R_W bit without generating a Stop bit, thus initiating a
slave transmit operation.
14.5
Automatic Clock Stretch
In the Slave modes, the module can synchronize buffer
reads and write to the master device by clock stretching.
14.5.1
TRANSMIT CLOCK STRETCHING
Both 10-bit and 7-bit Transmit modes implement clock
stretching by asserting the SCLREL bit after the falling
edge of the ninth clock, if the TBF bit is cleared,
indicating the buffer is empty.
In Slave Transmit modes, clock stretching is always
performed irrespective of the STREN bit.
Clock synchronization takes place following the ninth
clock of the transmit sequence. If the device samples
an ACK on the falling edge of the ninth clock and if the
TBF bit is still clear, then the SCLREL bit is automatically cleared. The SCLREL being cleared to ‘0’ asserts
the SCL line low. The user’s ISR must set the SCLREL
bit before transmission is allowed to continue. By holding the SCL line low, the user has time to service the
ISR and load the contents of the I2CTRN before the
master device can initiate another transmit sequence.
Note 1: If the user loads the contents of I2CTRN,
setting the TBF bit before the falling edge
of the ninth clock, the SCLREL bit is not
be cleared and clock stretching does not
occur.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software,
regardless of the state of the TBF bit.
14.5.2
RECEIVE CLOCK STRETCHING
The STREN bit in the I2CCON register can be used to
enable clock stretching in Slave Receive mode. When
the STREN bit is set, the SCL pin is held low at the end
of each data receive sequence.
14.5.3
Clock stretching takes place following the ninth clock of
the receive sequence. On the falling edge of the ninth
clock at the end of the ACK sequence, if the RBF bit is
set, the SCLREL bit is automatically cleared, forcing
the SCL output to be held low. The user’s ISR must set
the SCLREL bit before reception is allowed to continue.
By holding the SCL line low, the user has time to service the ISR and read the contents of the I2CRCV
before the master device can initiate another receive
sequence. This prevents buffer overruns from
occurring.
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
7-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
When the STREN bit is set in Slave Receive mode, the
SCL line is held low when the buffer register is full. The
method for stretching the SCL output is the same for
both 7 and 10-bit addressing modes.
Note 1: If the user reads the contents of the
I2CRCV, clearing the RBF bit before the
falling edge of the ninth clock, the
SCLREL bit is not cleared and clock
stretching does not occur.
2: The SCLREL bit can be set in software
regardless of the state of the RBF bit. The
user should be careful to clear the RBF bit
in the ISR before the next receive
sequence in order to prevent an overflow
condition.
14.5.4
CLOCK STRETCHING DURING
10-BIT ADDRESSING (STREN = 1)
Clock stretching takes place automatically during the
addressing sequence. Because this module has a
register for the entire address, it is not necessary for
the protocol to wait for the address to be updated.
After the address phase is complete, clock stretching
occurs on each data receive or transmit sequence, as
described earlier.
14.6
Software Controlled Clock
Stretching (STREN = 1)
When the STREN bit is ‘1’, the SCLREL bit can be
cleared by software to allow software to control the
clock stretching. Program logic synchronizes writes to
the SCLREL bit with the SCL clock. Clearing the
SCLREL bit does not assert the SCL output until the
module detects a falling edge on the SCL output and
SCL is sampled low. If the SCLREL bit is cleared by the
user while the SCL line has been sampled low, the SCL
output is asserted (held low). The SCL output remains
low until the SCLREL bit is set and all other devices on
the I2C bus have de-asserted SCL. This ensures that a
write to the SCLREL bit does not violate the minimum
high time requirement for SCL.
If the STREN bit is ‘0’, a software write to the SCLREL
bit is disregarded and has no effect on the SCLREL bit.
DS70138E-page 88
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
14.7
Interrupts
The I2C module generates two interrupt flags, MI2CIF
(I2C Master Interrupt Flag) and SI2CIF (I2C Slave Interrupt Flag). The MI2CIF interrupt flag is activated on
completion of a master message event. The SI2CIF
interrupt flag is activated on detection of a message
directed to the slave.
14.8
Slope Control
2
The I C standard requires slope control on the SDA
and SCL signals for Fast mode (400 kHz). The control
bit, DISSLW, enables the user to disable slew rate
control if desired. It is necessary to disable the slew
rate control for 1 MHz mode.
14.9
IPMI Support
The control bit, IPMIEN, enables the module to support
Intelligent Peripheral Management Interface (IPMI).
When this bit is set, the module accepts and acts upon
all addresses.
14.10 General Call Address Support
The general call address can address all devices.
When this address is used, all devices should, in
theory, respond with an acknowledgement.
The general call address is one of eight addresses
reserved for specific purposes by the I2C protocol. It
consists of all ‘0’s with R_W = 0.
The general call address is recognized when the General Call Enable (GCEN) bit is set (I2CCON<7> = 1).
Following a Start bit detection, 8 bits are shifted into
I2CRSR and the address is compared with I2CADD,
and is also compared with the general call address
which is fixed in hardware.
If a general call address match occurs, the I2CRSR is
transferred to the I2CRCV after the eighth clock, the
RBF flag is set and on the falling edge of the ninth bit
(ACK bit), the master event interrupt flag (MI2CIF) is
set.
When the interrupt is serviced, the source for the
interrupt can be checked by reading the contents of the
I2CRCV to determine if the address was device-specific or a general call address.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
14.11 I2C Master Support
As a master device, six operations are supported:
• Assert a Start condition on SDA and SCL.
• Assert a Restart condition on SDA and SCL.
• Write to the I2CTRN register initiating
transmission of data/address.
• Generate a Stop condition on SDA and SCL.
• Configure the I2C port to receive data.
• Generate an ACK condition at the end of a
received byte of data.
14.12 I2C Master Operation
The master device generates all of the serial clock
pulses and the Start and Stop conditions. A transfer is
ended with a Stop condition or with a Repeated Start
condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also
the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus is
not released.
In Master Transmitter mode, serial data is output
through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The
first byte transmitted contains the slave address of the
receiving device (7 bits) and the data direction bit. In
this case, the data direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘0’. Serial
data is transmitted 8 bits at a time. After each byte is
transmitted, an ACK bit is received. Start and Stop
conditions are output to indicate the beginning and the
end of a serial transfer.
In Master Receive mode, the first byte transmitted
contains the slave address of the transmitting device
(7 bits) and the data direction bit. In this case, the data
direction bit (R_W) is logic ‘1’. Thus, the first byte transmitted is a 7-bit slave address, followed by a ‘1’ to indicate receive bit. Serial data is received via SDA while
SCL outputs the serial clock. Serial data is received
8 bits at a time. After each byte is received, an ACK bit
is transmitted. Start and Stop conditions indicate the
beginning and end of transmission.
14.12.1
I2C MASTER TRANSMISSION
Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address or the
second half of a 10-bit address, is accomplished by
simply writing a value to I2CTRN register. The user
should only write to I2CTRN when the module is in a
WAIT state. This action sets the Buffer Full Flag (TBF)
and allow the Baud Rate Generator to begin counting
and start the next transmission. Each bit of address/
data is shifted out onto the SDA pin after the falling
edge of SCL is asserted. The Transmit Status Flag,
TRSTAT (I2CSTAT<14>), indicates that a master
transmit is in progress.
DS70138E-page 89
dsPIC30F3014/4013
14.12.2
I2C MASTER RECEPTION
Master mode reception is enabled by programming the
Receive Enable bit, RCEN (I2CCON<3>). The I2C
module must be Idle before the RCEN bit is set, otherwise the RCEN bit is disregarded. The Baud Rate Generator begins counting and on each rollover, the state
of the SCL pin ACK and data are shifted into the
I2CRSR on the rising edge of each clock.
If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the transmission is halted, the TBF flag is
cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted and a
value can now be written to I2CTRN. When the user
services the I2C master event Interrupt Service Routine, if the I2C bus is free (i.e., the P bit is set), the user
can resume communication by asserting a Start
condition.
In I2C Master mode, the reload value for the BRG is
located in the I2CBRG register. When the BRG is
loaded with this value, the BRG counts down to ‘0’ and
stops until another reload has taken place. If clock
arbitration is taking place, for instance, the BRG is
reloaded when the SCL pin is sampled high.
If a Start, Restart, Stop or Acknowledge condition was
in progress when the bus collision occurred, the condition is aborted, the SDA and SCL lines are de-asserted,
and the respective control bits in the I2CCON register
are cleared to ‘0’. When the user services the bus
collision Interrupt Service Routine, and if the I2C bus is
free, the user can resume communication by asserting
a Start condition.
As per the I2C standard, FSCK may be 100 kHz or
400 kHz. However, the user can specify any baud rate
up to 1 MHz. I2CBRG values of ‘0’ or ‘1’ are illegal.
The master continues to monitor the SDA and SCL
pins, and if a Stop condition occurs, the MI2CIF bit is
set.
EQUATION 14-1:
A write to the I2CTRN starts the transmission of data at
the first data bit, regardless of where the transmitter left
off when bus collision occurred.
14.12.3
BAUD RATE GENERATOR
I2CBRG =
14.12.4
SERIAL CLOCK RATE
CY
( FFSCK
–
FCY
1,111,111
)
–1
CLOCK ARBITRATION
Clock arbitration occurs when the master de-asserts
the SCL pin (SCL allowed to float high) during any
receive, transmit, or Restart/Stop condition. When the
SCL pin is allowed to float high, the Baud Rate Generator (BRG) is suspended from counting until the SCL
pin is actually sampled high. When the SCL pin is sampled high, the Baud Rate Generator is reloaded with
the contents of I2CBRG and begins counting. This
ensures that the SCL high time is always at least one
BRG rollover count in the event that the clock is held
low by an external device.
14.12.5
MULTI-MASTER COMMUNICATION,
BUS COLLISION AND BUS
ARBITRATION
Multi-master operation support is achieved by bus arbitration. When the master outputs address/data bits
onto the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the
master outputs a ‘1’ on SDA by letting SDA float high
while another master asserts a ‘0’. When the SCL pin
floats high, data should be stable. If the expected data
on SDA is a ‘1’ and the data sampled on the SDA
pin = 0, then a bus collision has taken place. The
master sets the MI2CIF pulse and resetS the master
portion of the I2C port to its Idle state.
DS70138E-page 90
In a multi-master environment, the interrupt generation
on the detection of Start and Stop conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C
bus can be taken when the P bit is set in the I2CSTAT
register, or the bus is Idle and the S and P bits are
cleared.
14.13 I2C Module Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
14.13.1
I2C OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
Sleep occurs in the middle of a transmission and the
state machine is partially into a transmission as the
clocks stop, then the transmission is aborted. Similarly,
if Sleep occurs in the middle of a reception, then the
reception is aborted.
14.13.2
I2C OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
For the I2C, the I2CSIDL bit determines if the module
stops or continues on Idle. If I2CSIDL = 0, the module
continues operation on assertion of the Idle mode. If
I2CSIDL = 1, the module stops on Idle.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 14-2:
SFR Name Addr.
dsPIC30F3014/4013 I2C REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
I2CRCV
0200
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Receive Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
I2CTRN
0202
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Register
0000 0000 1111 1111
I2CBRG
0204
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
I2CCON
0206
I2CEN
—
A10M
DISSLW
SMEN
GCEN
STREN
GCSTAT
ADD10
IWCOL
I2COV
I2CSIDL SCLREL IPMIEN
Baud Rate Generator
I2CSTAT
0208
ACKSTAT
TRSTAT
—
—
—
BCL
I2CADD
020A
—
—
—
—
—
—
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
0000 0000 0000 0000
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
0001 0000 0000 0000
D_A
P
S
R_W
RBF
TBF
0000 0000 0000 0000
Address Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 91
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 92
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
15.0
SPI MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module is a synchronous serial interface. It is useful for communicating
with other peripheral devices, such as EEPROMs, shift
registers, display drivers and A/D converters, or other
microcontrollers. It is compatible with Motorola’s SPI
and SIOP interfaces. The dsPIC30F3014 and
dsPIC30F4013 devices feature one SPI module, SPI1.
15.1
Operating Function Description
Each SPI module consists of a 16-bit shift register,
SPIxSR (where x = 1 or 2) , used for shifting data in and
out, and a buffer register, SPIxBUF. A control register,
SPIxCON, configures the module. Additionally, a
STATUS register, SPIxSTAT, indicates various status
conditions.
The serial interface consists of 4 pins: SDIx (serial data
input), SDOx (serial data output), SCKx (shift clock
input or output), and SSx (active-low slave select).
In Master mode operation, SCK is a clock output but in
Slave mode, it is a clock input.
A series of eight (8) or sixteen (16) clock pulses shift
out bits from the SPIxSR to SDOx pin and simultaneously shift in data from SDIx pin. An interrupt is generated when the transfer is complete and the
corresponding interrupt flag bit (SPI1IF or SPI2IF) is
set. This interrupt can be disabled through an interrupt
enable bit (SPI1IE or SPI2IE).
The receive operation is double-buffered. When a complete byte is received, it is transferred from SPIxSR to
SPIxBUF.
If the receive buffer is full when new data is being transferred from SPIxSR to SPIxBUF, the module sets the
SPIROV bit, indicating an overflow condition. The
transfer of the data from SPIxSR to SPIxBUF is not
completed and new data is lost. The module does not
respond to SCL transitions while SPIROV is ‘1’,
effectively disabling the module until SPIxBUF is read
by user software.
Transmit writes are also double-buffered. The user
writes to SPIxBUF. When the master or slave transfer
is completed, the contents of the shift register (SPIxSR)
are moved to the receive buffer. If any transmit data has
been written to the buffer register, the contents of the
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
transmit buffer are moved to SPIxSR. The received
data is thus placed in SPIxBUF and the transmit data in
SPIxSR is ready for the next transfer.
Note:
Both the transmit buffer (SPIxTXB) and
the receive buffer (SPIxRXB) are mapped
to the same register address, SPIxBUF.
In Master mode, the clock is generated by prescaling
the system clock. Data is transmitted as soon as a
value is written to SPIxBUF. The interrupt is generated
at the middle of the transfer of the last bit.
In Slave mode, data is transmitted and received as
external clock pulses appear on SCK. Again, the interrupt is generated when the last bit is latched. If SSx
control is enabled, then transmission and reception are
enabled only when SSx = low. The SDOx output is
disabled in SSx mode with SSx high.
The clock provided to the module is (FOSC/4). This
clock is then prescaled by the primary (PPRE<1:0>)
and the secondary (SPRE<2:0>) prescale factors. The
CKE bit determines whether transmit occurs on transition from active clock state to Idle clock state, or vice
versa. The CKP bit selects the Idle state (high or low)
for the clock.
15.1.1
WORD AND BYTE
COMMUNICATION
A control bit, MODE16 (SPIxCON<10>), allows the
module to communicate in either 16-bit or 8-bit mode.
16-bit operation is identical to 8-bit operation except
that the number of bits transmitted is 16 instead of 8.
The user software must disable the module prior to
changing the MODE16 bit. The SPI module is reset
when the MODE16 bit is changed by the user.
A basic difference between 8-bit and 16-bit operation is
that the data is transmitted out of bit 7 of the SPIxSR for
8-bit operation, and data is transmitted out of bit 15 of
the SPIxSR for 16-bit operation. In both modes, data is
shifted into bit 0 of the SPIxSR.
15.1.2
SDOx DISABLE
A control bit, DISSDO, is provided to the SPIxCON register to allow the SDOx output to be disabled. This
allows the SPI module to be connected in an input-only
configuration. SDO can also be used for general
purpose I/O.
15.2
Framed SPI Support
The module supports a basic framed SPI protocol in
Master or Slave mode. The control bit, FRMEN,
enables framed SPI support and causes the SSx pin to
perform the Frame Synchronization pulse (FSYNC)
function. The control bit, SPIFSD, determines whether
the SSx pin is an input or an output (i.e., whether the
module receives or generates the Frame Synchronization pulse). The frame pulse is an active-high pulse for
DS70138E-page 93
dsPIC30F3014/4013
a single SPI clock cycle. When Frame Synchronization
is enabled, the data transmission starts only on the
subsequent transmit edge of the SPI clock.
FIGURE 15-1:
SPI BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal
Data Bus
Read
Write
SPIxBUF
SPIxBUF
Receive
Transmit
SPIxSR
SDIx
bit 0
SDOx
Shift
Clock
Clock
Control
SS and
FSYNC
Control
SSx
Edge
Select
Secondary
Prescaler
1:1-1:8
SCKx
Primary
Prescaler
1:1, 1:4,
1:16, 1:64
FCY
Enable Master Clock
Note: x = 1 or 2.
FIGURE 15-2:
SPI MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master
SPI Slave
SDOx
SDIy
Serial Input Buffer
(SPIxBUF)
SDIx
Shift Register
(SPIxSR)
MSb
Serial Input Buffer
(SPIyBUF)
LSb
Shift Register
(SPIySR)
MSb
SCKx
PROCESSOR 1
SDOy
Serial Clock
LSb
SCKy
PROCESSOR 2
Note: x = 1 or 2, y = 1 or 2.
DS70138E-page 94
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
15.3
Slave Select Synchronization
The SSx pin allows a Synchronous Slave mode. The
SPI must be configured in SPI Slave mode with SSx pin
control enabled (SSEN = 1). When the SSx pin is low,
transmission and reception are enabled and the SDOx
pin is driven. When SSx pin goes high, the SDOx pin is
no longer driven. Also, the SPI module is resynchronized, and all counters/control circuitry are reset.
Therefore, when the SSx pin is asserted low again,
transmission/reception begins at the MSb even if SSx
had been de-asserted in the middle of a transmit/
receive.
15.4
15.5
SPI Operation During CPU Idle
Mode
When the device enters Idle mode, all clock sources
remain functional. The SPISIDL bit (SPIxSTAT<13>)
determines if the SPI module stops or continues on
Idle. If SPISIDL = 0, the module continues to operate
when the CPU enters Idle mode. If SPISIDL = 1, the
module stops when the CPU enters Idle mode.
SPI Operation During CPU Sleep
Mode
During Sleep mode, the SPI module is shut down. If the
CPU enters Sleep mode while an SPI transaction is in
progress, then the transmission and reception is
aborted.
The transmitter and receiver stop in Sleep mode.
However, register contents are not affected by entering
or exiting Sleep mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 95
dsPIC30F3014/4013 SPI1 REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
SPI1STAT
0220
SPI1CON
0222
SPI1BUF
0224
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
SPIEN
—
SPISIDL
—
—
FRMEN
SPIFSD
—
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
—
DISSDO MODE16
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
—
—
—
SPIROV
—
—
—
—
SPITBF
SPIRBF 0000 0000 0000 0000
SMP
CKE
SSEN
CKP
MSTEN
SPRE2
SPRE1
SPRE0
PPRE1
PPRE0
Transmit and Receive Buffer
0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 96
TABLE 15-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
16.0
UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER TRANSMITTER
(UART) MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
This section describes the Universal Asynchronous
Receiver/Transmitter Communications module.
16.1
UART Module Overview
• One or two Stop bits
• Fully integrated Baud Rate Generator with 16-bit
prescaler
• Baud rates range from 38 bps to 1.875 Mbps at a
30 MHz instruction rate
• 4-word deep transmit data buffer
• 4-word deep receive data buffer
• Parity, framing and buffer overrun error detection
• Support for interrupt only on address detect
(9th bit = 1)
• Separate transmit and receive interrupts
• Loopback mode for diagnostic support
• Two choices of TX/RX pins on UART1 module
The key features of the UART module are:
• Full-duplex, 8 or 9-bit data communication
• Even, odd or no parity options (for 8-bit data)
FIGURE 16-1:
UART TRANSMITTER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
Control and Status bits
Write
UTX8
Write
UxTXREG Low Byte
Transmit Control
– Control TSR
– Control Buffer
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
Load TSR
UxTXIF
UTXBRK
Data
Transmit Shift Register (UxTSR)
‘0’ (Start)
UxTX
or UxATX
if ALTIO=1
‘1’ (Stop)
Parity
Parity
Generator
16 Divider
16x Baud Clock
from Baud Rate
Generator
Control
Signals
Note:
x = 1 or 2.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 97
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 16-2:
UART RECEIVER BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
16
Write
Read
Read Read
UxMODE
Write
UxSTA
URX8 UxRXREG Low Byte
Receive Buffer Control
– Generate Flags
– Generate Interrupt
– Shift Data Characters
UxRX
or UxARX
if ALTIO=1
· Start bit Detect
· Parity Check
· Stop bit Detect
· Shift Clock Generation
· Wake Logic
Load RSR
to Buffer
Receive Shift Register
(UxRSR)
Control
Signals
FERR
0
8-9
PERR
LPBACK
From UxTX
1
16 Divider
16x Baud Clock from
Baud Rate Generator
UxRXIF
DS70138E-page 98
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
16.2
16.2.1
Enabling and Setting Up UART
ENABLING THE UART
The UART module is enabled by setting the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register (where x = 1 or 2). Once
enabled, the UxTX and UxRX pins are configured as an
output and an input, respectively, overriding the TRIS
and LAT register bit settings for the corresponding I/O
port pins. The UxTX pin is at logic ‘1’ when no
transmission is taking place.
16.2.2
16.3
16.3.1
Disabling the UART module resets the buffers to empty
states. Any data characters in the buffers are lost and
the baud rate counter is reset.
1.
2.
3.
4.
All error and status flags associated with the UART
module are reset when the module is disabled. The
URXDA, OERR, FERR, PERR, UTXEN, UTXBRK and
UTXBF bits are cleared, whereas RIDLE and TRMT
are set. Other control bits, including ADDEN,
URXISEL<1:0>, UTXISEL, as well as the UxMODE
and UxBRG registers, are not affected.
Clearing the UARTEN bit while the UART is active
aborts all pending transmissions and receptions and
resets the module, as defined above. Re-enabling the
UART restarts the UART in the same configuration.
16.2.3
16.2.4
5.
Set up the UART:
First, the data length, parity and number of Stop
bits must be selected. Then, the transmit and
receive interrupt enable and priority bits are
setup in the UxMODE and UxSTA registers.
Also, the appropriate baud rate value must be
written to the UxBRG register.
Enable the UART by setting the UARTEN bit
(UxMODE<15>).
Set the UTXEN bit (UxSTA<10>), thereby
enabling a transmission.
Write the byte to be transmitted to the lower byte
of UxTXREG. The value is transferred to the
Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) immediately,
and the serial bit stream starts shifting out during
the next rising edge of the baud clock. Alternatively, the data byte can be written while UTXEN
= 0, following which, the user can set UTXEN.
This causes the serial bit stream to begin immediately because the baud clock starts from a
cleared state.
A transmit interrupt is generated, depending on
the value of the interrupt control bit UTXISEL
(UxSTA<15>).
16.3.2
ALTERNATE I/O
The alternate I/O function is enabled by setting the
ALTIO bit (UxMODE<10>). If ALTIO = 1, the UxATX
and UxARX pins (alternate transmit and alternate
receive pins, respectively) are used by the UART module instead of the UxTX and UxRX pins. If ALTIO = 0,
the UxTX and UxRX pins are used by the UART
module.
SETTING UP DATA, PARITY AND
STOP BIT SELECTIONS
Control bits PDSEL<1:0> in the UxMODE register are
used to select the data length and parity used in the
transmission. The data length may either be 8 bits with
even, odd or no parity, or 9 bits with no parity.
The STSEL bit determines whether one or two Stop bits
are used during data transmission.
The default (power-on) setting of the UART is 8 bits, no
parity and 1 Stop bit (typically represented as 8, N, 1).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TRANSMITTING IN 8-BIT DATA
MODE
The following steps must be performed in order to
transmit 8-bit data:
DISABLING THE UART
The UART module is disabled by clearing the UARTEN
bit in the UxMODE register. This is the default state
after any Reset. If the UART is disabled, all I/O pins
operate as port pins under the control of the LAT and
TRIS bits of the corresponding port pins.
Transmitting Data
TRANSMITTING IN 9-BIT DATA
MODE
The sequence of steps involved in the transmission of
9-bit data is similar to 8-bit transmission, except that a
16-bit data word (of which the upper 7 bits are always
clear) must be written to the UxTXREG register.
16.3.3
TRANSMIT BUFFER (UXTXB)
The transmit buffer is 9 bits wide and 4 characters
deep. Including the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR),
the user effectively has a 5-deep FIFO (First-In, FirstOut) buffer. The UTXBF Status bit (UxSTA<9>)
indicates whether the transmit buffer is full.
If a user attempts to write to a full buffer, the new data
is not accepted into the FIFO, and no data shift occurs
within the buffer. This enables recovery from a buffer
overrun condition.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset but is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
Power-Saving mode.
DS70138E-page 99
dsPIC30F3014/4013
16.3.4
TRANSMIT INTERRUPT
The transmit interrupt flag (U1TXIF or U2TXIF) is
located in the corresponding interrupt flag register.
The transmitter generates an edge to set the UxTXIF
bit. The condition for generating the interrupt depends
on the UTXISEL control bit:
a)
b)
If UTXISEL = 0, an interrupt is generated when
a word is transferred from the transmit buffer to
the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR). This means
that the transmit buffer has at least one empty
word.
If UTXISEL = 1, an interrupt is generated when
a word is transferred from the transmit buffer to
the Transmit Shift register (UxTSR) and the
transmit buffer is empty.
Switching between the two Interrupt modes during
operation is possible and sometimes offers more
flexibility.
16.3.5
TRANSMIT BREAK
Setting the UTXBRK bit (UxSTA<11>) causes the
UxTX line to be driven to logic ‘0’. The UTXBRK bit
overrides all transmission activity. Therefore, the user
should generally wait for the transmitter to be Idle
before setting UTXBRK.
To send a Break character, the UTXBRK bit must be set
by software and must remain set for a minimum of 13
baud clock cycles. The UTXBRK bit is then cleared by
software to generate Stop bits. The user must wait for
a duration of at least one or two baud clock cycles in
order to ensure a valid Stop bit(s) before reloading the
UxTXB, or starting other transmitter activity. Transmission of a Break character does not generate a transmit
interrupt.
16.4
16.4.1
FERR values are updated.
16.4.2
The receive buffer is 4 words deep. Including the
Receive Shift register (UxRSR), the user effectively
has a 5-word deep FIFO buffer.
URXDA (UxSTA<0>) = 1 indicates that the receive
buffer has data available. URXDA = 0 means that the
buffer is empty. If a user attempts to read an empty
buffer, the old values in the buffer are read and no data
shift occurs within the FIFO.
The FIFO is reset during any device Reset. It is not
affected when the device enters or wakes up from a
Power-Saving mode.
16.4.3
a)
b)
c)
If URXISEL<1:0> = 00 or 01, an interrupt is generated every time a data word is transferred
from the Receive Shift register (UxRSR) to the
receive buffer. There may be one or more
characters in the receive buffer.
If URXISEL<1:0> = 10, an interrupt is generated
when a word is transferred from the Receive Shift
register (UxRSR) to the receive buffer, which as a
result of the transfer, contains 3 characters.
If URXISEL<1:0> = 11, an interrupt is set when
a word is transferred from the Receive Shift
register (UxRSR) to the receive buffer, which as
a result of the transfer, contains 4 characters
(i.e., becomes full).
Switching between the Interrupt modes during operation is possible, though generally not advisable during
normal operation.
The following steps must be performed while receiving
8-bit or 9-bit data:
16.5
1.
16.5.1
2.
3.
4.
5.
Set up the UART (see Section 16.3.1 “Transmitting in 8-Bit Data Mode”).
Enable the UART (see Section 16.3.1 “Transmitting in 8-Bit Data Mode”).
A receive interrupt is generated when one or
more data words have been received, depending on the receive interrupt settings specified by
the URXISEL bits (UxSTA<7:6>).
Read the OERR bit to determine if an overrun
error has occurred. The OERR bit must be reset
in software.
Read the received data from UxRXREG. The act
of reading UxRXREG moves the next word to
the top of the receive FIFO, and the PERR and
DS70138E-page 100
RECEIVE INTERRUPT
The receive interrupt flag (U1RXIF or U2RXIF) can be
read from the corresponding interrupt flag register. The
interrupt flag is set by an edge generated by the
receiver. The condition for setting the receive interrupt
flag depends on the settings specified by the
URXISEL<1:0> (UxSTA<7:6>) control bits.
Receiving Data
RECEIVING IN 8-BIT OR 9-BIT
DATA MODE
RECEIVE BUFFER (UXRXB)
Reception Error Handling
RECEIVE BUFFER OVERRUN
ERROR (OERR BIT)
The OERR bit (UxSTA<1>) is set if all of the following
conditions occur:
a)
b)
c)
The receive buffer is full.
The Receive Shift register is full, but unable to
transfer the character to the receive buffer.
The Stop bit of the character in the UxRSR is
detected, indicating that the UxRSR needs to
transfer the character to the buffer.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Once OERR is set, no further data is shifted in UxRSR
(until the OERR bit is cleared in software or a Reset
occurs). The data held in UxRSR and UxRXREG
remains valid.
16.5.2
FRAMING ERROR (FERR)
The FERR bit (UxSTA<2>) is set if a ‘0’ is detected
instead of a Stop bit. If two Stop bits are selected, both
Stop bits must be ‘1’, otherwise FERR is set. The readonly FERR bit is buffered along with the received data.
It is cleared on any Reset.
16.5.3
PARITY ERROR (PERR)
The PERR bit (UxSTA<3>) is set if the parity of the
received word is incorrect. This error bit is applicable
only if a Parity mode (odd or even) is selected. The
read-only PERR bit is buffered along with the received
data bytes. It is cleared on any Reset.
16.5.4
IDLE STATUS
When the receiver is active (i.e., between the initial
detection of the Start bit and the completion of the Stop
bit), the RIDLE bit (UxSTA<4>) is ‘0’. Between the completion of the Stop bit and detection of the next Start bit,
the RIDLE bit is ‘1’, indicating that the UART is Idle.
16.5.5
RECEIVE BREAK
The receiver counts and expects a certain number of bit
times based on the values programmed in the PDSEL
(UxMODE<2:1>) and STSEL (UxMODE<0>) bits.
If the break is longer than 13 bit times, the reception is
considered complete after the number of bit times
specified by PDSEL and STSEL. The URXDA bit is set,
FERR is set, zeros are loaded into the receive FIFO,
interrupts are generated if appropriate and the RIDLE
bit is set.
When the module receives a long break signal and the
receiver has detected the Start bit, the data bits and the
invalid Stop bit (which sets the FERR), the receiver
must wait for a valid Stop bit before looking for the next
Start bit. It cannot assume that the break condition on
the line is the next Start bit.
Break is regarded as a character containing all ‘0’s with
the FERR bit set. The Break character is loaded into
the buffer. No further reception can occur until a Stop bit
is received. Note that RIDLE goes high when the Stop
bit has not yet been received.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
16.6
Address Detect Mode
Setting the ADDEN bit (UxSTA<5>) enables this
special mode in which a 9th bit (URX8) value of ‘1’
identifies the received word as an address, rather than
data. This mode is only applicable for 9-bit data
communication. The URXISEL control bit does not
have any impact on interrupt generation in this mode
since an interrupt (if enabled) is generated every time
the received word has the 9th bit set.
16.7
Loopback Mode
Setting the LPBACK bit enables this special mode in
which the UxTX pin is internally connected to the UxRX
pin. When configured for the Loopback mode, the
UxRX pin is disconnected from the internal UART
receive logic. However, the UxTX pin still functions as
in a normal operation.
To select this mode:
a)
b)
c)
Configure UART for desired mode of operation.
Set LPBACK = 1 to enable Loopback mode.
Enable transmission as defined in Section 16.3
“Transmitting Data”.
16.8
Baud Rate Generator
The UART has a 16-bit Baud Rate Generator to allow
maximum flexibility in baud rate generation. The Baud
Rate Generator register (UxBRG) is readable and
writable. The baud rate is computed as follows:
BRG = 16-bit value held in UxBRG register
(0 through 65535)
FCY = Instruction Clock Rate (1/TCY)
The Baud Rate is given by Equation 16-1.
EQUATION 16-1:
BAUD RATE
Baud Rate = FCY / (16*(BRG+1))
Therefore, the maximum baud rate possible is:
FCY /16 (if BRG = 0),
and the minimum baud rate possible is:
FCY / (16* 65536).
With a full 16-bit Baud Rate Generator at 30 MIPS
operation, the minimum baud rate achievable is
28.5 bps.
DS70138E-page 101
dsPIC30F3014/4013
16.9
Auto-Baud Support
To allow the system to determine baud rates of
received characters, the input can be optionally linked
to a capture input (IC1 for UART1, IC2 for UART2). To
enable this mode, the user must program the input
capture module to detect the falling and rising edges of
the Start bit.
16.10.2
UART OPERATION DURING CPU
IDLE MODE
For the UART, the USIDL bit determines if the module
stops or continues operation when the device enters
Idle mode. If USIDL = 0, the module continues
operation during Idle mode. If USIDL = 1, the module
stops on Idle.
16.10 UART Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
16.10.1
UART OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’. If
entry into Sleep mode occurs while a transmission is in
progress, then the transmission is aborted. The UxTX
pin is driven to logic ‘1’. Similarly, if entry into Sleep
mode occurs while a reception is in progress, then the
reception is aborted. The UxSTA, UxMODE, transmit
and receive registers and buffers, and the UxBRG
register are not affected by Sleep mode.
If the WAKE bit (UxMODE<7>) is set before the device
enters Sleep mode, a falling edge on the UxRX pin
generates a receive interrupt. The Receive Interrupt
Select mode bit (URXISEL) has no effect for this function. If the receive interrupt is enabled, this wakes the
device up from Sleep. The UARTEN bit must be set in
order to generate a wake-up interrupt.
DS70138E-page 102
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 16-1:
dsPIC30F3014/4013 UART1 REGISTER MAP
SFR Name Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
ALTIO
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
WAKE
LPBACK
ABAUD
U1MODE
020C
UARTEN
—
USIDL
—
U1STA
020E
UTXISEL
—
—
—
U1TXREG
0210
—
—
—
—
—
U1RXREG
0212
—
—
—
—
—
U1BRG
0214
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
TABLE 16-2:
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 4
Bit 3
—
PERR
Bit 0
Reset State
—
—
TRMT
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
—
—
URX8
Receive Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN
—
Bit 1
UTXBF
UTXBRK UTXEN
RIDLE
Bit 2
PDSEL1 PDSEL0 STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
FERR
OERR
URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013 UART2 REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
—
—
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
WAKE
LPBACK
ABAUD
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
U2MODE
0216
UARTEN
—
USIDL
—
U2STA
0218
UTXISEL
—
—
—
U2TXREG
021A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
UTX8
Transmit Register
0000 000u uuuu uuuu
U2RXREG
021C
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
URX8
Receive Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
U2BRG
021E
UTXBRK UTXEN
—
—
UTXBF
TRMT
URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN
Baud Rate Generator Prescaler
—
—
RIDLE
PERR
PDSEL1 PDSEL0
FERR
OERR
STSEL 0000 0000 0000 0000
URXDA 0000 0001 0001 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend: u = uninitialized bit
1:
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 103
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 104
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
17.0
CAN MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
17.1
Overview
The Controller Area Network (CAN) module is a serial
interface, useful for communicating with other CAN
modules or microcontroller devices. This interface/
protocol was designed to allow communications within
noisy environments.
The CAN module is a communication controller implementing the CAN 2.0 A/B protocol, as defined in the
BOSCH specification. The module supports CAN 1.2,
CAN 2.0A, CAN 2.0B Passive, and CAN 2.0B Active
versions of the protocol. The module implementation is
a full CAN system. The CAN specification is not covered within this data sheet. The reader may refer to the
BOSCH CAN specification for further details.
The module features are as follows:
• Implementation of the CAN protocol CAN 1.2,
CAN 2.0A and CAN 2.0B
• Standard and extended data frames
• 0-8 bytes data length
• Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbit/sec
• Support for remote frames
• Double-buffered receiver with two prioritized
received message storage buffers (each buffer
may contain up to 8 bytes of data)
• 6 full (standard/extended identifier), acceptance
filters, 2 associated with the high priority receive
buffer and 4 associated with the low priority
receive buffer
• 2 full, acceptance filter masks, one each
associated with the high and low priority receive
buffers
• Three transmit buffers with application specified
prioritization and abort capability (each buffer may
contain up to 8 bytes of data)
• Programmable wake-up functionality with
integrated low-pass filter
• Programmable Loopback mode supports self-test
operation
• Signaling via interrupt capabilities for all CAN
receiver and transmitter error states
• Programmable clock source
• Programmable link to input capture module (IC2,
for both CAN1 and CAN2) for time-stamping and
network synchronization
• Low-Power Sleep and Idle mode
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The CAN bus module consists of a protocol engine and
message buffering/control. The CAN protocol engine
handles all functions for receiving and transmitting
messages on the CAN bus. Messages are transmitted
by first loading the appropriate data registers. Status
and errors can be checked by reading the appropriate
registers. Any message detected on the CAN bus is
checked for errors and then matched against filters to
see if it should be received and stored in one of the
receive registers.
17.2
Frame Types
The CAN module transmits various types of frames
which include data messages or remote transmission
requests, initiated by the user, as other frames that are
automatically generated for control purposes. The
following frame types are supported:
• Standard Data Frame:
A standard data frame is generated by a node
when the node wishes to transmit data. It includes
an 11-bit standard identifier (SID) but not an 18-bit
extended identifier (EID).
• Extended Data Frame:
An extended data frame is similar to a standard
data frame but includes an extended identifier as
well.
• Remote Frame:
It is possible for a destination node to request the
data from the source. For this purpose, the destination node sends a remote frame with an identifier that matches the identifier of the required data
frame. The appropriate data source node then
sends a data frame as a response to this remote
request.
• Error Frame:
An error frame is generated by any node that
detects a bus error. An error frame consists of 2
fields: an error flag field and an error delimiter
field.
• Overload Frame:
An overload frame can be generated by a node as
a result of 2 conditions. First, the node detects a
dominant bit during interframe space which is an
illegal condition. Second, due to internal conditions, the node is not yet able to start reception of
the next message. A node may generate a
maximum of 2 sequential overload frames to
delay the start of the next message.
• Interframe Space:
Interframe space separates a proceeding frame
(of whatever type) from a following data or remote
frame.
DS70138E-page 105
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 17-1:
CAN BUFFERS AND PROTOCOL ENGINE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Acceptance Mask
RXM1(2)
BUFFERS
Acceptance Filter
RXF2(2)
TXB2(2)
TXREQ
TXABT
TXLARB
TXERR
MESSAGE
TXREQ
TXABT
TXLARB
TXERR
MESSAGE
TXB1(2)
TXREQ
TXABT
TXLARB
TXERR
MESSAGE
TXB0(2)
A
c
c
e
p
t
Acceptance Mask
RXM0(2)
Acceptance Filter
RXF3(2)
Acceptance Filter
RXF0(2)
Acceptance Filter
RXF4(2)
Acceptance Filter
RXF1(2)
Acceptance Filter
RXF5(2)
R(2)
X
B
0
Message
Queue
Control
Transmit Byte Sequencer
Identifier
M
A
B
Data Field
Data Field
PROTOCOL
ENGINE
Note
1:
2:
RERRCNT
TERRCNT
Err Pas
Bus Off
Transmit
Error
Counter
CRC Generator
R(2)
X
B
1
Identifier
Receive
Error
Counter
Transmit Shift
A
c
c
e
p
t
Receive Shift
Protocol
Finite
State
Machine
CRC Check
Transmit
Logic
Bit
Timing
Logic
CiTX(1)
CiRX(1)
Bit Timing
Generator
i = 1 or 2 refers to a particular CAN module (CAN1 or CAN2).
These are conceptual groups of registers, not SFR names by themselves.
DS70138E-page 106
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
17.3
Modes of Operation
The CAN module can operate in one of several operation
modes selected by the user. These modes include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Initialization mode
Disable mode
Normal Operation mode
Listen Only mode
Loopback mode
Error Recognition mode
Modes are requested by setting the REQOP<2:0> bits
(CiCTRL<10:8>). Entry into a mode is Acknowledged
by monitoring the OPMODE<2:0> bits (CiCTRL<7:5>).
The module does not change the mode and the
OPMODE bits until a change in mode is acceptable,
generally during bus Idle time which is defined as at
least 11 consecutive recessive bits.
17.3.1
INITIALIZATION MODE
In the Initialization mode, the module does not transmit
or receive. The error counters are cleared and the interrupt flags remain unchanged. The programmer has
access to Configuration registers that are access
restricted in other modes. The module protects the user
from accidentally violating the CAN protocol through
programming errors. All registers that control the configuration of the module can not be modified while the
module is on-line. The CAN module is not allowed to
enter the Configuration mode while a transmission is
taking place. The Configuration mode serves as a lock
to protect the following registers.
•
•
•
•
•
All Module Control registers
Baud Rate and Interrupt Configuration registers
Bus Timing registers
Identifier Acceptance Filter registers
Identifier Acceptance Mask registers
17.3.2
DISABLE MODE
In Disable mode, the module does not transmit or
receive. The module has the ability to set the WAKIF bit
due to bus activity, however, any pending interrupts
remain and the error counters retain their value.
If the REQOP<2:0> bits (CiCTRL<10:8>) = 001, the
module enters the Module Disable mode. If the module is
active, the module waits for 11 recessive bits on the CAN
bus, detects that condition as an Idle bus, and then
accepts the module disable command. When the
OPMODE<2:0> bits (CiCTRL<7:5>) = 001, that
indicates whether the module successfully went into
Module Disable mode. The I/O pins revert to normal I/O
function when the module is in the Module Disable mode.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
The module can be programmed to apply a low-pass
filter function to the CiRX input line while the module or
the CPU is in Sleep mode. The WAKFIL bit
(CiCFG2<14>) enables or disables the filter.
Note:
17.3.3
Typically, if the CAN module is allowed to
transmit in a particular mode of operation
and a transmission is requested immediately after the CAN module has been
placed in that mode of operation, the module waits for 11 consecutive recessive bits
on the bus before starting transmission. If
the user switches to Disable mode within
this 11-bit period, then this transmission is
aborted and the corresponding TXABT bit
is set and TXREQ bit is cleared.
NORMAL OPERATION MODE
Normal Operating mode is selected when
REQOP<2:0> = 000. In this mode, the module is activated and the I/O pins assume the CAN bus functions.
The module transmits and receives CAN bus
messages via the CxTX and CxRX pins.
17.3.4
LISTEN ONLY MODE
If the Listen Only mode is activated, the module on the
CAN bus is passive. The transmitter buffers revert to
the port I/O function. The receive pins remain inputs.
For the receiver, no error flags or Acknowledge signals
are sent. The error counters are deactivated in this
state. The Listen Only mode can be used for detecting
the baud rate on the CAN bus. To use this, it is necessary that there are at least two further nodes that
communicate with each other.
17.3.5
LISTEN ALL MESSAGES MODE
The module can be set to ignore all errors and receive
any message. The Listen All Messages mode is activated by setting the REQOP<2:0> bits to ‘111’. In this
mode, the data which is in the message assembly
buffer until the time an error occurred, is copied in the
receive buffer and can be read via the CPU interface.
17.3.6
LOOPBACK MODE
If the Loopback mode is activated, the module
connects the internal transmit signal to the internal
receive signal at the module boundary. The transmit
and receive pins revert to their port I/O function.
DS70138E-page 107
dsPIC30F3014/4013
17.4
17.4.1
Message Reception
RECEIVE BUFFERS
The CAN bus module has 3 receive buffers. However,
one of the receive buffers is always committed to monitoring the bus for incoming messages. This buffer is
called the Message Assembly Buffer (MAB). So there
are 2 receive buffers visible, denoted as RXB0 and
RXB1, that can essentially instantaneously receive a
complete message from the protocol engine.
All messages are assembled by the MAB and are transferred to the RXBn buffers only if the acceptance filter
criterion are met. When a message is received, the
RXnIF flag (CiINRF<0> or CiINRF<1>) is set. This bit
can only be set by the module when a message is
received. The bit is cleared by the CPU when it has completed processing the message in the buffer. If the
RXnIE bit (CiINTE<0> or CiINTE<1>) is set, an interrupt
is generated when a message is received.
RXF0 and RXF1 filters with RXM0 mask are associated
with RXB0. The filters RXF2, RXF3, RXF4 and RXF5,
and the mask RXM1 are associated with RXB1.
17.4.2
MESSAGE ACCEPTANCE FILTERS
The message acceptance filters and masks are used to
determine if a message in the message assembly
buffer should be loaded into either of the receive buffers. Once a valid message has been received into the
Message Assembly Buffer (MAB), the identifier fields of
the message are compared to the filter values. If there
is a match, that message is loaded into the appropriate
receive buffer.
The acceptance filter looks at incoming messages for
the RXIDE bit (CiRXnSID<0>) to determine how to
compare the identifiers. If the RXIDE bit is clear, the
message is a standard frame and only filters with the
EXIDE bit (CiRXFnSID<0>) clear are compared. If the
RXIDE bit is set, the message is an extended frame
and only filters with the EXIDE bit set are compared.
17.4.3
MESSAGE ACCEPTANCE FILTER
MASKS
The mask bits essentially determine which bits to apply
the filter to. If any mask bit is set to a zero, that bit is
automatically accepted regardless of the filter bit.
There are two programmable acceptance filter masks
associated with the receive buffers, one for each buffer.
17.4.4
RECEIVE OVERRUN
An overrun condition occurs when the Message
Assembly Buffer (MAB) has assembled a valid
received message, the message is accepted through
the acceptance filters, and when the receive buffer
associated with the filter has not been designated as
clear of the previous message.
The overrun error flag, RXnOVR (CiINTF<15> or
CiINTF<14>), and the ERRIF bit (CiINTF<5>) are set
and the message in the MAB is discarded.
If the DBEN bit is clear, RXB1 and RXB0 operate independently. When this is the case, a message intended
for RXB0 is not diverted into RXB1 if RXB0 contains an
unread message, and the RX0OVR bit is set.
If the DBEN bit is set, the overrun for RXB0 is handled
differently. If a valid message is received for RXB0 and
RXFUL = 1 it indicates that RXB0 is full and
RXFUL = 0 indicates that RXB1 is empty, the message
for RXB0 is loaded into RXB1. An overrun error is not
generated for RXB0. If a valid message is received for
RXB0 and RXFUL = 1, indicates that both RXB0 and
RXB1 are full, the message is lost and an overrun is
indicated for RXB1.
17.4.5
RECEIVE ERRORS
The CAN module detects the following receive errors:
• Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) error
• Bit Stuffing error
• Invalid Message Receive Error
These receive errors do not generate an interrupt.
However, the receive error counter is incremented by
one in case one of these errors occur. The RXWAR bit
(CiINTF<9>) indicates that the receive error counter
has reached the CPU warning limit of 96 and an
interrupt is generated.
17.4.6
RECEIVE INTERRUPTS
Receive interrupts can be divided into 3 major groups,
each including various conditions that generate
interrupts:
• Receive Interrupt:
A message has been successfully received and
loaded into one of the receive buffers. This interrupt is activated immediately after receiving the
End-of-Frame (EOF) field. Reading the RXnIF flag
indicates which receive buffer caused the
interrupt.
• Wake-up Interrupt:
The CAN module has woken up from Disable
mode or the device has woken up from Sleep
mode.
DS70138E-page 108
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
• Receive Error Interrupts:
A receive error interrupt is indicated by the ERRIF
bit. This bit shows that an error condition
occurred. The source of the error can be determined by checking the bits in the CAN Interrupt
STATUS register, CiINTF.
- Invalid Message Received:
If any type of error occurred during reception of
the last message, an error is indicated by the
IVRIF bit.
- Receiver Overrun:
The RXnOVR bit indicates that an overrun
condition occurred.
- Receiver Warning:
The RXWAR bit indicates that the Receive Error
Counter (RERRCNT<7:0>) has reached the
warning limit of 96.
- Receiver Error Passive:
The RXEP bit indicates that the Receive Error
Counter has exceeded the error passive limit of
127 and the module has gone into error passive
state.
17.5
17.5.1
Message Transmission
TRANSMIT BUFFERS
The CAN module has three transmit buffers. Each of
the three buffers occupies 14 bytes of data. Eight of the
bytes are the maximum 8 bytes of the transmitted message. Five bytes hold the standard and extended
identifiers and other message arbitration information.
17.5.2
TRANSMIT MESSAGE PRIORITY
Transmit priority is a prioritization within each node of
the pending transmittable messages. There are
4 levels of transmit priority. If TXPRI<1:0>
(CiTXnCON<1:0>, where n = 0, 1 or 2, represents a
particular transmit buffer) for a particular message
buffer is set to ‘11’, that buffer has the highest priority.
If TXPRI<1:0> for a particular message buffer is set to
‘10’ or ‘01’, that buffer has an intermediate priority. If
TXPRI<1:0> for a particular message buffer is ‘00’, that
buffer has the lowest priority.
17.5.3
Setting TXREQ bit simply flags a message buffer as
enqueued for transmission. When the module detects
an available bus, it begins transmitting the message
which has been determined to have the highest priority.
If the transmission completes successfully on the first
attempt, the TXREQ bit is cleared automatically and an
interrupt is generated if TX1IE was set.
If the message transmission fails, one of the error
condition flags is set, and the TXREQ bit remains set,
indicating that the message is still pending for transmission. If the message encountered an error condition
during the transmission attempt, the TXERR bit is set,
and the error condition may cause an interrupt. If the
message loses arbitration during the transmission
attempt, the TXLARB bit is set. No interrupt is
generated to signal the loss of arbitration.
17.5.4
ABORTING MESSAGE
TRANSMISSION
The system can also abort a message by clearing the
TXREQ bit associated with each message buffer. Setting the ABAT bit (CiCTRL<12>) requests an abort of
all pending messages. If the message has not yet
started transmission, or if the message started but is
interrupted by loss of arbitration or an error, the abort is
processed. The abort is indicated when the module
sets the TXABT bit and the TXnIF flag is not automatically set.
17.5.5
TRANSMISSION ERRORS
The CAN module detects the following transmission
errors:
• Acknowledge error
• Form error
• Bit error
These transmission errors do not necessarily generate
an interrupt but are indicated by the transmission error
counter. However, each of these errors causes the
transmission error counter to be incremented by one.
Once the value of the error counter exceeds the value
of 96, the ERRIF (CiINTF<5>) and the TXWAR bit
(CiINTF<10>) are set. Once the value of the error
counter exceeds the value of 96, an interrupt is
generated and the TXWAR bit in the Error Flag register
is set.
TRANSMISSION SEQUENCE
To initiate transmission of the message, the TXREQ bit
(CiTXnCON<3>) must be set. The CAN bus module
resolves any timing conflicts between setting of the
TXREQ bit and the Start-of-Frame (SOF), ensuring that if
the priority was changed, it is resolved correctly before the
SOF occurs. When TXREQ is set, the TXABT
(CiTXnCON<6>), TXLARB (CiTXnCON<5>) and TXERR
(CiTXnCON<4>) flag bits are automatically cleared.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 109
dsPIC30F3014/4013
17.5.6
TRANSMIT INTERRUPTS
17.6
Baud Rate Setting
Transmit interrupts can be divided into 2 major groups,
each including various conditions that generate
interrupts:
All nodes on any particular CAN bus must have the
same nominal bit rate. In order to set the baud rate, the
following parameters have to be initialized:
• Transmit Interrupt:
At least one of the three transmit buffers is empty
(not scheduled) and can be loaded to schedule a
message for transmission. The TXnIF flags are
read to determine which transmit buffer is available and caused the interrupt.
•
•
•
•
•
•
• Transmit Error Interrupts:
A transmission error interrupt is indicated by the
ERRIF flag. This flag shows that an error condition
occurred. The source of the error can be
determined by checking the error flags in the CAN
Interrupt STATUS register, CiINTF. The flags in
this register are related to receive and transmit
errors.
- Transmitter Warning Interrupt:
The TXWAR bit indicates that the Transmit Error
Counter has reached the CPU warning limit of
96.
- Transmitter Error Passive:
The TXEP bit (CiINTF<12>) indicates that the
Transmit Error Counter has exceeded the error
passive limit of 127 and the module has gone to
error passive state.
- Bus Off:
The TXBO bit (CiINTF<13>) indicates that the
Transmit Error Counter (TERRCNT<7:0>)has
exceeded 255 and the module has gone to the
bus off state.
FIGURE 17-2:
Synchronization Jump Width
Baud Rate Prescaler
Phase Segments
Length determination of Phase Segment 2
Sample Point
Propagation Segment bits
17.6.1
BIT TIMING
All controllers on the CAN bus must have the same
baud rate and bit length. However, different controllers
are not required to have the same master oscillator
clock. At different clock frequencies of the individual
controllers, the baud rate has to be adjusted by
adjusting the number of time quanta in each segment.
The nominal bit time can be thought of as being divided
into separate non-overlapping time segments. These
segments are shown in Figure 17-2.
•
•
•
•
Synchronization Segment (Sync Seg)
Propagation Time Segment (Prop Seg)
Phase Segment 1 (Phase1 Seg)
Phase Segment 2 (Phase2 Seg)
The time segments and also the nominal bit time are
made up of integer units of time called time quanta or
TQ. By definition, the nominal bit time has a minimum
of 8 TQ and a maximum of 25 TQ. Also, by definition,
the minimum nominal bit time is 1 μsec corresponding
to a maximum bit rate of 1 MHz.
CAN BIT TIMING
Input Signal
Sync
Prop
Segment
Phase
Segment 1
Phase
Segment 2
Sync
Sample Point
TQ
DS70138E-page 110
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
17.6.2
PRESCALER SETTING
There is a programmable prescaler with integral values
ranging from 1 to 64 in addition to a fixed divide-by-2 for
clock generation. The Time Quantum (TQ) is a fixed
unit of time derived from the oscillator period, shown in
Equation 17-1, where FCAN is FCY (if the CANCKS bit
is set) or 4FCY (if CANCKS is clear).
Note:
FCAN must not exceed 30 MHz. If
CANCKS = 0, then FCY must not exceed
7.5 MHz.
EQUATION 17-1:
TIME QUANTUM FOR
CLOCK GENERATION
TQ = 2 (BRP<5:0> + 1)/FCAN
17.6.3
PROPAGATION SEGMENT
This part of the bit time is used to compensate physical
delay times within the network. These delay times consist of the signal propagation time on the bus line and
the internal delay time of the nodes. The propagation
segment can be programmed from 1 TQ to 8 TQ by
setting the PRSEG<2:0> bits (CiCFG2<2:0>).
17.6.4
PHASE SEGMENTS
The phase segments are used to optimally locate the
sampling of the received bit within the transmitted bit
time. The sampling point is between Phase1 Seg and
Phase2 Seg. These segments are lengthened or shortened by resynchronization. The end of the Phase1 Seg
determines the sampling point within a bit period. The
segment is programmable from 1 TQ to 8 TQ. Phase2
Seg provides delay to the next transmitted data transition. The segment is programmable from 1 TQ to 8 TQ,
or it may be defined to be equal to the greater of
Phase1 Seg or the information processing time (2 TQ).
The Phase1 Seg is initialized by setting bits
SEG1PH<2:0> (CiCFG2<5:3>), and Phase2 Seg is
initialized by setting SEG2PH<2:0> (CiCFG2<10:8>).
The following requirement must be fulfilled while setting
the lengths of the phase segments:
Prop Seg + Phase1 Seg > = Phase2 Seg
17.6.5
SAMPLE POINT
The sample point is the point of time at which the bus
level is read and interpreted as the value of that respective bit. The location is at the end of Phase1 Seg. If the
bit timing is slow and contains many TQ, it is possible to
specify multiple sampling of the bus line at the sample
point. The level determined by the CAN bus then corresponds to the result from the majority decision of three
values. The majority samples are taken at the sample
point and twice before with a distance of TQ/2. The
CAN module allows the user to choose between
sampling three times at the same point, or once at the
same point by setting or clearing the SAM bit
(CiCFG2<6>).
Typically, the sampling of the bit should take place at
about 60-70% through the bit time depending on the
system parameters.
17.6.6
SYNCHRONIZATION
To compensate for phase shifts between the oscillator
frequencies of the different bus stations, each CAN
controller must be able to synchronize to the relevant
signal edge of the incoming signal. When an edge in
the transmitted data is detected, the logic compares the
location of the edge to the expected time (synchronous
segment). The circuit then adjusts the values of
Phase1 Seg and Phase2 Seg. There are two
mechanisms used to synchronize.
17.6.6.1
Hard Synchronization
Hard synchronization is only done when there is a
recessive to dominant edge during bus Idle, indicating
the start of a message. After hard synchronization, the
bit-time counters are restarted with the synchronous
segment. Hard synchronization forces the edge which
has caused the hard synchronization to lie within the
synchronization segment of the restarted bit time. If a
hard synchronization is done, there will not be a
resynchronization within that bit time.
17.6.6.2
Resynchronization
As a result of resynchronization, Phase1 Seg may be
lengthened or Phase2 Seg may be shortened. The
amount of lengthening or shortening of the phase
buffer segment has an upper bound known as the synchronization jump width, and is specified by the
SJW<1:0> bits (CiCFG1<7:6>). The value of the
synchronization jump width is added to Phase1 Seg or
subtracted from Phase2 Seg. The resynchronization
jump width is programmable between 1 TQ and 4 TQ.
The following requirement must be fulfilled while setting
the SJW<1:0> bits:
Phase2 Seg > Synchronization Jump Width
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 111
dsPIC30F4013 CAN1 REGISTER MAP
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
SFR Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
C1RXF0SID
0300
—
—
—
C1RXF0EIDH
0302
—
—
—
C1RXF0EIDL
0304
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF1SID
0308
—
—
—
C1RXF1EIDH 030A
—
—
—
C1RXF1EIDL
030C
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF2SID
0310
—
—
—
C1RXF2EIDH
0312
—
—
—
C1RXF2EIDL
0314
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF3SID
0318
—
—
—
C1RXF3EIDH 031A
—
—
—
C1RXF3EIDL
031C
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF4SID
0320
—
—
—
C1RXF4EIDH
0322
—
—
—
C1RXF4EIDL
0324
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXF5SID
0328
—
—
—
C1RXF5EIDH 032A
—
—
—
C1RXF5EIDL
032C
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXM0SID
0330
—
—
—
C1RXM0EIDH 0332
—
—
—
C1RXM0EIDL 0334
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RXM1SID
0338
—
—
—
C1RXM1EIDH 033A
—
—
—
C1RXM1EIDL 033C
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
—
—
C1TX2SID
0340
Transmit Buffer 2 Standard Identifier<10:6>
—
—
—
C1TX2EID
0342
—
—
—
C1TX2DLC
0344
Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier<5:0>
TXRTR
TXRB1
C1TX2B1
0346
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B2
0348
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B3
034A
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX2B4
034C
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 2 Byte 6
C1TX2CON
034E
C1TX1SID
0350
C1TX1EID
0352
Legend:
1:
Bit 12
—
—
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
—
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
—
MIDE
000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
—
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
—
MIDE
000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
—
—
Receive Acceptance Mask 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
Receive Acceptance Mask 1 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
—
Transmit Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<10:6>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
—
—
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Transmit Buffer 2 Standard Identifier<5:0>
SRR
—
—
DLC<3:0>
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
TXREQ
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier<13:6>
TXRB0
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 5 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 4 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 3 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
uuuu uu00 0000 0000
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
Reset State
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 2 Standard Identifier<10:0>
Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier
<17:14>
Bit 0
EXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uu0u
Receive Acceptance Filter 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
—
—
—
Bit 1
—
Receive Acceptance Filter 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
Transmit Buffer 2 Extended Identifier
<17:14>
—
Bit 11
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
Transmit Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<5:0>
Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<13:6>
TXPRI<1:0>
SRR
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 112
TABLE 17-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 17-1:
SFR Name
Addr.
dsPIC30F4013 CAN1 REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
TXRTR
TXRB1
TXRB0
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
—
—
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
C1TX1DLC
0354
Transmit Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1TX1B1
0356
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B2
0358
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B3
035A
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX1B4
035C
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 1 Byte 6
C1TX1CON
035E
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Buffer 0 Standard Identifier<10:6>
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TXRTR
TXRB1
DLC<3:0>
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TXREQ
—
TXPRI<1:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
C1TX0SID
0360
C1TX0EID
0362
C1TX0DLC
0364
Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1TX0B1
0366
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 1
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B2
0368
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 3
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B3
036A
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 5
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1TX0B4
036C
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 7
Transmit Buffer 0 Byte 6
C1TX0CON
036E
—
—
—
C1RX1SID
0370
—
—
—
C1RX1EID
0372
—
—
—
C1RX1DLC
0374
Receive Buffer 1 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RX1B1
0376
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 1
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1B2
0378
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 3
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1B3
037A
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 5
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX1B4
037C
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 7
Receive Buffer 1 Byte 6
C1RX1CON
037E
—
—
—
C1RX0SID
0380
—
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier
<17:14>
—
—
—
—
—
Transmit Buffer 0 Standard Identifier <5:0>
SRR
TXRB0
—
—
—
DLC<3:0>
TXABT TXLARB TXERR
—
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
TXREQ
—
TXPRI<1:0>
SRR
—
—
—
—
—
—
RXFUL
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRB0
—
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uuuu
Receive Buffer 1 Extended Identifier <17:6>
RXRTR RXRB1
uuuu uuuu uuuu u000
DLC<3:0>
uuuu uuuu 000u uuuu
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRTRRO
FILHIT<2:0>
Receive Buffer 0 Standard Identifier<10:0>
SRR
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXIDE 000u uuuu uuuu uuuu
DS70138E-page 113
C1RX0EID
0382
C1RX0DLC
0384
Receive Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<5:0>
C1RX0B1
0386
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 1
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 0
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0B2
0388
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 3
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 2
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0B3
038A
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 5
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 4
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0B4
038C
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 7
Receive Buffer 0 Byte 6
uuuu uuuu uuuu uuuu
C1RX0CON
038E
—
—
—
—
—
C1CTRL
0390
CANCAP
—
CSIDL
ABAT
CANCKS
C1CFG1
0392
—
—
—
—
—
0394
—
WAKFIL
—
—
—
C1CFG2
Legend:
1:
—
Receive Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<17:6>
RXRTR RXRB1
—
—
—
—
RXFUL
REQOP<2:0>
—
—
SEG2PH<2:0>
—
—
OPMODE<2:0>
—
—
—
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
RXRB0
—
DLC<3:0>
RXRTRRO DBEN JTOFF FILHIT0 0000 0000 0000 0000
—
SJW<1:0>
SEG2PHTS
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
SAM
uuuu uuuu 000u uuuu
ICODE<2:0>
BRP<5:0>
SEG1PH<2:0>
—
0000 0100 1000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
PRSEG<2:0>
0u00 0uuu uuuu uuuu
dsPIC30F3014/4013
—
uuuu 0000 uuuu uuuu
—
Receive Buffer 1 Standard Identifier<10:0>
—
TXIDE uuuu u000 uuuu uuuu
Transmit Buffer 0 Extended Identifier<13:6>
SFR Name
dsPIC30F4013 CAN1 REGISTER MAP (CONTINUED)
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
C1INTF
0396
RX0OVR
RX1OVR
TXBO
TXEP
RXEP
C1INTE
0398
—
—
—
—
—
C1EC
Legend:
1:
039A
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
TXWAR RXWAR EWARN
—
—
—
TERRCNT<7:0>
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
IVRIF
WAKIF
ERRIF
TX2IF
TX1IF
TX0IF
RX1IF
RX0IF 0000 0000 0000 0000
IVRIE
WAKIE
ERRIE
TX2IE
TX1IE
TX0IE
RX1IE
RX0IE 0000 0000 0000 0000
RERRCNT<7:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 114
TABLE 17-1:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.0
DATA CONVERTER
INTERFACE (DCI) MODULE
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
18.1
Module Introduction
The dsPIC30F Data Converter Interface (DCI) module
allows simple interfacing of devices, such as audio
coder/decoders (Codecs), A/D converters and D/A
converters. The following interfaces are supported:
• Framed Synchronous Serial Transfer (single or
multichannel)
• Inter-IC Sound (I2S) Interface
• AC-Link Compliant mode
The DCI module provides the following general
features:
• Programmable word size up to 16 bits
• Support for up to 16 time slots, for a maximum
frame size of 256 bits
• Data buffering for up to 4 samples without CPU
overhead
18.2
Module I/O Pins
18.2.3
CSDI PIN
The serial data input (CSDI) pin is configured as an
input only pin when the module is enabled.
18.2.3.1
COFS PIN
The Codec Frame Synchronization (COFS) pin is used
to synchronize data transfers that occur on the CSDO
and CSDI pins. The COFS pin may be configured as an
input or an output. The data direction for the COFS pin
is determined by the COFSD control bit in the
DCICON1 register.
The DCI module accesses the shadow registers while
the CPU is in the process of accessing the memory
mapped buffer registers.
18.2.4
BUFFER DATA ALIGNMENT
Data values are always stored left justified in the buffers since most Codec data is represented as a signed
2’s complement fractional number. If the received word
length is less than 16 bits, the unused LSbs in the
receive buffer registers are set to ‘0’ by the module. If
the transmitted word length is less than 16 bits, the
unused LSbs in the transmit buffer register are ignored
by the module. The word length setup is described in
subsequent sections of this document.
18.2.5
TRANSMIT/RECEIVE SHIFT
REGISTER
There are four I/O pins associated with the module.
When enabled, the module controls the data direction
of each of the four pins.
The DCI module has a 16-bit shift register for shifting
serial data in and out of the module. Data is shifted in/
out of the shift register MSb first, since audio PCM data
is transmitted in signed 2’s complement format.
18.2.1
18.2.6
CSCK PIN
The CSCK pin provides the serial clock for the DCI
module. The CSCK pin may be configured as an input
or output using the CSCKD control bit in the DCICON1
SFR. When configured as an output, the serial clock is
provided by the dsPIC30F. When configured as an
input, the serial clock must be provided by an external
device.
18.2.2
CSDO PIN
The serial data output (CSDO) pin is configured as an
output only pin when the module is enabled. The
CSDO pin drives the serial bus whenever data is to be
transmitted. The CSDO pin is tri-stated or driven to ‘0’
during CSCK periods when data is not transmitted,
depending on the state of the CSDOM control bit. This
allows other devices to place data on the serial bus
during transmission periods not used by the DCI
module.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DCI BUFFER CONTROL
The DCI module contains a buffer control unit for transferring data between the shadow buffer memory and
the serial shift register. The buffer control unit is a simple 2-bit address counter that points to word locations
in the shadow buffer memory. For the receive memory
space (high address portion of DCI buffer memory), the
address counter is concatenated with a ‘0’ in the MSb
location to form a 3-bit address. For the transmit memory space (high portion of DCI buffer memory), the
address counter is concatenated with a ‘1’ in the MSb
location.
Note:
The DCI buffer control unit always
accesses the same relative location in the
transmit and receive buffers, so only one
address counter is provided.
DS70138E-page 115
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 18-1:
DCI MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
BCG Control bits
SCKD
FOSC/4
Sample Rate
CSCK
Generator
FSD
Word Size Selection bits
Frame Length Selection bits
16-bit Data Bus
DCI Mode Selection bits
Frame
Synchronization
Generator
COFS
Receive Buffer
Registers w/Shadow
DCI Buffer
Control Unit
15
Transmit Buffer
Registers w/Shadow
0
DCI Shift Register
CSDI
CSDO
DS70138E-page 116
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3
18.3.1
DCI Module Operation
MODULE ENABLE
The DCI module is enabled or disabled by setting/
clearing the DCIEN control bit in the DCICON1 SFR.
Clearing the DCIEN control bit has the effect of resetting the module. In particular, all counters associated
with CSCK generation, Frame Sync, and the DCI buffer
control unit are reset.
18.3.4
FRAME SYNC MODE
CONTROL BITS
The type of Frame Sync signal is selected using the
Frame
Synchronization
mode
control
bits
(COFSM<1:0>) in the DCICON1 SFR. The following
operating modes can be selected:
The DCI clocks are shut down when the DCIEN bit is
cleared.
•
•
•
•
When enabled, the DCI controls the data direction for
the four I/O pins associated with the module. The port,
LAT and TRIS register values for these I/O pins are
overridden by the DCI module when the DCIEN bit is set.
The operation of the COFSM control bits depends on
whether the DCI module generates the Frame Sync
signal as a master device, or receives the Frame Sync
signal as a slave device.
It is also possible to override the CSCK pin separately
when the bit clock generator is enabled. This permits
the bit clock generator to operate without enabling the
rest of the DCI module.
The master device in a DSP/Codec pair is the device
that generates the Frame Sync signal. The Frame Sync
signal initiates data transfers on the CSDI and CSDO
pins and usually has the same frequency as the data
sample rate (COFS).
18.3.2
The DCI module is a Frame Sync master if the COFSD
control bit is cleared and is a Frame Sync slave if the
COFSD control bit is set.
WORD-SIZE SELECTION BITS
The WS<3:0> word-size selection bits in the DCICON2
SFR determine the number of bits in each DCI data
word. Essentially, the WS<3:0> bits determine the
counting period for a 4-bit counter clocked from the
CSCK signal.
Any data length, up to 16 bits, may be selected. The
value loaded into the WS<3:0> bits is one less the
desired word length. For example, a 16-bit data word
size is selected when WS<3:0> = 1111.
Note:
18.3.3
These WS<3:0> control bits are used only
in the Multichannel and I2S modes. These
bits have no effect in AC-Link mode since
the data slot sizes are fixed by the protocol.
FRAME SYNC GENERATOR
The Frame Sync generator (COFSG) is a 4-bit counter
that sets the frame length in data words. The Frame
Sync generator is incremented each time the word-size
counter is reset (refer to Section 18.3.2 “Word-Size
Selection Bits”). The period for the Frame Synchronization generator is set by writing the COFSG<3:0>
control bits in the DCICON2 SFR. The COFSG period
in clock cycles is determined by the following formula:
EQUATION 18-1:
COFSG PERIOD
Frame Length = Word Length • (FSG Value + 1)
Frame lengths, up to 16 data words, may be selected.
The frame length in CSCK periods can vary up to a
maximum of 256 depending on the word size that is
selected.
Note:
Multichannel mode
I2S mode
AC-Link mode (16-bit)
AC-Link mode (20-bit)
18.3.5
MASTER FRAME SYNC
OPERATION
When the DCI module is operating as a Frame Sync
master device (COFSD = 0), the COFSM mode bits
determine the type of Frame Sync pulse that is
generated by the Frame Sync generator logic.
A new COFS signal is generated when the Frame Sync
generator resets to ‘0’.
In the Multichannel mode, the Frame Sync pulse is
driven high for the CSCK period to initiate a data transfer. The number of CSCK cycles between successive
Frame Sync pulses depends on the word size and
Frame Sync generator control bits. A timing diagram for
the Frame Sync signal in Multichannel mode is shown
in Figure 18-2.
In the AC-Link mode of operation, the Frame Sync
signal has a fixed period and duty cycle. The AC-Link
Frame Sync signal is high for 16 CSCK cycles and is
low for 240 CSCK cycles. A timing diagram with the
timing details at the start of an AC-Link frame is shown
in Figure 18-3.
In the I2S mode, a Frame Sync signal having a 50%
duty cycle is generated. The period of the I2S Frame
Sync signal in CSCK cycles is determined by the word
size and Frame Sync generator control bits. A new I2S
data transfer boundary is marked by a high-to-low or a
low-to-high transition edge on the COFS pin.
The COFSG control bits have no effect in
AC-Link mode since the frame length is
set to 256 CSCK periods by the protocol.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 117
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3.6
SLAVE FRAME SYNC OPERATION
When the DCI module is operating as a Frame Sync
slave (COFSD = 1), data transfers are controlled by the
Codec device attached to the DCI module. The
COFSM control bits control how the DCI module
responds to incoming COFS signals.
In the Multichannel mode, a new data frame transfer
begins one CSCK cycle after the COFS pin is sampled
high (see Figure 18-2). The pulse on the COFS pin
resets the Frame Sync generator logic.
FIGURE 18-2:
In the I2S mode, a new data word is transferred one
CSCK cycle after a low-to-high or a high-to-low transition is sampled on the COFS pin. A rising or falling
edge on the COFS pin resets the Frame Sync
generator logic.
In the AC-Link mode, the tag slot and subsequent data
slots for the next frame is transferred one CSCK cycle
after the COFS pin is sampled high.
The COFSG and WS bits must be configured to
provide the proper frame length when the module is
operating in the Slave mode. Once a valid Frame Sync
pulse has been sampled by the module on the COFS
pin, an entire data frame transfer takes place. The
module will not respond to further Frame Sync pulses
until the data frame transfer has completed.
FRAME SYNC TIMING, MULTICHANNEL MODE
CSCK
COFS
CSDI/CSDO
FIGURE 18-3:
MSB
LSB
FRAME SYNC TIMING, AC-LINK START-OF-FRAME
BIT_CLK
CSDO or CSDI
S12 S12 S12 Tag Tag Tag
bit 2 bit 1 LSb MSb bit 14 bit 13
SYNC
FIGURE 18-4:
I2S INTERFACE FRAME SYNC TIMING
CSCK
CSDI or CSDO
MSB
LSB MSB
LSB
WS
Note:
A 5-bit transfer is shown here for illustration purposes. The I2S protocol does not specify word length – this
will be system dependent.
DS70138E-page 118
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3.7
BIT CLOCK GENERATOR
EQUATION 18-2:
The DCI module has a dedicated 12-bit time base that
produces the bit clock. The bit clock rate (period) is set
by writing a non-zero 12-bit value to the BCG<11:0>
control bits in the DCICON3 SFR.
When the BCG<11:0> bits are set to zero, the bit clock
is disabled. If the BCG<11:0> bits are set to a non-zero
value, the bit clock generator is enabled. These bits
should be set to ‘0’ and the CSCKD bit set to ‘1’ if the
serial clock for the DCI is received from an external
device.
The formula for the bit clock frequency is given in
Equation 18-2.
TABLE 18-1:
BIT CLOCK FREQUENCY
FBCK =
FCY
2 • (BCG + 1)
The required bit clock frequency is determined by the
system sampling rate and frame size. Typical bit clock
frequencies range from 16x to 512x the converter
sample rate depending on the data converter and the
communication protocol that is used.
To achieve bit clock frequencies associated with
common audio sampling rates, the user needs to select
a crystal frequency that has an ‘even’ binary value.
Examples of such crystal frequencies are listed in
Table 18-1.
DEVICE FREQUENCIES FOR COMMON CODEC CSCK FREQUENCIES
FS (KHz)
FCSCK/FS
FCSCK (MHz)(1)
FOSC (MHZ)
PLL
FCY (MIPS)
BCG(2)
8
256
2.048
8.192
4
8.192
1
12
256
3.072
6.144
8
12.288
1
32
32
1.024
8.192
8
16.384
7
44.1
32
1.4112
5.6448
8
11.2896
3
48
64
3.072
6.144
16
24.576
3
Note 1:
2:
When the CSCK signal is applied externally (CSCKD = 1), the BCG<11:0> bits have no effect on the
operation of the DCI module.
When the CSCK signal is applied externally (CSCKD = 1), the external clock high and low times must
meet the device timing requirements.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 119
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3.8
SAMPLE CLOCK EDGE
CONTROL BIT
The sample clock edge (CSCKE) control bit determines
the sampling edge for the CSCK signal. If the CSCK bit
is cleared (default), data is sampled on the falling edge
of the CSCK signal. The AC-Link protocols and most
multichannel formats require that data be sampled on
the falling edge of the CSCK signal. If the CSCK bit is
set, data is sampled on the rising edge of CSCK. The
I2S protocol requires that data be sampled on the rising
edge of the CSCK signal.
18.3.9
DATA JUSTIFICATION
CONTROL BIT
In most applications, the data transfer begins one
CSCK cycle after the COFS signal is sampled active.
This is the default configuration of the DCI module. An
alternate data alignment can be selected by setting the
DJST control bit in the DCICON1 SFR. When DJST = 1,
data transfers begin during the same CSCK cycle when
the COFS signal is sampled active.
18.3.10
TRANSMIT SLOT ENABLE BITS
The TSCON SFR has control bits that are used to
enable up to 16 time slots for transmission. These control bits are the TSE<15:0> bits. The size of each time
slot is determined by the WS<3:0> word-size selection
bits and can vary up to 16 bits.
If a transmit time slot is enabled via one of the TSE bits
(TSEx = 1), the contents of the current transmit shadow
buffer location is loaded into the CSDO Shift register
and the DCI buffer control unit is incremented to point
to the next location.
During an unused transmit time slot, the CSDO pin
drives ‘0’s or is tri-stated during all disabled time slots
depending on the state of the CSDOM bit in the
DCICON1 SFR.
The data frame size in bits is determined by the chosen
data word size and the number of data word elements
in the frame. If the chosen frame size has less than 16
elements, the additional slot enable bits have no effect.
Each transmit data word is written to the 16-bit transmit
buffer as left justified data. If the selected word size is
less than 16 bits, then the LSbs of the transmit buffer
memory have no effect on the transmitted data. The
user should write ‘0’s to the unused LSbs of each transmit buffer location.
DS70138E-page 120
18.3.11
RECEIVE SLOT ENABLE BITS
The RSCON SFR contains control bits that are used to
enable up to 16 time slots for reception. These control
bits are the RSE<15:0> bits. The size of each receive
time slot is determined by the WS<3:0> word-size
selection bits and can vary from 1 to 16 bits.
If a receive time slot is enabled via one of the RSE bits
(RSEx = 1), the shift register contents are written to the
current DCI receive shadow buffer location and the
buffer control unit is incremented to point to the next
buffer location.
Data is not packed in the receive memory buffer locations if the selected word size is less than 16 bits. Each
received slot data word is stored in a separate 16-bit
buffer location. Data is always stored in a left justified
format in the receive memory buffer.
18.3.12
SLOT ENABLE BITS OPERATION
WITH FRAME SYNC
The TSE and RSE control bits operate in concert with
the DCI Frame Sync generator. In the Master mode, a
COFS signal is generated whenever the Frame Sync
generator is reset. In the Slave mode, the Frame Sync
generator is reset whenever a COFS pulse is received.
The TSE and RSE control bits allow up to 16 consecutive time slots to be enabled for transmit or receive.
After the last enabled time slot has been transmitted/
received, the DCI stops buffering data until the next
occurring COFS pulse.
18.3.13
SYNCHRONOUS DATA
TRANSFERS
The DCI buffer control unit is incremented by one word
location whenever a given time slot has been enabled
for transmission or reception. In most cases, data input
and output transfers are synchronized, which means
that a data sample is received for a given channel at the
same time a data sample is transmitted. Therefore, the
transmit and receive buffers are filled with equal
amounts of data when a DCI interrupt is generated.
In some cases, the amount of data transmitted and
received during a data frame may not be equal. As an
example, assume a two-word data frame is used.
Furthermore, assume that data is only received during
slot #0 but is transmitted during slot #0 and slot #1. In
this case, the buffer control unit counter would be
incremented twice during a data frame but only one
receive register location would be filled with data.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3.14
BUFFER LENGTH CONTROL
The amount of data that is buffered between interrupts
is determined by the buffer length (BLEN<1:0>) control
bits in the DCICON2 SFR. The size of the transmit and
receive buffers may be varied from 1 to 4 data words
using the BLEN control bits. The BLEN control bits are
compared to the current value of the DCI buffer control
unit address counter. When the two LSbs of the DCI
address counter match the BLEN<1:0> value, the
buffer control unit is reset to ‘0’. In addition, the contents of the receive shadow registers are transferred to
the receive buffer registers and the contents of the
transmit buffer registers are transferred to the transmit
shadow registers.
18.3.15
BUFFER ALIGNMENT WITH DATA
FRAMES
18.3.16
There are two transmit Status bits in the DCISTAT SFR.
The TMPTY bit is set when the contents of the transmit
buffer registers are transferred to the transmit shadow
registers. The TMPTY bit may be polled in software to
determine when the transmit buffer registers may be
written. The TMPTY bit is cleared automatically by the
hardware when a write to one of the four transmit
buffers occurs.
The TUNF bit is read-only and indicates that a transmit
underflow has occurred for at least one of the transmit
buffer registers that is in use. The TUNF bit is set at the
time the transmit buffer registers are transferred to the
transmit shadow registers. The TUNF Status bit is
cleared automatically when the buffer register that
underflowed is written by the CPU.
There is no direct coupling between the position of the
AGU Address Pointer and the data frame boundaries.
This means that there is an implied assignment of each
transmit and receive buffer that is a function of the
BLEN control bits and the number of enabled data slots
via the TSE and RSE control bits.
Note:
As an example, assume that a 4-word data frame is
chosen and that we want to transmit on all four time
slots in the frame. This configuration would be established by setting the TSE0, TSE1, TSE2, and TSE3
control bits in the TSCON SFR. With this module setup,
the TXBUF0 register would be naturally assigned to
slot #0, the TXBUF1 register would be naturally
assigned to slot #1, and so on.
18.3.17
Note:
When more than four time slots are active
within a data frame, the user code must
keep track of which time slots are to be
read/written at each interrupt. In some
cases, the alignment between transmit/
receive buffers and their respective slot
assignments could be lost. Examples of
such cases include an emulation breakpoint or a hardware trap. In these situations, the user should poll the SLOT Status
bits to determine what data should be
loaded into the buffer registers to
resynchronize the software with the DCI
module.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TRANSMIT STATUS BITS
The transmit Status bits only indicate status for buffer locations that are used by the
module. If the buffer length is set to less
than four words, for example, the unused
buffer locations do not affect the transmit
Status bits.
RECEIVE STATUS BITS
There are two receive Status bits in the DCISTAT SFR.
The RFUL Status bit is read-only and indicates that
new data is available in the receive buffers. The RFUL
bit is cleared automatically when all receive buffers in
use have been read by the CPU.
The ROV Status bit is read-only and indicates that a
receive overflow has occurred for at least one of the
receive buffer locations. A receive overflow occurs
when the buffer location is not read by the CPU before
new data is transferred from the shadow registers. The
ROV Status bit is cleared automatically when the buffer
register that caused the overflow is read by the CPU.
When a receive overflow occurs for a specific buffer
location, the old contents of the buffer are overwritten.
Note:
The receive Status bits only indicate status
for buffer locations that are used by the
module. If the buffer length is set to less
than four words, for example, the unused
buffer locations do not affect the transmit
Status bits.
DS70138E-page 121
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.3.18
SLOT STATUS BITS
18.4
The SLOT<3:0> Status bits in the DCISTAT SFR indicate the current active time slot. These bits correspond
to the value of the Frame Sync generator counter. The
user may poll these Status bits in software when a DCI
interrupt occurs to determine what time slot data was
last received and which time slot data should be loaded
into the TXBUF registers.
18.3.19
CSDO MODE BIT
The CSDOM control bit controls the behavior of the
CSDO pin during unused transmit slots. A given transmit time slot is unused if it’s corresponding TSEx bit in
the TSCON SFR is cleared.
If the CSDOM bit is cleared (default), the CSDO pin is
low during unused time slot periods. This mode is used
when there are only two devices attached to the serial
bus.
If the CSDOM bit is set, the CSDO pin is tri-stated during unused time slot periods. This mode allows multiple
devices to share the same CSDO line in a multichannel
application. Each device on the CSDO line is configured so that it only transmits data during specific time
slots. No two devices transmit data during the same
time slot.
18.3.20
DIGITAL LOOPBACK MODE
Digital Loopback mode is enabled by setting
DLOOP control bit in the DCICON1 SFR. When
DLOOP bit is set, the module internally connects
CSDO signal to CSDI. The actual data input on
CSDI I/O pin is ignored in Digital Loopback mode.
18.3.21
the
the
the
the
UNDERFLOW MODE CONTROL BIT
When an underflow occurs, one of two actions may
occur depending on the state of the Underflow mode
(UNFM) control bit in the DCICON1 SFR. If the UNFM
bit is cleared (default), the module transmits ‘0’s on the
CSDO pin during the active time slot for the buffer location. In this operating mode, the Codec device attached
to the DCI module is simply fed digital ‘silence’. If the
UNFM control bit is set, the module transmits the last
data written to the buffer location. This operating mode
permits the user to send continuous data to the Codec
device without consuming CPU overhead.
DS70138E-page 122
DCI Module Interrupts
The frequency of DCI module interrupts is dependent
on the BLEN<1:0> control bits in the DCICON2 SFR.
An interrupt to the CPU is generated each time the set
buffer length has been reached and a shadow register
transfer takes place. A shadow register transfer is
defined as the time when the previously written TXBUF
values are transferred to the transmit shadow registers
and new received values in the receive shadow
registers are transferred into the RXBUF registers.
18.5
18.5.1
DCI Module Operation During CPU
Sleep and Idle Modes
DCI MODULE OPERATION DURING
CPU SLEEP MODE
The DCI module has the ability to operate while in
Sleep mode and wake the CPU when the CSCK signal
is supplied by an external device (CSCKD = 1). The
DCI module generates an asynchronous interrupt
when a DCI buffer transfer has completed and the CPU
is in Sleep mode.
18.5.2
DCI MODULE OPERATION DURING
CPU IDLE MODE
If the DCISIDL control bit is cleared (default), the module continues to operate normally even in Idle mode. If
the DCISIDL bit is set, the module halts when Idle
mode is asserted.
18.6
AC-Link Mode Operation
The AC-Link protocol is a 256-bit frame with one 16-bit
data slot, followed by twelve 20-bit data slots. The DCI
module has two operating modes for the AC-Link protocol. These operating modes are selected by the
COFSM<1:0> control bits in the DCICON1 SFR. The
first AC-Link mode is called ‘16-bit AC-Link mode’ and
is selected by setting COFSM<1:0> = 10. The second
AC-Link mode is called ‘20-bit AC-Link mode’ and is
selected by setting COFSM<1:0> = 11.
18.6.1
16-BIT AC-LINK MODE
In the 16-bit AC-Link mode, data word lengths are
restricted to 16 bits. Note that this restriction only
affects the 20-bit data time slots of the AC-Link protocol. For received time slots, the incoming data is simply
truncated to 16 bits. For outgoing time slots, the 4 LSbs
of the data word are set to ‘0’ by the module. This truncation of the time slots limits the A/D and DAC data to
16 bits but permits proper data alignment in the TXBUF
and RXBUF registers. Each RXBUF and TXBUF
register contains one data time slot value.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
18.6.2
20-BIT AC-LINK MODE
The 20-bit AC-Link mode allows all bits in the data time
slots to be transmitted and received but does not maintain data alignment in the TXBUF and RXBUF
registers.
The 20-bit AC-Link mode functions similar to the Multichannel mode of the DCI module, except for the duty
cycle of the Frame Synchronization signal. The ACLink Frame Synchronization signal should remain high
for 16 CSCK cycles and should be low for the following
240 cycles.
The 20-bit mode treats each 256-bit AC-Link frame as
sixteen, 16-bit time slots. In the 20-bit AC-Link mode,
the module operates as if COFSG<3:0> = 1111 and
WS<3:0> = 1111. The data alignment for 20-bit data
slots is ignored. For example, an entire AC-Link data
frame can be transmitted and received in a packed
fashion by setting all bits in the TSCON and RSCON
SFRs. Since the total available buffer length is 64 bits,
it would take 4 consecutive interrupts to transfer the
AC-Link frame. The application software must keep
track of the current AC-Link frame segment.
18.7
18.7.1
I2S FRAME AND DATA WORD
LENGTH SELECTION
The WS and COFSG control bits are set to produce the
period for one half of an I2S data frame. That is, the
frame length is the total number of CSCK cycles
required for a left or a right data word transfer.
The BLEN bits must be set for the desired buffer length.
Setting BLEN<1:0> = 01 produces a CPU interrupt,
once per I2S frame.
18.7.2
I2S DATA JUSTIFICATION
As per the I2S specification, a data word transfer, by
default, begins one CSCK cycle after a transition of the
WS signal. A ‘MSb left justified’ option can be selected
using the DJST control bit in the DCICON1 SFR.
If DJST = 1, the I2S data transfers are MSb left justified.
The MSb of the data word is presented on the CSDO
pin during the same CSCK cycle as the rising or falling
edge of the COFS signal. The CSDO pin is tri-stated
after the data word has been sent.
I2S Mode Operation
The DCI module is configured for I2S mode by writing
a value of ‘01’ to the COFSM<1:0> control bits in the
DCICON1 SFR. When operating in the I2S mode, the
DCI module generates Frame Synchronization signals
with a 50% duty cycle. Each edge of the Frame
Synchronization signal marks the boundary of a new
data word transfer.
The user must also select the frame length and data
word size using the COFSG and WS control bits in the
DCICON2 SFR.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 123
dsPIC30F3014/4013 DCI REGISTER MAP
SFR Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
DCICON1
0240
DCIEN
—
DCISIDL
—
DLOOP
CSCKD
DCICON2
0242
—
—
—
—
BLEN1
BLEN0
DCICON3
0244
—
—
—
—
DCISTAT
0246
—
—
—
—
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
CSCKE COFSD UNFM
—
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
CSDOM
DJST
—
—
—
COFSM1
COFSG<3:0>
—
Bit 0
WS<3:0>
0000 0000 0000 0000
BCG<11:0>
SLOT3
SLOT2
SLOT1
SLOT0
—
—
—
Reset State
COFSM0 0000 0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000 0000
—
ROV
RFUL
TUNF
TMPTY
0000 0000 0000 0000
TSCON
0248
TSE15
TSE14
TSE13
TSE12
TSE11
TSE10
TSE9
TSE8
TSE7
TSE6
TSE5
TSE4
TSE3
TSE2
TSE1
TSE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
RSCON
024C
RSE15
RSE14
RSE13
RSE12
RSE11
RSE10
RSE9
RSE8
RSE7
RSE6
RSE5
RSE4 RSE3
RSE2
RSE1
RSE0
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXBUF0
0250
Receive Buffer #0 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXBUF1
0252
Receive Buffer #1 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXBUF2
0254
Receive Buffer #2 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
RXBUF3
0256
Receive Buffer #3 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXBUF0
0258
Transmit Buffer #0 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXBUF1
025A
Transmit Buffer #1 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXBUF2
025C
Transmit Buffer #2 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
TXBUF3
025E
Transmit Buffer #3 Data Register
0000 0000 0000 0000
Legend:
1:
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 124
TABLE 18-2:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.0
12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (ADC) MODULE
The A/D module has six 16-bit registers:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046).
The ADCON1, ADCON2 and ADCON3 registers
control the operation of the A/D module. The ADCHS
register selects the input channels to be converted. The
ADPCFG register configures the port pins as analog
inputs or as digital I/O. The ADCSSL register selects
inputs for scanning.
The 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) allows
conversion of an analog input signal to a 12-bit digital
number. This module is based on a Successive
Approximation Register (SAR) architecture and provides a maximum sampling rate of 200 ksps. The A/D
module has up to 16 analog inputs which are multiplexed into a sample and hold amplifier. The output of
the sample and hold is the input into the converter
which generates the result. The analog reference voltage is software selectable to either the device supply
voltage (AVDD/AVSS) or the voltage level on the
(VREF+/VREF-) pin. The A/D converter has a unique
feature of being able to operate while the device is in
Sleep mode with RC oscillator selection.
FIGURE 19-1:
A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
A/D Control Register 2 (ADCON2)
A/D Control Register 3 (ADCON3)
A/D Input Select Register (ADCHS)
A/D Port Configuration Register (ADPCFG)
A/D Input Scan Selection Register (ADCSSL)
Note:
The SSRC<2:0>, ASAM, SMPI<3:0>,
BUFM and ALTS bits, as well as the
ADCON3 and ADCSSL registers, must
not be written to while ADON = 1. This
would lead to indeterminate results.
The block diagram of the 12-bit A/D module is shown in
Figure 19-1.
12-BIT A/D FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM
AVDD
AVSS
VREF+
VREF-
AN2
AN3
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
AN8
AN9
AN10
AN11
AN12
DAC
0001
0010
12-bit SAR
0011
Conversion Logic
0100
16-word, 12-bit
Dual Port
RAM
0101
0110
0111
1000
Sample/Sequence
Control
Sample
Bus Interface
AN1
Comparator
0000
Data
Format
AN0
1001
1010
Input
Switches
1011
Input MUX
Control
1100
VREFAN1
S/H
CH0
Note: The ADCHS, ADPCFG and ADCSSL registers allow the application to configure AN13-AN15 as analog input pins.
Since these pins are not physically present on the device, conversion results from these pins will read ‘0’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 125
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.1
A/D Result Buffer
The module contains a 16-word dual port read-only
buffer, called ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, to buffer the A/D
results. The RAM is 12 bits wide but the data obtained
is represented in one of four different 16-bit data formats. The contents of the sixteen A/D Conversion
Result Buffer registers, ADCBUF0 through ADCBUFF,
cannot be written by user software.
19.2
Conversion Operation
After the A/D module has been configured, the sample
acquisition is started by setting the SAMP bit. Various
sources, such as a programmable bit, timer time-outs
and external events, terminate acquisition and start a
conversion. When the A/D conversion is complete, the
result is loaded into ADCBUF0...ADCBUFF, and the
DONE bit and the A/D interrupt flag, ADIF, are set after
the number of samples specified by the SMPI bit. The
ADC module can be configured for different interrupt
rates as described in Section 19.3 “Selecting the
Conversion Sequence”.
The following steps should be followed for doing an
A/D conversion:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Configure the A/D module:
• Configure analog pins, voltage reference and
digital I/O
• Select A/D input channels
• Select A/D conversion clock
• Select A/D conversion trigger
• Turn on A/D module
Configure A/D interrupt (if required):
• Clear ADIF bit
• Select A/D interrupt priority
• Set ADIE bit (for ISR processing)
Start sampling
Wait the required acquisition time
Trigger acquisition end, start conversion:
Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either:
• Waiting for the A/D interrupt, or
• Waiting for the DONE bit to get set.
Read A/D result buffer, clear ADIF if required
19.3
Several groups of control bits select the sequence in
which the A/D connects inputs to the sample/hold
channel, converts a channel, writes the buffer memory
and generates interrupts.
The sequence is controlled by the sampling clocks.
The SMPI bits select the number of acquisition/
conversion sequences that would be performed before
an interrupt occurs. This can vary from 1 sample per
interrupt to 16 samples per interrupt.
The BUFM bit splits the 16-word results buffer into two
8-word groups. Writing to the 8-word buffers is alternated on each interrupt event.
Use of the BUFM bit depends on how much time is
available for moving the buffers after the interrupt.
If the processor can quickly unload a full buffer within
the time it takes to acquire and convert one channel,
the BUFM bit can be ‘0’ and up to 16 conversions (corresponding to the 16 input channels) may be done per
interrupt. The processor has one acquisition and
conversion time to move the sixteen conversions.
If the processor cannot unload the buffer within the
acquisition and conversion time, the BUFM bit should be
‘1’. For example, if SMPI<3:0> (ADCON2<5:2>) = 0111,
then eight conversions are loaded into 1/2 of the buffer,
following which an interrupt occurs. The next eight conversions are loaded into the other 1/2 of the buffer. The
processor has the entire time between interrupts to
move the eight conversions.
The ALTS bit can be used to alternate the inputs
selected during the sampling sequence. The input
multiplexer has two sets of sample inputs: MUX A and
MUX B. If the ALTS bit is ‘0’, only the MUX A inputs are
selected for sampling. If the ALTS bit is ‘1’ and
SMPI<3:0> = 0000 on the first sample/convert
sequence, the MUX A inputs are selected and on the
next acquire/convert sequence, the MUX B inputs are
selected.
The CSCNA bit (ADCON2<10>) allows the S/H input to
be sequentially scanned across a selected number of
analog inputs for the MUX A group. The inputs are
selected by the ADCSSL register. If a particular bit in
the ADCSSL register is ‘1’, the corresponding input is
selected. The inputs are always scanned from lower to
higher numbered inputs, starting after each interrupt. If
the number of inputs selected is greater than the
number of samples taken per interrupt, the higher
numbered inputs are unused.
Note:
DS70138E-page 126
Selecting the Conversion Sequence
The ADCHS, ADPCFG and ADCSSL registers allow the application to configure
AN13-AN15 as analog input pins. Since
these pins are not physically present on
the device, conversion results from these
pins read ‘0’.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.4
Programming the Start of
Conversion Trigger
The conversion trigger terminates acquisition and
starts the requested conversions.
The SSRC<2:0> bits select the source of the conversion trigger. The SSRC bits provide for up to 4 alternate
sources of conversion trigger.
When SSRC<2:0> = 000, the conversion trigger is
under software control. Clearing the SAMP bit causes
the conversion trigger.
When SSRC<2:0> = 111 (Auto-Convert mode), the
conversion trigger is under A/D clock control. The
SAMC bits select the number of A/D clocks between
the start of acquisition and the start of conversion. This
provides the fastest conversion rates on multiple
channels. SAMC must always be at least 1 clock cycle.
Other trigger sources can come from timer modules or
external interrupts.
19.5
For correct ADC conversions, the ADC conversion
clock (TAD) must be selected to ensure a minimum TAD
time of 334 nsec (for VDD = 5V). Refer to the Electrical
Specifications section for minimum TAD under other
operating conditions.
Example 19-1 shows a sample calculation for the
ADCS<5:0> bits, assuming a device operating speed
of 30 MIPS.
EXAMPLE 19-1:
If clearing of the ADON bit coincides with an auto-start,
the clearing has a higher priority and a new conversion
does not start.
Selecting the ADC Conversion
Clock
The ADC conversion requires 14 TAD. The source of
the ADC conversion clock is software selected, using a
six-bit counter. There are 64 possible options for TAD.
EQUATION 19-1:
ADC CONVERSION
CLOCK CALCULATION
Minimum TAD = 154 nsec
TCY = 33.33 nsec (30 MIPS)
TAD
–1
TCY
154 nsec
=2•
33.33 nsec
= 8.33
ADCS<5:0> = 2
Aborting a Conversion
Clearing the ADON bit during a conversion aborts the
current conversion and stops the sampling sequencing
until the next sampling trigger. The ADCBUF is not
updated with the partially completed A/D conversion
sample. That is, the ADCBUF will continue to contain
the value of the last completed conversion (or the last
value written to the ADCBUF register).
19.6
The internal RC oscillator is selected by setting the
ADRC bit.
–1
Therefore,
Set ADCS<5:0> = 9
TCY
(ADCS<5:0> + 1)
2
33.33 nsec
=
(19 + 1)
2
Actual TAD =
= 165 nsec
If SSRC<2:0> = ‘111’ and SAMC<4:0> = ‘00001’
Since,
Sampling Time = Acquisition Time + Conversion Time
= 1 TAD + 14 TAD
= 15 x 165 nsec
Therefore,
Sampling Rate =
1
(15 x 165 nsec)
= ~100 kHz
ADC CONVERSION
CLOCK
TAD = TCY * (0.5*(ADCS<5:0> + 1))
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 127
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.7
ADC Speeds
The dsPIC30F 12-bit ADC specifications permit a
maximum of 200 ksps sampling rate. The table below
summarizes the conversion speeds for the dsPIC30F
12-bit ADC and the required operating conditions.
TABLE 19-1:
12-BIT ADC EXTENDED CONVERSION RATES
dsPIC30F 12-bit ADC Conversion Rates
Speed
Up to 200
ksps(1)
TAD
Sampling
Minimum Time Min
334 ns
1 TAD
Rs Max
VDD
Temperature
2.5 kΩ
4.5V to 5.5V
-40°C to +85°C
Channels Configuration
VREF- VREF+
CHX
ANx
S/H
Up to 100
ksps
668 ns
1 TAD
2.5 kΩ
3.0V to 5.5V
ADC
-40°C to +125°C
VREF- VREF+
or
or
AVSS AVDD
CHX
ANx
S/H
ADC
ANx or VREF-
Note 1: External VREF- and VREF+ pins must be used for correct operation. See Figure 19-2 for recommended
circuit.
DS70138E-page 128
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
The following figure depicts the recommended circuit
for the conversion rates above 200 ksps. The
dsPIC30F3014 is shown as an example.
35
34
37
36
38
40
39
See Note 1:
1
33
2
32
VSS 31
VSS 30
3
4
5
VDD
42
41
43
ADC VOLTAGE REFERENCE SCHEMATIC
44
FIGURE 19-2:
dsPIC30F3014
6 VSS
7 VDD
8 VDD
VDD
C7
0.1 μF
VDD
C6
0.01 μF
VDD
27
26
AVDD
25
24
23
C5
1 μF
AVDD
C4
0.1 μF
AVDD
C3
0.01 μF
21
22
19 VREF+
20 VREF-
18
17 AVDD
14
15
16 AVSS
12
13
C8
1 μF
VDD 29
VDD 28
9
10
11
VDD
VDD
R2
10
C2
0.1 μF
VDD
R1
10
C1
0.01 μF
Note 1: Ensure adequate bypass capacitors are provided on each VDD pin.
The configuration procedures below give the required
setup values for the conversion speeds above 100
ksps.
• Configure the ADC clock period to be:
1
(14 + 1) x 200,000
19.7.1
200 KSPS CONFIGURATION
GUIDELINE
The following configuration items are required to
achieve a 200 ksps conversion rate.
• Comply with conditions provided in Table 19-2.
• Connect external VREF+ and VREF- pins following
the recommended circuit shown in Figure 19-2.
• Set SSRC<2.0> = 111 in the ADCON1 register to
enable the auto-convert option.
• Enable automatic sampling by setting the ASAM
control bit in the ADCON1 register.
• Write the SMPI<3.0> control bits in the ADCON2
register for the desired number of conversions
between interrupts.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
= 334 ns
by writing to the ADCS<5:0> control bits in the
ADCON3 register.
• Configure the sampling time to be 1 TAD by
writing: SAMC<4:0> = 00001.
The following figure shows the timing diagram of the
ADC running at 200 ksps. The TAD selection in conjunction with the guidelines described above allows a conversion speed of 200 ksps. See Example 19-1 for code
example.
DS70138E-page 129
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 19-3:
CONVERTING 1 CHANNEL AT 200 KSPS, AUTO-SAMPLE START, 1 TAD
SAMPLING TIME
TSAMP
= 1 TAD
TSAMP
= 1 TAD
ADCLK
TCONV
= 14 TAD
TCONV
= 14 TAD
SAMP
DONE
ADCBUF0
ADCBUF1
Instruction Execution BSET ADCON1, ASAM
19.8
A/D Acquisition Requirements
The analog input model of the 12-bit A/D converter is
shown in Figure 19-4. The total sampling time for the A/
D is a function of the internal amplifier settling time and
the holding capacitor charge time.
For the A/D converter to meet its specified accuracy,
the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed
to fully charge to the voltage level on the analog input
pin. The source impedance (RS), the interconnect
impedance (RIC), and the internal sampling switch
(RSS) impedance combine to directly affect the time
FIGURE 19-4:
required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The combined
impedance of the analog sources must therefore be
small enough to fully charge the holding capacitor
within the chosen sample time. To minimize the effects
of pin leakage currents on the accuracy of the A/D converter, the maximum recommended source impedance, RS, is 2.5 kΩ. After the analog input channel is
selected (changed), this sampling function must be
completed prior to starting the conversion. The internal
holding capacitor will be in a discharged state prior to
each sample operation.
12-BIT A/D CONVERTER ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
Rs
VA
ANx
RIC ≤ 250Ω
VT = 0.6V
Sampling
Switch
RSS ≤ 3 kΩ
RSS
CPIN
VT = 0.6V
I leakage
± 500 nA
CHOLD
= DAC capacitance
= 18 pF
VSS
Legend: CPIN
= input capacitance
VT
= threshold voltage
I leakage = leakage current at the pin due to
various junctions
RIC
= interconnect resistance
RSS
= sampling switch resistance
CHOLD
= sample/hold capacitance (from DAC)
Note: CPIN value depends on device package and is not tested. Effect of CPIN negligible if Rs ≤ 2.5 kΩ.
DS70138E-page 130
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.9
Module Power-down Modes
eliminates all digital switching noise from the conversion. (When the conversion sequence is complete, the
DONE bit is set.)
The module has two internal power modes.
When the ADON bit is ‘1’, the module is in Active mode;
it is fully powered and functional.
When ADON is ‘0’, the module is in Off mode. The
digital and analog portions of the circuit are disabled for
maximum current savings.
In order to return to the Active mode from Off mode, the
user must wait for the ADC circuitry to stabilize. The
time required to stabilize is specified in the “Electrical
Characteristics”.
19.10 A/D Operation During CPU Sleep
and Idle Modes
19.10.1
19.10.2
A/D OPERATION DURING CPU IDLE
MODE
The ADSIDL bit determines if the module stops or continues on Idle. If ADSIDL = 0, the module continues
operation on assertion of Idle mode. If ADSIDL = 1, the
module stops on Idle.
19.11 Effects of a Reset
A/D OPERATION DURING CPU
SLEEP MODE
When the device enters Sleep mode, all clock sources
to the module are shut down and stay at logic ‘0’.
If Sleep occurs in the middle of a conversion, the conversion is aborted. The converter does not continue
with a partially completed conversion on exit from
Sleep mode.
Register contents are not affected by the device
entering or leaving Sleep mode.
The A/D module can operate during Sleep mode if the
A/D clock source is set to RC (ADRC = 1). When the RC
clock source is selected, the A/D module waits one
instruction cycle before starting the conversion. This
allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed which
FIGURE 19-5:
If the A/D interrupt is enabled, the device wakes up
from Sleep. If the A/D interrupt is not enabled, the A/D
module is then turned off, although the ADON bit
remains set.
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the A/D module to be turned off, and any
conversion and sampling sequence is aborted. The values that are in the ADCBUF registers are not modified.
The A/D Result register contains unknown data after a
Power-on Reset.
19.12 Output Formats
The A/D result is 12 bits wide. The data buffer RAM is
also 12 bits wide. The 12-bit data can be read in one of
four different formats. The FORM<1:0> bits select the
format. Each of the output formats translates to a 16-bit
result on the data bus. Write data is always in rightjustified (integer) format.
A/D OUTPUT DATA FORMATS
RAM Contents:
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
Read to Bus:
Signed Fractional
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
Fractional
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
Signed Integer
Integer
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
d11 d11 d11 d11 d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
0
0
0
0
d11 d10 d09 d08 d07 d06 d05 d04 d03 d02 d01 d00
DS70138E-page 131
dsPIC30F3014/4013
19.13 Configuring Analog Port Pins
19.14 Connection Considerations
The use of the ADPCFG and TRIS registers control the
operation of the A/D port pins. The port pins that are
desired as analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS bit set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (output), the digital output level (VOH or VOL) is converted.
The analog inputs have diodes to VDD and VSS as ESD
protection. This requires that the analog input be
between VDD and VSS. If the input voltage exceeds this
range by greater than 0.3V (either direction), one of the
diodes becomes forward biased and it may damage the
device if the input current specification is exceeded.
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CH0SA<3:0>/CH0SB<3:0> bits and the TRIS bits.
When reading the PORT register, all pins configured as
analog input channels are read as cleared.
Pins configured as digital inputs will not convert an
analog input. Analog levels on any pin that is defined as
a digital input (including the ANx pins) may cause the
input buffer to consume current that exceeds the
device specifications.
DS70138E-page 132
An external RC filter is sometimes added for antialiasing of the input signal. The R component should be
selected to ensure that the sampling time requirements
are satisfied. Any external components connected (via
high-impedance) to an analog input pin (capacitor,
Zener diode, etc.) should have very little leakage
current at the pin.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 19-2:
A/D CONVERTER REGISTER MAP
SFR
Name
Addr.
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
ADCBUF0
0280
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 0
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF1
0282
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 1
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF2
0284
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 2
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF3
0286
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 3
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF4
0288
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 4
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF5
028A
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 5
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF6
028C
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 6
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF7
028E
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 7
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF8
0290
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 8
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUF9
0292
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 9
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFA
0294
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 10
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFB
0296
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 11
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFC 0298
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 12
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFD 029A
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 13
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFE 029C
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 14
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
ADCBUFF
029E
—
—
—
—
ADC Data Buffer 15
ADCON1
02A0
ADON
—
ADSIDL
—
—
—
—
Bit 10
—
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 7
FORM<1:0>
Bit 6
Bit 5
SSRC<2:0>
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset State
0000 uuuu uuuu uuuu
—
—
ASAM
SAMP
DONE
0000 0000 0000 0000
BUFM
ALTS
0000 0000 0000 0000
ADCON2
02A2
ADCON3
02A4
—
—
—
ADCHS
02A6
—
—
—
ADPCFG
02A8
PCFG15 PCFG14 PCFG13 PCFG12
PCFG11 PCFG10 PCFG9 PCFG8 PCFG7
PCFG6 PCFG5
PCFG4
PCFG3 PCFG2 PCFG1
PCFG0
0000 0000 0000 0000
ADCSSL
02AA
CSSL15 CSSL14 CSSL13
CSSL11
CSSL6
CSSL4
CSSL3
CSSL0
0000 0000 0000 0000
CSCNA
—
—
SAMC<4:0>
CH0NB
CSSL12
CH0SB<3:0>
CSSL10 CSSL9
CSSL8
BUFS
—
ADRC
—
—
—
CSSL7
u = uninitialized bit
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
SMPI<3:0>
ADCS<5:0>
—
CSSL5
CH0NA
0000 0000 0000 0000
CH0SA<3:0>
CSSL2
CSSL1
0000 0000 0000 0000
DS70138E-page 133
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Legend:
1:
VCFG<2:0>
Bit 11
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 134
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.0
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
There are several features intended to maximize
system reliability, minimize cost through elimination of
external components, provide power-saving operating
modes and offer code protection:
• Oscillator Selection
• Reset
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Low-Voltage Detect
• Power-Saving modes (Sleep and Idle)
• Code Protection
• Unit ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP)
20.1
Oscillator System Overview
The dsPIC30F oscillator system has the following
modules and features:
• Various external and internal oscillator options as
clock sources
• An on-chip PLL to boost internal operating
frequency
• A clock switching mechanism between various
clock sources
• Programmable clock postscaler for system power
savings
• A Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) that detects
clock failure and takes fail-safe measures
• Clock Control register (OSCCON)
• Configuration bits for main oscillator selection
Configuration bits determine the clock source upon
Power-on Reset (POR) and Brown-out Reset (BOR).
Thereafter, the clock source can be changed between
permissible clock sources. The OSCCON register
controls the clock switching and reflects system clock
related Status bits.
Table 20-1 provides a summary of the dsPIC30F
oscillator operating modes. A simplified diagram of the
oscillator system is shown in Figure 20-1.
dsPIC30F devices have a Watchdog Timer which is
permanently enabled via the Configuration bits or can
be software controlled. It runs off its own RC oscillator
for added reliability. There are two timers that offer
necessary delays on power-up. One is the Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST), intended to keep the chip in
Reset until the crystal oscillator is stable. The other is
the Power-up Timer (PWRT) which provides a delay on
power-up only, designed to keep the part in Reset while
the power supply stabilizes. With these two timers onchip, most applications need no external Reset
circuitry.
Sleep mode is designed to offer a very low-current
Power-Down mode. The user can wake-up from Sleep
through external Reset, Watchdog Timer Wake-up, or
through an interrupt. Several oscillator options are also
made available to allow the part to fit a wide variety of
applications. In the Idle mode, the clock sources are
still active but the CPU is shut-off. The RC oscillator
option saves system cost while the LP crystal option
saves power.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 135
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 20-1:
OSCILLATOR OPERATING MODES
Oscillator Mode
Description
XTL
200 kHz-4 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2
XT
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2
XT w/PLL 4x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 4x PLL enabled
XT w/PLL 8x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 8x PLL enabled
XT w/PLL 16x
4 MHz-10 MHz crystal on OSC1:OSC2, 16x PLL enabled(1)
LP
32 kHz crystal on SOSCO:SOSCI(2)
HS
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal
HS/2 w/PLL 4x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 4x PLL enabled
HS/2 w/PLL 8x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 8x PLL enabled
HS/2 w/PLL 16x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 2, 16x PLL enabled
HS/3 w/PLL 4x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 4x PLL enabled
HS/3 w/PLL 8x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 8x PLL enabled
HS/3 w/PLL 16x
10 MHz-25 MHz crystal, divide by 3, 16x PLL enabled
EC
External clock input (0-40 MHz)
ECIO
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O
EC w/PLL 4x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 4x PLL enabled(1)
EC w/PLL 8x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 8x PLL enabled(1)
EC w/PLL 16x
External clock input (0-40 MHz), OSC2 pin is I/O, 16x PLL enabled(1)
ERC
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is FOSC/4 output(3)
ERCIO
External RC oscillator, OSC2 pin is I/O(3)
FRC
7.37 MHz internal RC oscillator
FRC w/PLL 4x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 4x PLL enabled
FRC w/PLL 8x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 8x PLL enabled
FRC w/PLL 16x
7.37 MHz Internal RC oscillator, 16x PLL enabled
LPRC
512 kHz internal RC oscillator
Note 1:
2:
3:
dsPIC30F maximum operating frequency of 120 MHz must be met.
LP oscillator can be conveniently shared as system clock, as well as real-time clock for Timer1.
Requires external R and C. Frequency operation up to 4 MHz.
DS70138E-page 136
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 20-1:
OSCILLATOR SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Oscillator Configuration bits
PWRSAV Instruction
Wake-up Request
OSC1
OSC2
FPLL
Primary
Oscillator
PLL
PLL
x4, x8, x16
Lock
COSC<2:0>
Primary Osc
NOSC<2:0>
Primary
Oscillator
OSWEN
Stability Detector
POR Done
Oscillator
Start-up
Timer
Clock
Secondary Osc
SOSCO
SOSCI
32 kHz LP
Oscillator
Switching
and Control
Block
Secondary
Oscillator
Stability Detector
Programmable
Clock Divider System
Clock
2
POST<1:0>
TUN<3:0>
4
Internal Fast RC
Oscillator (FRC)
Internal Low
Power RC
Oscillator (LPRC)
FCKSM<1:0>
2
LPRC
Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor (FSCM)
CF
Oscillator Trap
To Timer1
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 137
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.2
20.2.2
Oscillator Configurations
20.2.1
INITIAL CLOCK SOURCE
SELECTION
In order to ensure that a crystal oscillator (or ceramic
resonator) has started and stabilized, an Oscillator
Start-up Timer is included. It is a simple 10-bit counter
that counts 1024 TOSC cycles before releasing the
oscillator clock to the rest of the system. The time-out
period is designated as TOST. The TOST time is involved
every time the oscillator has to restart (i.e., on POR,
BOR and wake-up from Sleep). The Oscillator Start-up
Timer is applied to the LP oscillator, XT, XTL, and HS
modes (upon wake-up from Sleep, POR and BOR) for
the primary oscillator.
While coming out of Power-on Reset or Brown-out
Reset, the device selects its clock source based on:
a)
b)
FOS<2:0> Configuration bits that select one of
four oscillator groups,
and FPR<4:0> Configuration bits that select one
of 13 oscillator choices within the primary group.
The selection is as shown in Table 20-2.
TABLE 20-2:
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
(OST)
CONFIGURATION BIT VALUES FOR CLOCK SELECTION
Oscillator Mode
Oscillator
Source
FOS<2:0>
OSC2
Function
FPR<4:0>
ECIO w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
I/O
ECIO w/PLL 8x
PLL
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
I/O
ECIO w/PLL 16x
PLL
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
I/O
FRC w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
I/O
FRC w/PLL 8x
PLL
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
I/O
FRC w/PLL 16x
PLL
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
I/O
XT w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
OSC2
XT w/PLL 8x
PLL
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
OSC2
XT w/PLL 16x
PLL
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
OSC2
HS2 w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
1
OSC2
HS2 w/PLL 8x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
OSC2
HS2 w/PLL 16x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
OSC2
HS3 w/PLL 4x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
OSC2
HS3 w/PLL 8x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
0
OSC2
HS3 w/PLL 16x
PLL
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
OSC2
ECIO
External
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
I/O
XT
External
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
OSC2
HS
External
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
OSC2
EXT
External
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
CLKO
ERC
External
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
CLKO
ERCIO
External
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
I/O
XTL
External
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
OSC2
LP
Secondary
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
(Notes 1, 2)
FRC
Internal FRC
0
0
1
X
X
X
X
X
(Notes 1, 2)
LPRC
Internal LPRC
0
1
0
X
X
X
X
X
(Notes 1, 2)
Note 1:
2:
OSC2 pin function is determined by (FPR<4:0>).
Note that OSC1 pin cannot be used as an I/O pin even if the secondary oscillator or an internal clock
source is selected at all times.
DS70138E-page 138
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.2.3
LP OSCILLATOR CONTROL
Note:
When a 16x PLL is used, the FRC
frequency must not be tuned to a
frequency greater than 7.5 MHz.
Enabling the LP oscillator is controlled with two
elements:
1.
2.
The current oscillator group bits COSC<2:0>.
The LPOSCEN bit (OSCCON register).
The LP oscillator is on (even during Sleep mode) if
LPOSCEN = 1. The LP oscillator is the device clock if:
• COSC<2:0> = 00 (LP selected as main oscillator)
and
• LPOSCEN = 1
Keeping the LP oscillator on at all times allows for a fast
switch to the 32 kHz system clock for lower power
operation. Returning to the faster main oscillator still
requires a start-up time
20.2.4
PHASE LOCKED LOOP (PLL)
The PLL multiplies the clock which is generated by the
primary oscillator. The PLL is selectable to have either
gains of x4, x8, and x16. Input and output frequency
ranges are summarized in Table 20-3.
TABLE 20-3:
PLL FREQUENCY RANGE
FIN
PLL
Multiplier
FOUT
4 MHz-10 MHz
x4
16 MHz-40 MHz
4 MHz-10 MHz
x8
32 MHz-80 MHz
4 MHz-7.5 MHz
x16
64 MHz-120 MHz
The PLL features a lock output which is asserted when
the PLL enters a phase locked state. Should the loop
fall out of lock (e.g., due to noise), the lock signal is
rescinded. The state of this signal is reflected in the
read-only LOCK bit in the OSCCON register.
20.2.5
FAST RC OSCILLATOR (FRC)
The FRC oscillator is a fast (7.37 MHz ±2% nominal)
internal RC oscillator. This oscillator is intended to provide reasonable device operating speeds without the
use of an external crystal, ceramic resonator, or RC
network. The FRC oscillator can be used with the PLL
to obtain higher clock frequencies.
The dsPIC30F operates from the FRC oscillator whenever the current oscillator selection control bits in the
OSCCON register (OSCCON<14:12>) are set to ‘001’.
The
four-bit
field
specified
by
TUN<3:0>
(OSCTUN<3:0>) allows the user to tune the internal
fast RC oscillator (nominal 7.37 MHz). The user can
tune the FRC oscillator within a range of +10.5% (840
kHz) and -12% (960 kHz) in steps of 1.50% around the
factory-calibrated setting, see Table 20-4.
If OSCCON<14:12> are set to ‘111’ and FPR<4:0> are
set to ‘00101’, ‘00110’ or ‘00111’, then a PLL
multiplier of 4, 8 or 16 (respectively) is applied.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
TABLE 20-4:
TUN<3:0>
Bits
0111
0110
0101
0100
0011
0010
0001
0000
1111
1110
1101
1100
1011
1010
1001
1000
20.2.6
FRC TUNING
FRC Frequency
+ 10.5%
+ 9.0%
+ 7.5%
+ 6.0%
+ 4.5%
+ 3.0%
+ 1.5%
Center Frequency (oscillator is
running at calibrated frequency)
- 1.5%
- 3.0%
- 4.5%
- 6.0%
- 7.5%
- 9.0%
- 10.5%
- 12.0%
LOW-POWER RC OSCILLATOR
(LPRC)
The LPRC oscillator is a component of the Watchdog
Timer (WDT) and oscillates at a nominal frequency of
512 kHz. The LPRC oscillator is the clock source for
the Power-up Timer (PWRT) circuit, WDT and clock
monitor circuits. It may also be used to provide a lowfrequency clock source option for applications where
power consumption is critical and timing accuracy is
not required.
The LPRC oscillator is always enabled at a Power-on
Reset because it is the clock source for the PWRT.
After the PWRT expires, the LPRC oscillator remains
on if one of the following is TRUE:
• The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled
• The WDT is enabled
• The LPRC oscillator is selected as the system
clock via the COSC<2:0> control bits in the
OSCCON register
If one of the above conditions is not true, the LPRC
shuts off after the PWRT expires.
Note 1: OSC2 pin function is determined by the
Primary Oscillator mode selection
(FPR<4:0>).
2: OSC1 pin cannot be used as an I/O pin
even if the secondary oscillator or an
internal clock source is selected at all
times.
DS70138E-page 139
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.2.7
FAIL-SAFE CLOCK MONITOR
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the device
to continue to operate even in the event of an oscillator
failure. The FSCM function is enabled by appropriately
programming the FCKSM Configuration bits (clock
switch and monitor selection bits) in the FOSC Device
Configuration register. If the FSCM function is enabled,
the LPRC internal oscillator runs at all times (except
during Sleep mode) and is not subject to control by the
SWDTEN bit.
In the event of an oscillator failure, the FSCM
generates a clock failure trap event and switches the
system clock over to the FRC oscillator. The user then
has the option to either attempt to restart the oscillator
or execute a controlled shutdown. The user may decide
to treat the trap as a warm Reset by simply loading the
Reset address into the oscillator fail trap vector. In this
event, the CF (Clock Fail) Status bit (OSCCON<3>) is
also set whenever a clock failure is recognized.
In the event of a clock failure, the WDT is unaffected
and continues to run on the LPRC clock.
If the oscillator has a very slow start-up time coming out
of POR, BOR or Sleep, it is possible that the PWRT
timer will expire before the oscillator has started. In
such cases, the FSCM is activated and the FSCM initiates a clock failure trap, and the COSC<2:0> bits are
loaded with FRC oscillator selection. This effectively
shuts off the original oscillator that was trying to start.
The OSCCON register holds the control and Status bits
related to clock switching.
• COSC<2:0>: Read-only Status bits always reflect
the current oscillator group in effect.
• NOSC<2:0>: Control bits which are written to
indicate the new oscillator group of choice.
- On POR and BOR, COSC<2:0> and
NOSC<2:0> are both loaded with the Configuration bit values FOS<2:0>.
• LOCK: The LOCK Status bit indicates a PLL lock.
• CF: Read-only Status bit indicating if a clock fail
detect has occurred.
• OSWEN: Control bit changes from a ‘0’ to a ‘1’
when a clock transition sequence is initiated.
Clearing the OSWEN control bit aborts a clock
transition in progress (used for hang-up
situations).
If Configuration bits FCKSM<1:0> = 1x, then the clock
switching and Fail-Safe Clock monitoring functions are
disabled. This is the default Configuration bit setting.
If clock switching is disabled, then the FOS<2:0> and
FPR<4:0> bits directly control the oscillator selection
and the COSC<2:0> bits do not control the clock
selection. However, these bits reflect the clock source
selection.
Note:
The user may detect this situation and restart the
oscillator in the clock fail trap ISR.
Upon a clock failure detection, the FSCM module
initiates a clock switch to the FRC oscillator as follows:
1.
2.
3.
The COSC bits (OSCCON<14:12>) are loaded
with the FRC oscillator selection value.
CF bit is set (OSCCON<3>).
OSWEN control bit (OSCCON<0>) is cleared.
For the purpose of clock switching, the clock sources
are sectioned into four groups:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Primary
Secondary
Internal FRC
Internal LPRC
The user can switch between these functional groups
but cannot switch between options within a group. If the
primary group is selected, then the choice within the
group is always determined by the FPR<4:0> Configuration bits.
20.2.8
The application should not attempt to
switch to a clock of frequency lower than
100 KHz when the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
is enabled. If such clock switching is
performed, the device may generate an
oscillator fail trap and switch to the Fast RC
oscillator.
PROTECTION AGAINST
ACCIDENTAL WRITES TO OSCCON
A write to the OSCCON register is intentionally made
difficult because it controls clock switching and clock
scaling.
To write to the OSCCON low byte, the following code
sequence must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
Byte Write “0x46” to OSCCON low
Byte Write “0x57” to OSCCON low
Byte write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
To write to the OSCCON high byte, the following
instructions must be executed without any other
instructions in between:
Byte Write “0x78” to OSCCON high
Byte Write “0x9A” to OSCCON high
Byte write is allowed for one instruction cycle. Write the
desired value or use bit manipulation instruction.
DS70138E-page 140
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.3
Oscillator Control Registers
Note:
The oscillators are controlled with two SFRs,
OSCCON and OSCTUN and one Configuration
register, FOSC.
REGISTER 20-1:
The description of the OSCCON and
OSCTUN SFRs, as well as the FOSC Configuration register provided in this section
are applicable only to the dsPIC30F3014
and dsPIC30F4013 devices in the
dsPIC30F product family.
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
R-y
—
R-y
R-y
U-0
COSC<2:0>
R/W-y
—
R/W-y
R/W-y
NOSC<2:0>
bit 15
bit 8
R/W-0
R/W-0
POST<1:0>
R-0
U-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LOCK
—
CF
—
LPOSCEN
OSWEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 15
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 14-12
COSC<2:0>: Current Oscillator Group Selection bits (Read-Only)
111 = PLL Oscillator; PLL source selected by FPR<4:0> bits
011 = External Oscillator; OSC1/OSC2 pins; External Oscillator configuration selected by FPR<4:0>
bits
010 = LPRC internal low-power RC
001 = FRC internal fast RC
000 = LP crystal oscillator; SOSCI/SOSCO pins
Set to FOS<2:0> values on POR or BOR
Loaded with NOSC<2:0> at the completion of a successful clock switch
Set to FRC value when FSCM detects a failure and switches clock to FRC
bit 11
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 10-8
NOSC<2:0>: New Oscillator Group Selection bits
111 = PLL Oscillator; PLL source selected by FPR<4:0> bits
011 = External Oscillator; OSC1/OSC2 pins; External Oscillator configuration selected by FPR<4:0>
bits
010 = LPRC internal low-power RC
001 = FRC internal fast RC
000 = LP crystal oscillator; SOSCI/SOSCO pins
Set to FOS<2:0> values on POR or BOR
bit 7-6
POST<1:0>: Oscillator Postscaler Selection bits
11 = Oscillator postscaler divides clock by 64
10 = Oscillator postscaler divides clock by 16
01 = Oscillator postscaler divides clock by 4
00 = Oscillator postscaler does not alter clock
bit 5
LOCK: PLL Lock Status bit (Read-Only)
1 = Indicates that PLL is in lock
0 = Indicates that PLL is out of lock (or disabled)
Reset on POR or BOR
Reset when a valid clock switching sequence is initiated
Set when PLL lock is achieved after a PLL start
Reset when lock is lost
Read zero when PLL is not selected as a system clock
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 141
dsPIC30F3014/4013
REGISTER 20-1:
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED)
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
CF: Clock Fail Detect bit (Read/Clearable by application)
1 = FSCM has detected clock failure
0 = FSCM has NOT detected clock failure
Reset on POR or BOR
Reset when a valid clock switching sequence is initiated
Set when clock fail detected
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1
LPOSCEN: 32 KHz Secondary (LP) Oscillator Enable bit
1 = Secondary oscillator is enabled
0 = Secondary oscillator is disabled
Reset on POR or BOR
bit 0
OSWEN: Oscillator Switch Enable bit
1 = Request oscillator switch to selection specified by NOSC<2:0> bits
0 = Oscillator switch is complete
Reset on POR or BOR
Reset after a successful clock switch
Reset after a redundant clock switch
Reset after FSCM switches the oscillator to (Group 1) FRC
DS70138E-page 142
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
REGISTER 20-2:
OSCTUN: FRC OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
bit 15
bit 8
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
—
—
—
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
TUN<3:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 15-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
TUN<3:0>: Lower two bits of TUN field. The four-bit field specified by TUN<3:0> specifies the user
tuning capability for the internal fast RC oscillator (nominal 7.37 MHz).
0111 = Maximum Frequency
0110 =
0101 =
0100 =
0011 =
0010 =
0001 =
0000 = Center Frequency, Oscillator is running at calibrated frequency
1111 =
1110 =
1101 =
1100 =
1011 =
1010 =
1001 =
1000 = Minimum Frequency
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 143
dsPIC30F3014/4013
REGISTER 20-3:
FOSC: OSCILLATOR CONFIGURATION REGISTER
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
bit 23
bit 16
R/P
R/P
FCKSM<1:0>
U
U
U
—
—
—
R/P
R/P
R/P
FOS<2:0>
bit 15
bit 8
U
U
U
—
—
—
R/P
R/P
R/P
R/P
R/P
FPR<4:0>
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
bit 23-16
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 15-14
FCKSM<1:0>: Clock Switching and Monitor Selection Configuration bits
1x = Clock switching is disabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled
01 = Clock switching is enabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled
00 = Clock switching is enabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled
bit 13-11
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 10-8
FOS<2:0>: Oscillator Group Selection on POR bits
111 = PLL Oscillator; PLL source selected by FPR<4:0> bits. See Table 20-2.
011 = EXT: External Oscillator; OSC1/OSC2 pins; External Oscillator configuration selected by
FPR<4:0> bits
010 = LPRC: Internal Low-Power RC
001 = FRC: Internal Fast RC
000 = LPOSC: Low-Power Crystal Oscillator; SOSCI/SOSCO pins
bit 7-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
FPR<4:0>: Oscillator Selection within Primary Group bits. See Table 20-2.
DS70138E-page 144
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.4
Reset
The PIC18F1220/1320 differentiates between various
kinds of Reset:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
Power-on Reset (POR)
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during Sleep
Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset (during normal
operation)
Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
RESET Instruction
Reset caused by trap lockup (TRAPR)
Reset caused by illegal opcode or by using an
uninitialized W register as an Address Pointer
(IOPUWR)
FIGURE 20-2:
Different registers are affected in different ways by various Reset conditions. Most registers are not affected
by a WDT wake-up since this is viewed as the resumption of normal operation. Status bits from the RCON
register are set or cleared differently in different Reset
situations, as indicated in Table 20-5. These bits are
used in software to determine the nature of the Reset.
A block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit is shown
in Figure 20-2.
A MCLR noise filter is provided in the MCLR Reset
path. The filter detects and ignores small pulses.
Internally generated Resets do not drive MCLR pin low.
RESET SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM
RESET
Instruction
Digital
Glitch Filter
MCLR
Sleep or Idle
WDT
Module
POR
VDD Rise
Detect
S
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
BOR
BOREN
R
Q
SYSRST
Trap Conflict
Illegal Opcode/
Uninitialized W Register
20.4.1
POR: POWER-ON RESET
A power-on event generates an internal POR pulse
when a VDD rise is detected. The Reset pulse occurs at
the POR circuit threshold voltage (VPOR) which is nominally 1.85V. The device supply voltage characteristics
must meet specified starting voltage and rise rate
requirements. The POR pulse resets a POR timer and
places the device in the Reset state. The POR also
selects the device clock source identified by the
oscillator configuration fuses.
The POR circuit inserts a small delay, TPOR, which is
nominally 10 μs and ensures that the device bias
circuits are stable. Furthermore, a user selected powerup time-out (TPWRT) is applied. The TPWRT parameter
is based on device Configuration bits and can be 0 ms
(no delay), 4 ms, 16 ms, or 64 ms. The total delay is at
device power-up, TPOR + TPWRT. When these delays
have expired, SYSRST is negated on the next leading
edge of the Q1 clock and the PC jumps to the Reset
vector.
The timing for the SYSRST signal is shown in
Figure 20-3 through Figure 20-5.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 145
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 20-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
FIGURE 20-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
FIGURE 20-5:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
INTERNAL Reset
DS70138E-page 146
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.4.1.1
POR with Long Crystal Start-up Time
(with FSCM Enabled)
Timer (OST). The system clock is held until OST
expires. If the PLL is used, then the clock is held until
the LOCK bit (OSCCON<5>) is ‘1’.
The oscillator start-up circuitry is not linked to the POR
circuitry. Some crystal circuits (especially low
frequency crystals) have a relatively long start-up time.
Therefore, one or more of the following conditions is
possible after the POR timer and the PWRT have
expired:
Concurrently, the POR time-out (TPOR) and the PWRT
time-out (TPWRT) are applied before the internal Reset is
released. If TPWRT = 0 and a crystal oscillator is being
used, then a nominal delay of TFSCM = 100 μs is applied.
The total delay in this case is (TPOR + TFSCM).
• The oscillator circuit has not begun to oscillate.
• The Oscillator Start-up Timer has not expired (if a
crystal oscillator is used).
• The PLL has not achieved a LOCK (if PLL is
used).
The BOR Status bit (RCON<1>) is set to indicate that a
BOR has occurred. The BOR circuit, if enabled, continues to operate while in Sleep or Idle modes and resets
the device should VDD fall below the BOR threshold
voltage.
If the FSCM is enabled and one of the above conditions
is true, a clock failure trap occurs. The device automatically switches to the FRC oscillator and the user can
switch to the desired crystal oscillator in the trap ISR.
FIGURE 20-6:
20.4.1.2
VDD
Operating without FSCM and PWRT
D
If the FSCM is disabled and the Power-up Timer
(PWRT) is also disabled, then the device exits rapidly
from Reset on power-up. If the clock source is FRC,
LPRC, ERC or EC, it will be active immediately.
If the FSCM is disabled and the system clock has not
started, the device will be in a frozen state at the Reset
vector until the system clock starts. From the user’s
perspective, the device appears to be in Reset until a
system clock is available.
20.4.2
BOR: PROGRAMMABLE
BROWN-OUT RESET
The BOR (Brown-out Reset) module is based on an
internal voltage reference circuit. The main purpose of
the BOR module is to generate a device Reset when a
brown-out condition occurs. Brown-out conditions are
generally caused by glitches on the AC mains (i.e.,
missing portions of the AC cycle waveform due to bad
power transmission lines, or voltage sags due to excessive current draw when a large inductive load is turned
on).
The BOR module allows selection of one of the
following voltage trip points (see Table 23-11):
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
R
R1
C
Note 1:
2:
3:
Note:
MCLR
dsPIC30F
External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
R should be suitably chosen so as to make
sure that the voltage drop across R does not
violate the device’s electrical specifications.
R1 should be suitably chosen so as to limit
any current flowing into MCLR from external
capacitor C, in the event of MCLR/VPP pin
breakdown due to Electrostatic Discharge
(ESD), or Electrical Overstress (EOS).
Dedicated supervisory devices, such as
the MCP1XX and MCP8XX, may also be
used as an external Power-on Reset
circuit.
• 2.6V-2.71V
• 4.1V-4.4V
• 4.58V-4.73V
Note:
The BOR voltage trip points indicated here
are nominal values provided for design
guidance only. Refer to the Electrical
Specifications in the specific device data
sheet for BOR voltage limit specifications.
A BOR generates a Reset pulse, which resets the
device. The BOR selects the clock source based on the
device Configuration bit values (FOS<2:0> and
FPR<4:0>). Furthermore, if an Oscillator mode is
selected, the BOR activates the Oscillator Start-up
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 147
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Table 20-5 shows the Reset conditions for the RCON
register. Since the control bits within the RCON register
are R/W, the information in the table means that all the
bits are negated prior to the action specified in the
condition column.
TABLE 20-5:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER: CASE 1
Condition
Program
Counter
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
Power-on Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Brown-out Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0x000000
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
MCLR Reset during Sleep
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
MCLR Reset during Idle
WDT Time-out Reset
0x000000
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
0x000000
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
PC + 2
WDT Wake-up
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep
PC +
2(1)
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Clock Failure Trap
0x000004
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Trap Reset
0x000000
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Illegal Operation Trap
0x000000
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
Table 20-6 shows a second example of the bit
conditions for the RCON register. In this case, it is not
assumed the user has set/cleared specific bits prior to
action specified in the condition column.
TABLE 20-6:
INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR RCON REGISTER: CASE 2
Condition
Program
Counter
TRAPR IOPUWR EXTR SWR WDTO IDLE SLEEP POR BOR
Power-on Reset
0x000000
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Brown-out Reset
0x000000
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
0
1
MCLR Reset during normal
operation
Software Reset during
normal operation
0x000000
u
u
1
0
0
0
0
u
u
0x000000
u
u
0
1
0
0
0
u
u
MCLR Reset during Sleep
0x000000
u
u
1
u
0
0
1
u
u
MCLR Reset during Idle
WDT Time-out Reset
0x000000
u
u
1
u
0
1
0
u
u
0x000000
u
u
0
0
1
0
0
u
u
PC + 2
WDT Wake-up
u
u
u
u
1
u
1
u
u
Interrupt Wake-up from Sleep
(1)
PC + 2
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
u
Clock Failure Trap
0x000004
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Trap Reset
0x000000
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Illegal Operation Reset
0x000000
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, – = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an enabled interrupt, the PC is loaded with the corresponding interrupt vector.
DS70138E-page 148
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.5
20.5.1
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
WATCHDOG TIMER OPERATION
The primary function of the Watchdog Timer (WDT) is
to reset the processor in the event of a software malfunction. The WDT is a free-running timer that runs off
an on-chip RC oscillator, requiring no external component. Therefore, the WDT timer continues to operate
even if the main processor clock (e.g., the crystal
oscillator) fails.
20.5.2
ENABLING AND DISABLING
THE WDT
The Watchdog Timer can be “Enabled” or “Disabled”
only through a Configuration bit (FWDTEN) in the
Configuration register, FWDT.
Setting FWDTEN = 1 enables the Watchdog Timer. The
enabling is done when programming the device. By
default, after chip erase, FWDTEN bit = 1. Any device
programmer capable of programming dsPIC30F
devices allows programming of this and other
Configuration bits.
If enabled, the WDT increments until it overflows or
“times out”. A WDT time-out forces a device Reset
(except during Sleep). To prevent a WDT time-out, the
user must clear the Watchdog Timer using a CLRWDT
instruction.
If a WDT times out during Sleep, the device wakes up.
The WDTO bit in the RCON register is cleared to indicate a wake-up resulting from a WDT time-out.
Setting FWDTEN = 0 allows user software to enable/
disable the Watchdog Timer via the SWDTEN
(RCON<5>) control bit.
20.7
There are two power-saving states that can be entered
through the execution of a special instruction, PWRSAV;
these are Sleep and Idle.
The format of the PWRSAV instruction is as follows:
PWRSAV <parameter>, where ‘parameter’ defines
Idle or Sleep mode.
20.7.1
Low-Voltage Detect
The Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) module is used to
detect when the VDD of the device drops below a
threshold value, VLVD, which is determined by the
LVDL<3:0> bits (RCON<11:8>) and is thus user programmable. The internal voltage reference circuitry
requires a nominal amount of time to stabilize, and the
BGST bit (RCON<13>) indicates when the voltage reference has stabilized.
In some devices, the LVD threshold voltage may be
applied externally on the LVDIN pin.
The LVD module is enabled by setting the LVDEN bit
(RCON<12>).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
SLEEP MODE
In Sleep mode, the clock to the CPU and peripherals is
shut down. If an on-chip oscillator is being used, it is
shut down.
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is not functional during
Sleep since there is no clock to monitor. However,
LPRC clock remains active if WDT is operational during
Sleep.
The brown-out protection circuit and the Low-Voltage
Detect circuit, if enabled, remains functional during
Sleep.
The processor wakes up from Sleep if at least one of
the following conditions has occurred:
• any interrupt that is individually enabled and
meets the required priority level
• any Reset (POR, BOR and MCLR)
• WDT time-out
On waking up from Sleep mode, the processor restarts
the same clock that was active prior to entry into Sleep
mode. When clock switching is enabled, bits
COSC<2:0> determine the oscillator source to be used
on wake-up. If clock switch is disabled, then there is
only one system clock.
Note:
20.6
Power-Saving Modes
If a POR or BOR occurred, the selection of
the oscillator is based on the FOS<2:0>
and FPR<4:0> Configuration bits.
If the clock source is an oscillator, the clock to the
device is held off until OST times out (indicating a stable oscillator). If PLL is used, the system clock is held
off until LOCK = 1 (indicating that the PLL is stable). In
either case, TPOR, TLOCK and TPWRT delays are
applied.
If EC, FRC, LPRC or ERC oscillators are used, then a
delay of TPOR (~ 10 μs) is applied. This is the smallest
delay possible on wake-up from Sleep.
Moreover, if LP oscillator was active during Sleep and
LP is the oscillator used on wake-up, then the start-up
delay is equal to TPOR. PWRT delay and OST timer
delay are not applied. In order to have the smallest
possible start-up delay when waking up from Sleep,
one of these faster wake-up options should be selected
before entering Sleep.
DS70138E-page 149
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using the corresponding IE bit) and meets the prevailing priority level
can wake-up the processor. The processor processes
the interrupt and branch to the ISR. The Sleep Status bit
in the RCON register is set upon wake-up.
Note:
In spite of various delays applied (TPOR,
TLOCK and TPWRT), the crystal oscillator
(and PLL) may not be active at the end of
the time-out (e.g., for low frequency crystals). In such cases, if FSCM is enabled, the
device detects this as a clock failure and
processes the clock failure trap, the FRC
oscillator is enabled and the user will have
to re-enable the crystal oscillator. If FSCM is
not enabled, the device simply suspends
execution of code until the clock is stable
and remain in Sleep until the oscillator clock
has started.
All Resets wake up the processor from Sleep mode.
Any Reset, other than POR, sets the Sleep Status bit.
In a POR, the Sleep bit is cleared.
If the Watchdog Timer is enabled, the processor wakes
up from Sleep mode upon WDT time-out. The Sleep
and WDTO Status bits are both set.
20.7.2
IDLE MODE
In Idle mode, the clock to the CPU is shut down while
peripherals keep running. Unlike Sleep mode, the clock
source remains active.
Any interrupt that is individually enabled (using IE bit)
and meets the prevailing priority level is able to wake
up the processor. The processor processes the interrupt and branches to the ISR. The Idle Status bit in the
RCON register is set upon wake-up.
Any Reset other than POR sets the Idle Status bit. On
a POR, the Idle bit is cleared.
If Watchdog Timer is enabled, the processor wakes up
from Idle mode upon WDT time-out. The Idle and
WDTO Status bits are both set.
Unlike wake-up from Sleep, there are no time delays
involved in wake-up from Idle.
20.8
Device Configuration Registers
The Configuration bits in each device Configuration
register specify some of the device modes and are
programmed by a device programmer, or by using the
In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) feature of
the device. Each device Configuration register is a
24-bit register, but only the lower 16 bits of each register are used to hold configuration data. There are four
device Configuration registers available to the user:
1.
2.
3.
FOSC (0xF80000): Oscillator Configuration
Register
FWDT (0xF80002): Watchdog Timer
Configuration Register
FBORPOR (0xF80004): BOR and POR
Configuration Register
FGS (0xF8000A): General Code Segment
Configuration Register
Several peripherals have a control bit in each module
that allows them to operate during Idle.
4.
LPRC Fail-Safe Clock remains active if clock failure
detect is enabled.
The placement of the Configuration bits is automatically handled when you select the device in your device
programmer. The desired state of the Configuration bits
may be specified in the source code (dependent on the
language tool used), or through the programming
interface. After the device has been programmed, the
application software may read the Configuration bit
values through the table read instructions. For
additional information, please refer to the Programming
Specifications of the device.
The processor wakes up from Idle if at least one of the
following conditions has occurred:
• any interrupt that is individually enabled (IE bit is
‘1’) and meets the required priority level
• any Reset (POR, BOR, MCLR)
• WDT time-out
Upon wake-up from Idle mode, the clock is re-applied
to the CPU and instruction execution begins immediately, starting with the instruction following the PWRSAV
instruction.
DS70138E-page 150
Note:
If the code protection configuration fuse
bits (FGS<GCP> and FGS<GWRP>)
have been programmed, an erase of the
entire code-protected device is only
possible at voltages VDD ≥ 4.5V.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
20.9
Peripheral Module Disable (PMD)
Registers
The Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) registers
provide a method to disable a peripheral module by
stopping all clock sources supplied to that module.
When a peripheral is disabled via the appropriate PMD
control bit, the peripheral is in a minimum power consumption state. The control and STATUS registers
associated with the peripheral are also disabled so
writes to those registers have no effect and read values
are invalid.
A peripheral module is only enabled if both the associated bit in the PMD register is cleared and the peripheral is supported by the specific dsPIC DSC variant. If
the peripheral is present in the device, it is enabled in
the PMD register by default.
Note:
If a PMD bit is set, the corresponding module is disabled after a delay of 1 instruction
cycle. Similarly, if a PMD bit is cleared, the
corresponding module is enabled after a
delay of 1 instruction cycle (assuming the
module control registers are already
configured to enable module operation).
20.10 In-Circuit Debugger
When MPLAB® ICD 2 is selected as a Debugger, the
In-Circuit Debugging functionality is enabled. This
function allows simple debugging functions when used
with MPLAB IDE. When the device has this feature
enabled, some of the resources are not available for
general use. These resources include the first 80 bytes
of Data RAM and two I/O pins.
One of four pairs of Debug I/O pins may be selected by
the user using configuration options in MPLAB IDE.
These pin pairs are named EMUD/EMUC, EMUD1/
EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 and MUD3/EMUC3.
In each case, the selected EMUD pin is the Emulation/
Debug Data line, and the EMUC pin is the Emulation/
Debug Clock line. These pins interface to the MPLAB
ICD 2 module available from Microchip. The selected
pair of Debug I/O pins is used by MPLAB ICD 2 to send
commands and receive responses, as well as to send
and receive data. To use the In-Circuit Debugger
function of the device, the design must implement ICSP
connections to MCLR, VDD, VSS, PGC, PGD and the
selected EMUDx/EMUCx pin pair.
This gives rise to two possibilities:
1.
Note:
In the dsPIC30F3014 device, the T4MD,
T5MD, IC7MD, IC8MD, OC3MD, OC4MD
and DCIMD are readable and writable,
and are read as “1” when set.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
2.
If EMUD/EMUC is selected as the Debug I/O pin
pair, then only a 5-pin interface is required, as
the EMUD and EMUC pin functions are multiplexed with the PGD and PGC pin functions in
all dsPIC30F devices.
If EMUD1/EMUC1, EMUD2/EMUC2 or EMUD3/
EMUC3 is selected as the Debug I/O pin pair,
then a 7-pin interface is required, as the
EMUDx/EMUCx pin functions (x = 1, 2 or 3) are
not multiplexed with the PGD and PGC pin
functions.
DS70138E-page 151
SFR
Name
Addr.
SYSTEM INTEGRATION REGISTER MAP
Bit 15
Bit 13
Bit 12
TRAPR IOPUWR BGST
LVDEN
RCON
0740
OSCCON
0742
—
OSCTUN
0744
—
PMD1
0770
PMD2
0772
Note
Bit 14
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
LVDL<3:0>
COSC<2:0>
—
NOSC<2:0>
—
—
—
—
—
—
T5MD
T4MD
T3MD
T2MD
T1MD
—
—
IC8MD
IC7MD
—
—
—
—
IC2MD
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
EXTR
SWR
SWDTEN
WDTO
SLEEP
IDLE
LOCK
—
CF
—
—
TUN3
TUN2
—
POST<1:0>
—
—
—
—
DCIMD
I2CMD
U2MD
U1MD
—
SPI1MD
IC1MD
—
—
—
—
OC4MD OC3MD
Reset state depends on type of Reset.
Reset state depends on Configuration bits.
3:
For the dsPIC30F3014 device, the DCIMD, T4MD, T5MD, OC3MD, OC4,MD, IC7MD and IC8MD bits do not perform any function.
4:
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
File Name
FOSC
Bit 0
Reset State
BOR
POR
(Note 1)
LPOSCEN OSWEN
1:
2:
TABLE 20-8:
Bit 1
TUN1
TUN0
(Note 2)
0000 0000 0000 0000
C1MD
ADCMD 0000 0000 0000 0000
OC2MD
OC1MD 0000 0000 0000 0000
DEVICE CONFIGURATION REGISTER MAP
Addr.
Bits 23-16
F80000
—
Bit 15
Bit 14
FCKSM<1:0>
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
—
—
—
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
FOS<2:0>
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
—
—
—
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
FWDT
F80002
—
FWDTEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
FWPSA<1:0>
FBORPOR
F80004
—
MCLREN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BOREN
—
BORV<1:0>
—
—
FGS
F8000A
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1:
Refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046) for descriptions of register bit fields.
Bit 1
Bit 0
FPR<4:0>
—
FWPSB<3:0>
FPWRT<1:0>
GCP
GWRP
dsPIC30F3014/4013
DS70138E-page 152
TABLE 20-7:
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
21.0
INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
Note: This data sheet summarizes features of this group
of dsPIC30F devices and is not intended to be a complete
reference source. For more information on the CPU,
peripherals, register descriptions and general device
functionality, refer to the “dsPIC30F Family Reference
Manual” (DS70046). For more information on the device
instruction set and programming, refer to the “dsPIC30F/
33F Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70157).
The dsPIC30F instruction set adds many
enhancements to the previous PIC® MCU instruction
sets, while maintaining an easy migration from
PIC
MCU instruction sets.
Most instructions are a single program memory word
(24 bits). Only three instructions require two program
memory locations.
Each single-word instruction is a 24-bit word divided
into an 8-bit opcode which specifies the instruction
type, and one or more operands which further specify
the operation of the instruction.
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into five basic categories:
•
•
•
•
•
Word or byte-oriented operations
Bit-oriented operations
Literal operations
DSP operations
Control operations
Table 21-1 shows the general symbols used in
describing the instructions.
The dsPIC30F instruction set summary in Table 21-2
lists all the instructions, along with the status flags
affected by each instruction.
Most word or byte-oriented W register instructions
(including barrel shift instructions) have three
operands:
• The first source operand which is typically a
register ‘Wb’ without any address modifier
• The second source operand which is typically a
register ‘Ws’ with or without an address modifier
• The destination of the result which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
However, word or byte-oriented file register instructions
have two operands:
• The file register specified by the value ‘f’
• The destination, which could either be the file
register ‘f’ or the W0 register, which is denoted as
‘WREG’
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Most bit-oriented instructions (including simple rotate/
shift instructions) have two operands:
• The W register (with or without an address
modifier) or file register (specified by the value of
‘Ws’ or ‘f’)
• The bit in the W register or file register
(specified by a literal value or indirectly by the
contents of register ‘Wb’)
The literal instructions that involve data movement may
use some of the following operands:
• A literal value to be loaded into a W register or file
register (specified by the value of ‘k’)
• The W register or file register where the literal
value is to be loaded (specified by ‘Wb’ or ‘f’)
However, literal instructions that involve arithmetic or
logical operations use some of the following operands:
• The first source operand which is a register ‘Wb’
without any address modifier
• The second source operand which is a literal
value
• The destination of the result (only if not the same
as the first source operand) which is typically a
register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier
The MAC class of DSP instructions may use some of the
following operands:
• The accumulator (A or B) to be used (required
operand)
• The W registers to be used as the two operands
• The X and Y address space prefetch operations
• The X and Y address space prefetch destinations
• The accumulator write-back destination
The other DSP instructions do not involve any
multiplication, and may include:
• The accumulator to be used (required)
• The source or destination operand (designated as
Wso or Wdo, respectively) with or without an
address modifier
• The amount of shift specified by a W register ‘Wn’
or a literal value
The control instructions may use some of the following
operands:
• A program memory address
• The mode of the table read and table write
instructions
All instructions are a single word, except for certain
double word instructions, which were made double
word instructions so that all the required information is
available in these 48 bits. In the second word, the
8 MSbs are ‘0’s. If this second word is executed as an
instruction (by itself), it executes as a NOP.
DS70138E-page 153
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Most single-word instructions are executed in a single
instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or
the program counter is changed as a result of the
instruction. In these cases, the execution takes two
instruction cycles with the additional instruction
cycle(s) executed as a NOP. Notable exceptions are the
BRA (unconditional/computed branch), indirect CALL/
GOTO, all table reads and writes, and RETURN/RETFIE
instructions, which are single-word instructions but take
two or three cycles. Certain instructions that involve
skipping over the subsequent instruction require either
TABLE 21-1:
two or three cycles if the skip is performed, depending
on whether the instruction being skipped is a singleword or two-word instruction. Moreover, double word
moves require two cycles. The double word
instructions execute in two instruction cycles.
Note:
For more details on the instruction set,
refer to the Programmer’s Reference
Manual.
SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS
Field
Description
#text
Means literal defined by “text”
(text)
Means “content of text”
[text]
Means “the location addressed by text”
{ }
Optional field or operation
<n:m>
Register bit field
.b
Byte mode selection
.d
Double Word mode selection
.S
Shadow register select
.w
Word mode selection (default)
Acc
One of two accumulators {A, B}
AWB
Accumulator write-back destination address register ∈ {W13, [W13]+=2}
bit4
4-bit bit selection field (used in word addressed instructions) ∈ {0...15}
C, DC, N, OV, Z
MCU Status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Negative, Overflow, Sticky Zero
Expr
Absolute address, label or expression (resolved by the linker)
f
File register address ∈ {0x0000...0x1FFF}
lit1
1-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0,1}
lit4
4-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...15}
lit5
5-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...31}
lit8
8-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255}
lit10
10-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...255} for Byte mode, {0:1023} for Word mode
lit14
14-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...16384}
lit16
16-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...65535}
lit23
23-bit unsigned literal ∈ {0...8388608}; LSB must be 0
None
Field does not require an entry, may be blank
OA, OB, SA, SB
DSP Status bits: AccA Overflow, AccB Overflow, AccA Saturate, AccB Saturate
PC
Program Counter
Slit10
10-bit signed literal ∈ {-512...511}
Slit16
16-bit signed literal ∈ {-32768...32767}
Slit6
6-bit signed literal ∈ {-16...16}
DS70138E-page 154
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-1:
SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Field
Description
Wb
Base W register ∈ {W0..W15}
Wd
Destination W register ∈ { Wd, [Wd], [Wd++], [Wd--], [++Wd], [--Wd] }
Wdo
Destination W register ∈
{ Wnd, [Wnd], [Wnd++], [Wnd--], [++Wnd], [--Wnd], [Wnd+Wb] }
Wm,Wn
Dividend, Divisor working register pair (direct addressing)
Wm*Wm
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for Square instructions ∈
{W4*W4,W5*W5,W6*W6,W7*W7}
Wm*Wn
Multiplicand and Multiplier working register pair for DSP instructions ∈
{W4*W5,W4*W6,W4*W7,W5*W6,W5*W7,W6*W7}
Wn
One of 16 working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
Wnd
One of 16 destination working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
Wns
One of 16 source working registers ∈ {W0..W15}
WREG
W0 (working register used in file register instructions)
Ws
Source W register ∈ { Ws, [Ws], [Ws++], [Ws--], [++Ws], [--Ws] }
Wso
Source W register ∈
{ Wns, [Wns], [Wns++], [Wns--], [++Wns], [--Wns], [Wns+Wb] }
Wx
X data space prefetch address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W8]+=6, [W8]+=4, [W8]+=2, [W8], [W8]-=6, [W8]-=4, [W8]-=2,
[W9]+=6, [W9]+=4, [W9]+=2, [W9], [W9]-=6, [W9]-=4, [W9]-=2,
[W9+W12],none}
Wxd
X data space prefetch destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
Wy
Y data space prefetch address register for DSP instructions
∈ {[W10]+=6, [W10]+=4, [W10]+=2, [W10], [W10]-=6, [W10]-=4, [W10]-=2,
[W11]+=6, [W11]+=4, [W11]+=2, [W11], [W11]-=6, [W11]-=4, [W11]-=2,
[W11+W12], none}
Wyd
Y data space prefetch destination register for DSP instructions ∈ {W4..W7}
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 155
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-2:
Base
Instr
#
1
2
3
4
5
6
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW
Assembly
Mnemoni
c
ADD
ADDC
AND
ASR
BCLR
BRA
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
# of
Words Cycles
Status Flags
Affected
ADD
Acc
Add Accumulators
1
1
ADD
f
f = f + WREG
1
1
OA,OB,SA,SB
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADD
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADD
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 + Wd
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADD
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb + Ws
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADD
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb + lit5
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
OA,OB,SA,SB
ADD
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
16-bit Signed Add to Accumulator
1
1
ADDC
f
f = f + WREG + (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADDC
f,WREG
WREG = f + WREG + (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADDC
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 + Wd + (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADDC
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb + Ws + (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
ADDC
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb + lit5 + (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
AND
f
f = f .AND. WREG
1
1
N,Z
AND
f,WREG
WREG = f .AND. WREG
1
1
N,Z
AND
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .AND. Wd
1
1
N,Z
AND
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .AND. Ws
1
1
N,Z
AND
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .AND. lit5
1
1
N,Z
ASR
f
f = Arithmetic Right Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
ASR
f,WREG
WREG = Arithmetic Right Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
ASR
Ws,Wd
Wd = Arithmetic Right Shift Ws
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
ASR
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N,Z
ASR
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N,Z
BCLR
f,#bit4
Bit Clear f
1
1
None
BCLR
Ws,#bit4
Bit Clear Ws
1
1
None
BRA
C,Expr
Branch if Carry
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GE,Expr
Branch if greater than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GEU,Expr
Branch if unsigned greater than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GT,Expr
Branch if greater than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
GTU,Expr
Branch if unsigned greater than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LE,Expr
Branch if less than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LEU,Expr
Branch if unsigned less than or equal
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LT,Expr
Branch if less than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
LTU,Expr
Branch if unsigned less than
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
N,Expr
Branch if Negative
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NC,Expr
Branch if Not Carry
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NN,Expr
Branch if Not Negative
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NOV,Expr
Branch if Not Overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
NZ,Expr
Branch if Not Zero
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OA,Expr
Branch if Accumulator A overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OB,Expr
Branch if Accumulator B overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
OV,Expr
Branch if Overflow
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
SA,Expr
Branch if Accumulator A saturated
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
SB,Expr
Branch if Accumulator B saturated
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
Expr
Branch Unconditionally
1
2
None
BRA
Z,Expr
Branch if Zero
1
1 (2)
None
BRA
Wn
Computed Branch
1
2
None
7
BSET
BSET
f,#bit4
Bit Set f
1
1
None
BSET
Ws,#bit4
Bit Set Ws
1
1
None
8
BSW
BSW.C
Ws,Wb
Write C bit to Ws<Wb>
1
1
None
BSW.Z
Ws,Wb
Write Z bit to Ws<Wb>
1
1
None
DS70138E-page 156
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-2:
Base
Instr
#
9
10
11
12
13
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Assembly
Mnemoni
c
BTG
BTSC
BTSS
BTST
BTSTS
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
# of
Words Cycles
Status Flags
Affected
BTG
f,#bit4
Bit Toggle f
1
1
None
BTG
Ws,#bit4
Bit Toggle Ws
1
1
None
BTSC
f,#bit4
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTSC
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Clear
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTSS
f,#bit4
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTSS
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws, Skip if Set
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
BTST
f,#bit4
Bit Test f
1
1
Z
BTST.C
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to C
1
1
C
BTST.Z
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to Z
1
1
Z
BTST.C
Ws,Wb
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to C
1
1
C
Z
BTST.Z
Ws,Wb
Bit Test Ws<Wb> to Z
1
1
BTSTS
f,#bit4
Bit Test then Set f
1
1
Z
BTSTS.C
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to C, then Set
1
1
C
BTSTS.Z
Ws,#bit4
Bit Test Ws to Z, then Set
1
1
Z
14
CALL
CALL
lit23
Call subroutine
2
2
None
CALL
Wn
Call indirect subroutine
1
2
None
15
CLR
CLR
f
f = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
WREG
WREG = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
Ws
Ws = 0x0000
1
1
None
CLR
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
Clear Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,SA,SB
16
CLRWDT
CLRWDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
1
1
WDTO,Sleep
17
COM
COM
f
f=f
1
1
N,Z
COM
f,WREG
WREG = f
1
1
N,Z
COM
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws
1
1
N,Z
CP
f
Compare f with WREG
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CP
Wb,#lit5
Compare Wb with lit5
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CP
Wb,Ws
Compare Wb with Ws (Wb - Ws)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CP0
f
Compare f with 0x0000
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CP0
Ws
Compare Ws with 0x0000
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CPB
f
Compare f with WREG, with Borrow
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CPB
Wb,#lit5
Compare Wb with lit5, with Borrow
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
CPB
Wb,Ws
Compare Wb with Ws, with Borrow
(Wb - Ws - C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
18
19
20
CP
CP0
CPB
21
CPSEQ
CPSEQ
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if =
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
22
CPSGT
CPSGT
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if >
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
23
CPSLT
CPSLT
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if <
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
24
CPSNE
CPSNE
Wb, Wn
Compare Wb with Wn, skip if ≠
1
1
(2 or 3)
None
25
DAW
DAW
Wn
Wn = decimal adjust Wn
1
1
C
26
DEC
DEC
f
f = f -1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
DEC
f,WREG
WREG = f -1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
DEC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws - 1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
DEC2
f
f = f -2
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
DEC2
f,WREG
WREG = f -2
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
27
28
DEC2
DISI
DEC2
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws - 2
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
DISI
#lit14
Disable Interrupts for k instruction cycles
1
1
None
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 157
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-2:
Base
Instr
#
29
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Assembly
Mnemoni
c
DIV
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
# of
Words Cycles
Status Flags
Affected
DIV.S
Wm,Wn
Signed 16/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N,Z,C,OV
DIV.SD
Wm,Wn
Signed 32/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N,Z,C,OV
DIV.U
Wm,Wn
Unsigned 16/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N,Z,C,OV
DIV.UD
Wm,Wn
Unsigned 32/16-bit Integer Divide
1
18
N,Z,C,OV
Signed 16/16-bit Fractional Divide
1
18
N,Z,C,OV
None
30
DIVF
DIVF
31
DO
DO
#lit14,Expr
Do code to PC+Expr, lit14+1 times
2
2
DO
Wn,Expr
Do code to PC+Expr, (Wn)+1 times
2
2
None
Wm,Wn
32
ED
ED
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
Euclidean Distance (no accumulate)
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
33
EDAC
EDAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd
Euclidean Distance
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
34
EXCH
EXCH
Wns,Wnd
Swap Wns with Wnd
1
1
None
35
FBCL
FBCL
Ws,Wnd
Find Bit Change from Left (MSb) Side
1
1
C
36
FF1L
FF1L
Ws,Wnd
Find First One from Left (MSb) Side
1
1
C
37
FF1R
FF1R
Ws,Wnd
Find First One from Right (LSb) Side
1
1
C
38
GOTO
GOTO
Expr
Go to address
2
2
None
GOTO
Wn
Go to indirect
1
2
None
INC
f
f=f+1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
INC
f,WREG
WREG = f + 1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
INC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
INC2
f
f=f+2
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
INC2
f,WREG
WREG = f + 2
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
39
40
41
42
INC
INC2
IOR
LAC
INC2
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 2
1
1
IOR
f
f = f .IOR. WREG
1
1
N,Z
IOR
f,WREG
WREG = f .IOR. WREG
1
1
N,Z
IOR
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .IOR. Wd
1
1
N,Z
IOR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .IOR. Ws
1
1
N,Z
IOR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .IOR. lit5
1
1
N,Z
LAC
Wso,#Slit4,Acc
Load Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
43
LNK
LNK
#lit14
Link frame pointer
1
1
None
44
LSR
LSR
f
f = Logical Right Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
LSR
f,WREG
WREG = Logical Right Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
LSR
Ws,Wd
Wd = Logical Right Shift Ws
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
LSR
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N,Z
LSR
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N,Z
MAC
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
,
AWB
Multiply and Accumulate
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
MAC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Square and Accumulate
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
MOV
f,Wn
Move f to Wn
1
1
None
MOV
f
Move f to f
1
1
N,Z
MOV
f,WREG
Move f to WREG
1
1
N,Z
MOV
#lit16,Wn
Move 16-bit literal to Wn
1
1
None
MOV.b
#lit8,Wn
Move 8-bit literal to Wn
1
1
None
MOV
Wn,f
Move Wn to f
1
1
None
MOV
Wso,Wdo
Move Ws to Wd
1
1
None
MOV
WREG,f
Move WREG to f
1
1
N,Z
Move Double from W(ns):W(ns+1) to Wd
1
2
None
45
46
MAC
MOV
MOV.D
MOV.D
47
MOVSAC
MOVSAC
DS70138E-page 158
Wns,Wd
Ws,Wnd
Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB
Move Double from Ws to W(nd+1):W(nd)
1
2
None
Prefetch and store accumulator
1
1
None
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-2:
Base
Instr
#
48
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Assembly
Mnemoni
c
MPY
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
# of
Words Cycles
Status Flags
Affected
MPY
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Multiply Wm by Wn to Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
MPY
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
Square Wm to Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
49
MPY.N
MPY.N
Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
-(Multiply Wm by Wn) to Accumulator
1
1
None
50
MSC
MSC
Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd
,
AWB
Multiply and Subtract from Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
51
MUL
MUL.SS
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * signed(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.SU
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.US
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) * signed(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.UU
Wb,Ws,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) *
unsigned(Ws)
1
1
None
MUL.SU
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = signed(Wb) * unsigned(lit5)
1
1
None
MUL.UU
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
{Wnd+1, Wnd} = unsigned(Wb) *
unsigned(lit5)
1
1
None
52
53
54
NEG
NOP
POP
MUL
f
W3:W2 = f * WREG
1
1
None
NEG
Acc
Negate Accumulator
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
NEG
f
f=f+1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
NEG
f,WREG
WREG = f + 1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
NEG
Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws + 1
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
NOP
No Operation
1
1
None
NOPR
No Operation
1
1
None
POP
f
Pop f from top-of-stack (TOS)
1
1
None
POP
Wdo
Pop from top-of-stack (TOS) to Wdo
1
1
None
POP.D
Wnd
Pop from top-of-stack (TOS) to
W(nd):W(nd+1)
1
2
None
Pop Shadow Registers
1
1
All
f
Push f to top-of-stack (TOS)
1
1
None
PUSH
Wso
Push Wso to top-of-stack (TOS)
1
1
None
PUSH.D
Wns
Push W(ns):W(ns+1) to top-of-stack (TOS)
1
2
None
Push Shadow Registers
1
1
None
WDTO,Sleep
POP.S
55
PUSH
PUSH
PUSH.S
56
PWRSAV
PWRSAV
Go into Sleep or Idle mode
1
1
57
RCALL
RCALL
Expr
Relative Call
1
2
None
RCALL
Wn
Computed Call
1
2
None
REPEAT
#lit14
Repeat Next Instruction lit14+1 times
1
1
None
REPEAT
Wn
Repeat Next Instruction (Wn)+1 times
1
1
None
None
58
REPEAT
#lit1
59
RESET
RESET
Software device Reset
1
1
60
RETFIE
RETFIE
Return from interrupt
1
3 (2)
None
61
RETLW
RETLW
#lit10,Wn
Return with literal in Wn
1
3 (2)
None
62
RETURN
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
1
3 (2)
None
63
RLC
RLC
f
f = Rotate Left through Carry f
1
1
C,N,Z
RLC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Left through Carry f
1
1
C,N,Z
RLC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Left through Carry Ws
1
1
C,N,Z
RLNC
f
f = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
1
1
N,Z
RLNC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Left (No Carry) f
1
1
N,Z
64
65
RLNC
RRC
RLNC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Left (No Carry) Ws
1
1
N,Z
RRC
f
f = Rotate Right through Carry f
1
1
C,N,Z
RRC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Right through Carry f
1
1
C,N,Z
RRC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Right through Carry Ws
1
1
C,N,Z
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 159
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 21-2:
Base
Instr
#
66
INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED)
Assembly
Mnemoni
c
RRNC
Assembly Syntax
Description
# of
# of
Words Cycles
Status Flags
Affected
RRNC
f
f = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
1
1
N,Z
RRNC
f,WREG
WREG = Rotate Right (No Carry) f
1
1
N,Z
RRNC
Ws,Wd
Wd = Rotate Right (No Carry) Ws
1
1
N,Z
67
SAC
SAC
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
Store Accumulator
1
1
None
SAC.R
Acc,#Slit4,Wdo
Store Rounded Accumulator
1
1
None
68
SE
SE
Ws,Wnd
Wnd = sign-extended Ws
1
1
C,N,Z
69
SETM
SETM
f
f = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SETM
WREG
WREG = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SETM
Ws
Ws = 0xFFFF
1
1
None
SFTAC
Acc,Wn
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by (Wn)
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SFTAC
Acc,#Slit6
Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by Slit6
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SL
f
f = Left Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
f,WREG
WREG = Left Shift f
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
Ws,Wd
Wd = Left Shift Ws
1
1
C,N,OV,Z
SL
Wb,Wns,Wnd
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by Wns
1
1
N,Z
SL
Wb,#lit5,Wnd
Wnd = Left Shift Wb by lit5
1
1
N,Z
SUB
Acc
Subtract Accumulators
1
1
OA,OB,OAB,
SA,SB,SAB
SUB
f
f = f - WREG
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUB
f,WREG
WREG = f - WREG
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUB
#lit10,Wn
Wn = Wn - lit10
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUB
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb - Ws
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUB
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb - lit5
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBB
f
f = f - WREG - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBB
f,WREG
WREG = f - WREG - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
70
71
72
73
74
75
SFTAC
SL
SUB
SUBB
SUBR
SUBBR
SUBB
#lit10,Wn
Wn = Wn - lit10 - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBB
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb - Ws - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBB
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb - lit5 - (C)
1
1
SUBR
f
f = WREG - f
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBR
f,WREG
WREG = WREG - f
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws - Wb
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = lit5 - Wb
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBBR
f
f = WREG - f - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBBR
f,WREG
WREG = WREG -f - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
C,DC,N,OV,Z
SUBBR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Ws - Wb - (C)
1
1
SUBBR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = lit5 - Wb - (C)
1
1
C,DC,N,OV,Z
Wn
Wn = nibble swap Wn
1
1
None
76
SWAP
SWAP.b
SWAP
Wn
Wn = byte swap Wn
1
1
None
77
TBLRDH
TBLRDH
Ws,Wd
Read Prog<23:16> to Wd<7:0>
1
2
None
78
TBLRDL
TBLRDL
Ws,Wd
Read Prog<15:0> to Wd
1
2
None
79
TBLWTH
TBLWTH
Ws,Wd
Write Ws<7:0> to Prog<23:16>
1
2
None
Ws,Wd
80
TBLWTL
TBLWTL
81
ULNK
ULNK
82
XOR
XOR
f
f = f .XOR. WREG
1
1
N,Z
XOR
f,WREG
WREG = f .XOR. WREG
1
1
N,Z
XOR
#lit10,Wn
Wd = lit10 .XOR. Wd
1
1
N,Z
XOR
Wb,Ws,Wd
Wd = Wb .XOR. Ws
1
1
N,Z
XOR
Wb,#lit5,Wd
Wd = Wb .XOR. lit5
1
1
N,Z
ZE
Ws,Wnd
Wnd = Zero-extend Ws
1
1
C,Z,N
83
ZE
DS70138E-page 160
Write Ws to Prog<15:0>
1
2
None
Unlink frame pointer
1
1
None
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
22.0
DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PIC® microcontrollers are supported with a full
range of hardware and software development tools:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
- MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Device Programmers
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
- PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer
• Low-Cost Demonstration and Development
Boards and Evaluation Kits
22.1
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit microcontroller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
operating system-based application that contains:
• A single graphical interface to all debugging tools
- Simulator
- Programmer (sold separately)
- Emulator (sold separately)
- In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color-coded context
• A multiple project manager
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
• High-level source code debugging
• Visual device initializer for easy register
initialization
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Drag and drop variables from source to watch
windows
• Extensive on-line help
• Integration of select third party tools, such as
HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR
C Compilers
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PIC MCU emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- Source files (assembly or C)
- Mixed assembly and C
- Machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost-effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility
and power.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 161
dsPIC30F3014/4013
22.2
MPASM Assembler
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PIC MCUs.
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose
source files
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
22.5
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
Command line interface
Rich directive set
Flexible macro language
MPLAB IDE compatibility
22.6
22.3
MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30
C Compilers
The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI C compilers for
Microchip’s PIC18 family of microcontrollers and the
dsPIC30, dsPIC33 and PIC24 family of digital signal
controllers. These compilers provide powerful integration capabilities, superior code optimization and ease
of use not found with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
22.4
MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects
from precompiled libraries, using directives from a
linker script.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be
logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace
buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of
the simulator to record and track program execution,
actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers.
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and
MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and
MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator
offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside
of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an
excellent, economical software development tool.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine are linked in with
the application. This allows large libraries to be used
efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
DS70138E-page 162
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
22.7
MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended
to provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for PIC microcontrollers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE 2000
In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment, which allows
editing, building, downloading and source debugging
from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator
system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitoring features. Interchangeable processor modules allow
the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of
different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB
ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to
support new PIC microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
22.8
MPLAB ICE 4000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended to
provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for high-end
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. Software control of the
MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is provided by the
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which
allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
22.9
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PIC
MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other
PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2 utilizes
the in-circuit debugging capability built into the Flash
devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s In-Circuit
Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol, offers costeffective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the graphical
user interface of the MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment. This enables a designer to develop and
debug source code by setting breakpoints, single stepping and watching variables, and CPU status and
peripheral registers. Running at full speed enables
testing hardware and applications in real time. MPLAB
ICD 2 also serves as a development programmer for
selected PIC devices.
22.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set
code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for
file storage and secure data applications.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 is a premium emulator system,
providing the features of MPLAB ICE 2000, but with
increased emulation memory and high-speed performance for dsPIC30F and PIC18XXXX devices. Its
advanced emulator features include complex triggering
and timing, and up to 2 Mb of emulation memory.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 163
dsPIC30F3014/4013
22.11 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
22.13 Demonstration, Development and
Evaluation Boards
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It
connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports
most PIC devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins.
Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and
PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket.
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE
compliant.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for
adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware
and source code for examination and modification.
22.12 PICkit 2 Development Programmer
The PICkit™ 2 Development Programmer is a low-cost
programmer with an easy-to-use interface for programming many of Microchip’s baseline, mid-range
and PIC18F families of Flash memory microcontrollers.
The PICkit 2 Starter Kit includes a prototyping development board, twelve sequential lessons, software and
HI-TECH’s PICC™ Lite C compiler, and is designed to
help get up to speed quickly using PIC® microcontrollers. The kit provides everything needed to
program, evaluate and develop applications using
Microchip’s powerful, mid-range Flash memory family
of microcontrollers.
DS70138E-page 164
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN,
IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL®
evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate
sensing, plus many more.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for
the complete list of demonstration, development and
evaluation kits.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
23.0
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
This section provides an overview of dsPIC30F electrical characteristics. Additional information will be provided in future
revisions of this document as it becomes available.
For detailed information about the dsPIC30F architecture and core, refer to “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual”
(DS70046).
Absolute maximum ratings for the dsPIC30F family are listed below. Exposure to these maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability. Functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above
the parameters indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied.
Absolute Maximum Ratings(†)
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD and MCLR) (Note 1) ..................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +5.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS ....................................................................................................... 0V to +13.25V
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin (Note 2)................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD) .......................................................................................................... ±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) ...................................................................................................±20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all ports .......................................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports (Note 2)....................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Voltage spikes below Vss at the MCLR/VPP pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up.
Thus, a series resistor of 50-100W should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR/VPP pin, rather
than pulling this pin directly to Vss.
2: Maximum allowable current is a function of device maximum power dissipation. See Table 23-4
†NOTICE:
Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
Note:
23.1
All peripheral electrical characteristics are specified. For exact peripherals available on specific
devices, please refer to the Family Cross Reference Table.
DC Characteristics
TABLE 23-1:
OPERATING MIPS VS. VOLTAGE
Max MIPS
VDD Range
Temp Range
dsPIC30FXXX-30I
dsPIC30FXXX-20E
30
—
4.5-5.5V
-40°C to 85°C
4.5-5.5V
-40°C to 125°C
—
20
3.0-3.6V
-40°C to 85°C
15
—
3.0-3.6V
-40°C to 125°C
—
10
2.5-3.0V
-40°C to 85°C
10
—
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 165
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-2:
THERMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS
Rating
Symbol
Min
Operating Junction Temperature Range
TJ
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
Typ
Max
Unit
-40
+125
°C
TA
-40
+85
°C
Operating Junction Temperature Range
TJ
-40
+150
°C
Operating Ambient Temperature Range
TA
-40
+125
°C
dsPIC30F3014-30I
dsPIC30F4013-30I
dsPIC30F3014-20E
dsPIC30F4013-20E
Power Dissipation:
Internal chip power dissipation:
P INT = V D D × ( I D D – ∑ I O H)
PD
PINT + PI/O
W
PDMAX
(TJ - TA) / θJA
W
I/O Pin power dissipation:
P I/O = ∑ ( { V D D – VO H } × I OH ) + ∑ ( V O L × I O L )
Maximum Allowed Power Dissipation
TABLE 23-3:
THERMAL PACKAGING CHARACTERISTICS
Characteristic
Symbol
θJA
θJA
θJA
Package Thermal Resistance, 40-pin DIP (P)
Package Thermal Resistance, 44-pin TQFP (10x10x1mm)
Package Thermal Resistance, 44-pin QFN
Note 1:
Max
Unit
Notes
47
°C/W
1
39.3
°C/W
1
27.8
°C/W
1
Junction to ambient thermal resistance, Theta-ja (θJA) numbers are achieved by package simulations.
TABLE 23-4:
DC TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Typ
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Voltage(2)
DC10
VDD
Supply Voltage
2.5
—
5.5
V
Industrial temperature
DC11
VDD
Supply Voltage
3.0
—
5.5
V
Extended temperature
DC12
VDR
RAM Data Retention Voltage(3)
—
1.5
—
V
DC16
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
—
VSS
—
V
DC17
SVDD
VDD Rise Rate
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
0.05
—
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
V/ms 0-5V in 0.1 sec
0-3V in 60 ms
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered without losing RAM data.
DS70138E-page 166
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-5:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: OPERATING CURRENT (IDD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(1)
DC31a
DC31b
2
2
4
4
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC31c
DC31e
2
4
4
6
mA
mA
125°C
25°C
DC31f
DC31g
4
4
6
6
mA
mA
85°C
125°C
DC30a
DC30b
6
6
11
11
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC30c
DC30e
7
11
11
16
mA
mA
125°C
25°C
DC30f
DC30g
11
11
16
16
mA
mA
85°C
125°C
DC23a
DC23b
13
13
20
20
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC23c
DC23e
14
22
20
31
mA
mA
125°C
25°C
DC23f
DC23g
22
22
31
31
mA
mA
85°C
125°C
DC24a
DC24b
27
28
39
39
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC24c
DC24e
28
46
39
64
mA
mA
125°C
25°C
DC24f
DC24g
46
46
64
64
mA
mA
85°C
125°C
DC27a
DC27b
52
51
72
72
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC27d
DC27e
86
85
120
120
mA
mA
25°C
85°C
DC27f
DC29a
85
123
120
170
mA
mA
125°C
25°C
DC29b
Note 1:
3.3V
0.128 MIPS
LPRC (512 kHz)
5V
3.3V
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
5V
3.3V
4 MIPS
5V
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
20 MIPS
5V
5V
30 MIPS
122
170
mA
85°C
The supply current is mainly a function of the operating voltage and frequency. Other factors such as I/O
pin loading and switching rate, oscillator type, internal code execution pattern and temperature also have
an impact on the current consumption. The test conditions for all IDD measurements are as follows: OSC1
driven with external square wave from rail-to-rail. All I/O pins are configured as Inputs and pulled to VDD.
MCLR = VDD, WDT, FSCM, LVD and BOR are disabled. CPU, SRAM, Program Memory and Data
Memory are operational. No peripheral modules are operating.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 167
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-6:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: IDLE CURRENT (IIDLE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical
Max
Units
Conditions
Operating Current (IDD)(1)
DC51a
1.4
3
mA
25°C
DC51b
1.5
3
mA
85°C
DC51c
1.5
3
mA
125°C
DC51e
3
5
mA
25°C
DC51f
3
5
mA
85°C
DC51g
3
5
mA
125°C
DC50a
4
6
mA
25°C
DC50b
4
6
mA
85°C
DC50c
4
6
mA
125°C
DC50e
8
11
mA
25°C
DC50f
8
11
mA
85°C
DC50g
8
11
mA
125°C
DC43a
7
11
mA
25°C
DC43b
7
11
mA
85°C
DC43c
8
11
mA
125°C
DC43e
13
17
mA
25°C
DC43f
13
17
mA
85°C
DC43g
13
17
mA
125°C
DC44a
16
22
mA
25°C
DC44b
16
22
mA
85°C
DC44c
17
22
mA
125°C
DC44e
27
36
mA
25°C
DC44f
27
36
mA
85°C
DC44g
28
36
mA
125°C
DC47a
30
40
mA
25°C
DC47b
31
40
mA
85°C
DC47d
50
65
mA
25°C
DC47e
51
65
mA
85°C
DC47f
52
65
mA
125°C
DC49a
74
95
mA
25°C
DC49b
75
95
mA
85°C
Note 1:
3.3V
0.128 MIPS
LPRC (512 kHz)
5V
3.3V
(1.8 MIPS)
FRC (7.37 MHz)
5V
3.3V
4 MIPS
5V
3.3V
10 MIPS
5V
3.3V
20 MIPS
5V
5V
30 MIPS
Base IIDLE current is measured with Core off, Clock on and all modules turned off.
DS70138E-page 168
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-7:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: POWER-DOWN CURRENT (IPD)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Parameter
No.
Typical
Max
Units
—
μA
Conditions
Power-Down Current (IPD)(1)
DC60a
1
25°C
DC60b
3
30
μA
85°C
DC60c
30
60
μA
125°C
DC60e
2
—
μA
25°C
DC60f
6
45
μA
85°C
DC60g
55
90
μA
125°C
DC61a
7
11
μA
25°C
DC61b
7
11
μA
85°C
DC61c
7
11
μA
125°C
DC61e
14
21
μA
25°C
DC61f
14
21
μA
85°C
DC61g
14
21
μA
125°C
DC62a
—
—
μA
25°C
DC62b
—
—
μA
85°C
DC62c
—
—
μA
125°C
DC62e
—
—
μA
25°C
DC62f
—
—
μA
85°C
DC62g
30
45
μA
125°C
DC63a
30
45
μA
25°C
DC63b
33
50
μA
85°C
DC63c
34
51
μA
125°C
DC63e
34
51
μA
25°C
DC63f
37
56
μA
85°C
DC63g
37
56
μA
125°C
DC66a
18
27
μA
25°C
DC66b
20
30
μA
85°C
DC66c
21
32
μA
125°C
DC66e
22
33
μA
25°C
DC66f
23
35
μA
85°C
24
36
μA
125°C
DC66g
Note 1:
2:
3.3V
Base Power-Down Current(2)
5V
3.3V
Watchdog Timer Current: ΔIWDT(2)
5V
3.3V
Timer1 w/32 kHz Crystal: ΔITI32(2)
5V
3.3V
BOR On: ΔIBOR(2)
5V
3.3V
Low-Voltage Detect: ΔILVD(2)
5V
Base IPD is measured with all peripherals and clocks shut down. All I/Os are configured as inputs and
pulled high. LVD, BOR, WDT, etc. are all switched off.
The Δ current is the additional current consumed when the module is enabled. This current should be
added to the base IPD current.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 169
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-8:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN INPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
VIL
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Input Low Voltage(2)
DI10
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI15
MCLR
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI16
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes)
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
DI17
OSC1 (in RC mode)(3)
VSS
—
0.3 VDD
V
DI18
SDA, SCL
VSS
—
0.3 VDD
V
SM bus disabled
DI19
SDA, SCL
VSS
—
0.2 VDD
V
SM bus enabled
I/O pins:
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI25
MCLR
0.8 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI26
OSC1 (in XT, HS and LP modes) 0.7 VDD
—
VDD
V
VIH
DI20
Input High Voltage
(2)
mode)(3)
DI27
OSC1 (in RC
0.9 VDD
—
VDD
V
DI28
SDA, SCL
0.7 VDD
—
VDD
V
SM bus disabled
SDA, SCL
VDD
—
VDD
V
SM bus enabled
50
250
400
μA
VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
DI29
0.8
Current(2)
ICNPU
CNXX Pull-up
IIL
Input Leakage Current(2)(4)(5)
DI30
DI50
I/O ports
—
0.01
±1
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
DI51
Analog input pins
—
0.50
—
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
DI55
MCLR
—
0.05
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
DI56
OSC1
—
0.05
±5
μA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD, XT, HS
and LP Osc mode
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKl pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that
the dsPIC30F device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
DS70138E-page 170
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-9:
DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN OUTPUT SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
VOL
DO10
Characteristic
VOH
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Output Low Voltage(2)
I/O ports
DO16
Min
—
—
0.6
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 5V
—
—
TBD
V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
OSC2/CLKO
—
—
0.6
V
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 5V
(RC or EC Osc mode)
—
—
TBD
V
IOL = 2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
(2)
Output High Voltage
DO20
I/O ports
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 5V
TBD
—
—
V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
DO26
OSC2/CLKO
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 5V
TBD
—
—
V
IOH = -2.0 mA, VDD = 3V
15
pF
In XTL, XT, HS and LP modes
when external clock is used to
drive OSC1.
(RC or EC Osc mode)
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins(2)
DO50
COSC2
OSC2/SOSC2 pin
—
—
DO56
CIO
All I/O pins and OSC2
—
—
50
pF
RC or EC Osc mode
DO58
CB
SCL, SDA
—
—
400
pF
In I2C mode
Note 1:
2:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
FIGURE 23-1:
LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
LV10
LVDIF
(LVDIF set by hardware)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 171
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-10: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: LVDL
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
LV10
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
VPLVD
LVDL Voltage on VDD transition high-to-low
Min
Typ
Max
Units
LVDL = 0000(2)
—
—
—
V
LVDL = 0001(2)
—
—
—
V
0010(2)
—
—
—
V
LVDL =
LVDL = 0011
LV15
Note 1:
2:
VLVDIN
External LVD input pin
threshold voltage
(2)
—
—
—
V
LVDL = 0100
2.50
—
2.65
V
LVDL = 0101
2.70
—
2.86
V
LVDL = 0110
2.80
—
2.97
V
LVDL = 0111
3.00
—
3.18
V
LVDL = 1000
3.30
—
3.50
V
LVDL = 1001
3.50
—
3.71
V
LVDL = 1010
3.60
—
3.82
V
LVDL = 1011
3.80
—
4.03
V
LVDL = 1100
4.00
—
4.24
V
LVDL = 1101
4.20
—
4.45
V
LVDL = 1110
4.50
—
4.77
V
LVDL = 1111
—
—
—
V
Conditions
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
These values not in usable operating range.
FIGURE 23-2:
BROWN-OUT RESET CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
BO10
(Device in Brown-out Reset)
BO15
(Device not in Brown-out Reset)
RESET (due to BOR)
Power-Up Time-out
DS70138E-page 172
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-11: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: BOR
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
BO10
Symbol
VBOR
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
BORV = 11(3)
—
—
—
V
BORV = 10
2.6
—
2.71
V
BORV = 01
4.1
—
4.4
V
BORV = 00
4.58
—
4.73
V
—
5
—
mV
Characteristic
BOR Voltage(2) on
VDD transition highto-low
Conditions
Not in operating
range
BO15
VBHYS
Note 1:
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
11 values not in usable operating range.
2:
3:
TABLE 23-12: DC CHARACTERISTICS: PROGRAM AND EEPROM
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
Data EEPROM Memory(2)
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
D120
ED
Byte Endurance
100K
1M
—
E/W
D121
VDRW
VDD for Read/Write
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D122
TDEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
ms
D123
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
100
—
Year
Provided no other specifications
are violated
D124
IDEW
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
Row Erase
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
Using EECON to read/write
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
(2)
Program Flash Memory
D130
EP
Cell Endurance
10K
100K
—
E/W
D131
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
—
5.5
V
D132
VEB
VDD for Bulk Erase
4.5
—
5.5
V
D133
VPEW
VDD for Erase/Write
3.0
—
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D134
TPEW
Erase/Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
ms
D135
TRETD
Characteristic Retention
40
100
—
Year
D136
TEB
ICSP™ Block Erase Time
—
4
—
ms
D137
IPEW
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
Row Erase
D138
IEB
IDD During Programming
—
10
30
mA
Bulk Erase
Note 1:
2:
Provided no other specifications
are violated
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 173
dsPIC30F3014/4013
23.2
AC Characteristics and Timing Parameters
The information contained in this section defines dsPIC30F AC characteristics and timing parameters.
TABLE 23-13: TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC Spec Section 23.0
“Electrical Characteristics”.
AC CHARACTERISTICS
FIGURE 23-3:
LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Load Condition 1 – for all pins except OSC2
Load Condition 2 – for OSC2
VDD/2
RL = 464 Ω
CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2
5 pF for OSC2 output
VSS
FIGURE 23-4:
VSS
Legend:
CL
Pin
CL
Pin
RL
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1
OS20
OS30
OS25
OS30
OS31
OS31
CLKO
OS40
DS70138E-page 174
OS41
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-14: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
OS10
FOSC
Characteristic
Min
Typ(1)
Max
Units
External CLKI Frequency(2)
(External clocks allowed only
in EC mode)
DC
4
4
4
—
—
—
—
40
10
10
7.5(3)
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
EC
EC with 4x PLL
EC with 8x PLL
EC with 16x PLL
DC
0.4
4
4
4
4
10
10
10
10
12(4)
12(4)
12(4)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
32.768
4
4
10
10
10
7.5(3)
25
20(4)
20(4)
15(3)
25
25
22.5(3)
—
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
kHz
RC
XTL
XT
XT with 4x PLL
XT with 8x PLL
XT with 16x PLL
HS
HS/2 with 4x PLL
HS/2 with 8x PLL
HS/2 with 16x PLL
HS/3 with 4x PLL
HS/3 with 8x PLL
HS/3 with 16x PLL
LP
—
—
—
—
See parameter OS10
for FOSC value
Oscillator Frequency(2)
Conditions
OS20
TOSC
TOSC = 1/FOSC
OS25
TCY
Instruction Cycle Time(2)(5)
33
—
DC
ns
See Table 23-16
OS30
TosL,
TosH
External Clock(2) in (OSC1)
High or Low Time
.45 x
TOSC
—
—
ns
EC
OS31
TosR,
TosF
External Clock(2) in (OSC1)
Rise or Fall Time
—
—
20
ns
EC
OS40
TckR
CLKO Rise Time(2)(6)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter D031
—
—
—
ns
See parameter D032
OS41
TckF
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
(2)(6)
CLKO Fall Time
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Limited by the PLL output frequency range.
Limited by the PLL input frequency range.
Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values
are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under standard operating conditions
with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator
operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “min.”
values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKI pin. When an external clock input is used, the
“Max.” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
Measurements are taken in EC or ERC modes. The CLKO signal is measured on the OSC2 pin. CLKO is
low for the Q1-Q2 period (1/2 TCY) and high for the Q3-Q4 period (1/2 TCY).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 175
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-15: PLL JITTER
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Characteristic
OS61
x4 PLL
x8 PLL
x16 PLL
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
—
0.251
0.413
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.251
0.413
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.256
0.47
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.256
0.47
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.355
0.584
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.355
0.584
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.362
0.664
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
0.362
0.664
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
VDD = 3.0 to 3.6V
—
0.67
0.92
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
—
0.632
0.956
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
%
-40°C ≤
≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5 to 5.5V
—
Note 1:
Typ(1)
0.632
0.956
TA
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
TABLE 23-16: INTERNAL CLOCK TIMING EXAMPLES
Clock
Oscillator
Mode
FOSC
(MHz)(1)
TCY (μsec)(2)
MIPS(3)
w/o PLL
MIPS(3)
w PLL x4
MIPS(3)
w PLL x8
MIPS(3)
w PLL x16
EC
0.200
20.0
0.05
—
—
—
XT
Note 1:
2:
3:
4
1.0
1.0
4.0
8.0
16.0
10
0.4
2.5
10.0
20.0
—
25
0.16
6.25
—
—
—
4
1.0
1.0
4.0
8.0
16.0
10
0.4
2.5
10.0
20.0
—
Assumption: Oscillator Postscaler is divide by 1.
Instruction Execution Cycle Time: TCY = 1 / MIPS.
Instruction Execution Frequency: MIPS = (FOSC * PLLx)/4 [since there are 4 Q clocks per instruction
cycle].
DS70138E-page 176
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-17: AC CHARACTERISTICS: INTERNAL RC ACCURACY
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Internal FRC Jitter @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz(1)
OS62
FRC
FRC with 4x PLL
FRC with 8x PLL
FRC with 16x PLL
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
+0.23
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
+0.62
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
+0.77
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
+0.87
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
+0.48
+1.08
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
+0.71
+1.23
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-5.5V
—
+0.04
+0.16
—
+0.07
—
+0.31
—
+0.34
—
+0.44
—
—
(1)
Internal FRC Accuracy @ FRC Freq. = 7.37 MHz
OS63
FRC
—
—
Internal FRC Drift @ FRC Freq. = 7.37
OS64
Note 1:
2:
+1.50
MHz(1)
-0.7
—
0.5
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
-0.7
—
0.7
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 3.0-3.6V
-0.7
—
0.5
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
-0.7
—
0.7
%
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
Frequency calibrated at 7.372 MHz ±2%, 25°C and 5V. TUN bits (OSCCON<3:0>) can be used to
compensate for temperature drift.
Overall FRC variation can be calculated by adding the absolute values of jitter, accuracy and drift
percentages.
TABLE 23-18: AC CHARACTERISTICS: INTERNAL RC JITTER
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
-35
—
+35
%
—
LPRC @ Freq. = 512 kHz(1)
OS65
Note 1:
Change of LPRC frequency as VDD changes.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 177
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-5:
CLKO AND I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
I/O Pin
(Input)
DI35
DI40
I/O Pin
(Output)
New Value
Old Value
DO31
DO32
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-19: CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)(2)(3)
Min
Typ(4)
Max
Units
Conditions
DO31
TIOR
Port output rise time
—
7
20
ns
—
DO32
TIOF
Port output fall time
—
7
20
ns
—
DI35
TINP
INTx pin high or low time (output)
20
—
—
ns
—
DI40
TRBP
CNx high or low time (input)
2 TCY
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges
Measurements are taken in RC mode and EC mode where CLKO output is 4 x TOSC.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70138E-page 178
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-6:
VDD
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND POWER-UP
TIMER TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SY12
MCLR
SY10
Internal
POR
SY11
PWRT
Time-out
OSC
Time-out
SY30
Internal
Reset
Watchdog
Timer
Reset
SY13
SY20
SY13
I/O Pins
SY35
FSCM
Delay
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 179
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-20: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SY10
TmcL
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
—
—
μs
-40°C to +85°C
SY11
TPWRT
Power-up Timer Period
3
12
50
4
16
64
6
22
90
ms
-40°C to +85°C
User programmable
SY12
TPOR
Power-On Reset Delay
3
10
30
μs
-40°C to +85°C
SY13
TIOZ
I/O High-impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
0.8
1.0
μs
SY20
TWDT1
Watchdog Timer Time-out Period
(No Prescaler)
1.4
2.1
2.8
ms
VDD = 5V, -40°C to +85°C
1.4
2.1
2.8
ms
VDD = 3V, -40°C to +85°C
VDD ≤ VBOR (D034)
TWDT2
Width(3)
SY25
TBOR
Brown-out Reset Pulse
100
—
—
μs
SY30
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
—
1024 TOSC
—
—
TOSC = OSC1 period
SY35
TFSCM
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Delay
—
500
900
μs
-40°C to +85°C
Note 1:
2:
3:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
Refer to Figure 23-2 and Table 23-11 for BOR.
FIGURE 23-7:
BAND GAP START-UP TIME CHARACTERISTICS
VBGAP
0V
Enable Band Gap
(see Note)
Band Gap
Stable
SY40
Note: Set LVDEN bit (RCON<12>) or FBORPOR<7>set.
TABLE 23-21: BAND GAP START-UP TIME REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
SY40
Note 1:
2:
Symbol
TBGAP
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
Band Gap Start-up Time
—
40
65
μs
Defined as the time between the
instant that the band gap is enabled
and the moment that the band gap
reference voltage is stable.
RCON<13>Status bit
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated.
DS70138E-page 180
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-8:
TYPE A, B AND C TIMER EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
TxCK
Tx11
Tx10
Tx15
Tx20
OS60
TMRX
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-22: TYPE A TIMER (TIMER1) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
TA10
TA11
TA15
Symbol
TTXH
TTXL
TTXP
Characteristic
TxCK High Time
TxCK Low Time
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TA15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Asynchronous
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Asynchronous
10
—
—
ns
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
—
—
—
Asynchronous
20
—
—
ns
DC
—
50
kHz
0.5 TCY
—
1.5
TCY
—
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
OS60
Ft1
TA20
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
Note:
SOSC1/T1CK oscillator input
frequency range (oscillator enabled
by setting bit TCS (T1CON, bit 1))
Must also meet
parameter TA15
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
Timer1 is a Type A.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 181
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-23: TYPE B TIMER (TIMER2 AND TIMER4) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
TB10
TB11
TB15
Symbol
TtxH
TtxL
TtxP
Characteristic
TxCK High Time
TxCK Low Time
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TB15
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Synchronous,
with prescaler
10
—
—
ns
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
—
1.5 TCY
—
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
Synchronous,
with prescaler
TB20
Note:
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
0.5 TCY
Must also meet
parameter TB15
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
Timer2 and Timer4 are Type B.
TABLE 23-24: TYPE C TIMER (TIMER3 AND TIMER5) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
TC10
TtxH
TxCK High Time
Synchronous
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TC11
TtxL
TxCK Low Time
Synchronous
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
ns
Must also meet
parameter TC15
TC15
TtxP
TxCK Input Period Synchronous,
no prescaler
TCY + 10
—
—
ns
N = prescale
value
(1, 8, 64, 256)
—
1.5
TCY
—
Synchronous,
with prescaler
TC20
Note:
TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock
Edge to Timer Increment
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
0.5 TCY
Timer3 and Timer5 are Type C.
DS70138E-page 182
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-9:
INPUT CAPTURE (CAPx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
ICX
IC10
IC11
IC15
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-25: INPUT CAPTURE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
IC10
TccL
ICx Input Low Time
IC11
TccH
ICx Input High Time
IC15
TccP
ICx Input Period
Characteristic(1)
No Prescaler
Min
Max
Units
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
With Prescaler
No Prescaler
10
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
10
—
ns
(2 TCY + 40)/N
—
ns
With Prescaler
Note 1:
Conditions
N = prescale
value (1, 4, 16)
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
FIGURE 23-10:
OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE (OCx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OCx
(Output Compare
or PWM Mode)
OC10
OC11
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-26: OUTPUT COMPARE MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OC10
TccF
OCx Output Fall Time
—
—
—
ns
See Parameter D032
OC11
TccR
OCx Output Rise Time
—
—
—
ns
See Parameter D031
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 183
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-11:
OC/PWM MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
OC20
OCFA/OCFB
OC15
OCx
TABLE 23-27: SIMPLE OC/PWM MODE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
OC15
TFD
Fault Input to PWM I/O
Change
—
—
50
ns
—
OC20
TFLT
Fault Input Pulse Width
50
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70138E-page 184
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-12:
DCI MODULE (MULTICHANNEL, I2S MODES) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
CSCK
(SCKE = 0)
CS11
CS10
CS21
CS20
CS20
CS21
CSCK
(SCKE = 1)
COFS
CS55 CS56
CS35
CS51
CSDO
HIGH-Z
70
CS50
LSb
MSb
CS30
CSDI
MSb IN
HIGH-Z
CS31
LSb IN
CS40 CS41
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 185
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-28: DCI MODULE (MULTICHANNEL, I2S MODES) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
CS10
Symbol
TcSCKL
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
TCY/2 + 20
—
—
ns
—
30
—
—
ns
—
TCY/2 + 20
—
—
ns
—
CSCK Output High Time(3)
(CSCK pin is an output)
30
—
—
ns
—
CSCK Input Low Time
(CSCK pin is an input)
CSCK Output Low Time(3)
(CSCK pin is an output)
CS11
TcSCKH
CSCK Input High Time
(CSCK pin is an input)
CS20
TcSCKF
CSCK Output Fall Time(4)
(CSCK pin is an output)
—
10
25
ns
—
CS21
TcSCKR
CSCK Output Rise Time(4)
(CSCK pin is an output)
—
10
25
ns
—
CS30
TcSDOF
CSDO Data Output Fall Time(4)
—
10
25
ns
—
Time(4)
CS31
TcSDOR
CSDO Data Output Rise
—
10
25
ns
—
CS35
TDV
Clock edge to CSDO data valid
—
—
10
ns
—
CS36
TDIV
Clock edge to CSDO tri-stated
10
—
20
ns
—
CS40
TCSDI
Setup time of CSDI data input to
CSCK edge (CSCK pin is input
or output)
20
—
—
ns
—
CS41
THCSDI
Hold time of CSDI data input to
CSCK edge (CSCK pin is input
or output)
20
—
—
ns
—
CS50
TcoFSF
COFS Fall Time
(COFS pin is output)
—
10
25
ns
Note 1
CS51
TcoFSR
COFS Rise Time
(COFS pin is output)
—
10
25
ns
Note 1
CS55
TscoFS
Setup time of COFS data input to
CSCK edge (COFS pin is input)
20
—
—
ns
—
CS56
THCOFS
Hold time of COFS data input to
CSCK edge (COFS pin is input)
20
—
—
ns
—
CS57
TPCSCK
CSCK clock period
100
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for CSCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all DCI pins.
DS70138E-page 186
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-13:
DCI MODULE (AC-LINK MODE) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
BIT_CLK
(CSCK)
CS61
CS60
CS62
CS21
CS20
CS71
CS70
CS72
SYNC
(COFS)
CS76
CS75
CS80
SDO
(CSDO)
LSb
MSb
LSb
CS76
SDI
(CSDI)
CS75
MSb IN
CS65 CS66
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 187
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-29: DCI MODULE (AC-LINK MODE) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)(2)
Min
Typ(3)
Max
Units
Conditions
CS60
TBCLKL
BIT_CLK Low Time
36
40.7
45
ns
—
CS61
TBCLKH
BIT_CLK High Time
36
40.7
45
ns
—
CS62
TBCLK
BIT_CLK Period
—
81.4
—
ns
CS65
TSACL
Input Setup Time to
Falling Edge of BIT_CLK
—
—
10
ns
—
CS66
THACL
Input Hold Time from
Falling Edge of BIT_CLK
—
—
10
ns
—
CS70
TSYNCLO
SYNC Data Output Low Time
—
19.5
—
μs
Note 1
CS71
TSYNCHI
SYNC Data Output High Time
—
1.3
—
μs
Note 1
CS72
TSYNC
SYNC Data Output Period
—
20.8
—
μs
Note 1
CS75
TRACL
Rise Time, SYNC,
SDATA_OUT
—
10
25
ns
CLOAD = 50 pF, VDD =
5V
CS76
TFACL
Fall Time, SYNC, SDATA_OUT
—
10
25
ns
CLOAD = 50 pF, VDD =
5V
CS77
TRACL
Rise Time, SYNC,
SDATA_OUT
—
TBD
TBD
ns
CLOAD = 50 pF, VDD =
3V
CS78
TFACL
Fall Time, SYNC, SDATA_OUT
—
TBD
TBD
ns
CLOAD = 50 pF, VDD =
3V
CS80
TOVDACL
Output valid delay from rising
edge of BIT_CLK
—
—
15
ns
Note 1:
2:
3:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
These values assume BIT_CLK frequency is 12.288 MHz.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70138E-page 188
Bit clock is input
—
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-14:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SCKx
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SP20
SP21
SCKx
(CKP = 1)
SP35
MSb
SDOx
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
SP31
SDIx
LSb
SP30
MSb IN
LSb IN
Bit 14 - - - -1
SP40 SP41
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-30: SPI MASTER MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP10
TscL
SCKX Output Low Time(3)
TCY/2
—
—
ns
—
SP11
TscH
SCKX Output High Time(3)
TCY/2
—
—
ns
—
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
Time(4
SP20
TscF
SCKX Output Fall
SP21
TscR
SCKX Output Rise Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP30
TdoF
SDOX Data Output Fall Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
SP31
TdoR
SDOX Data Output Rise
Time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP35
TscH2doV,
TscL2doV
SDOX Data Output Valid after
SCKX Edge
—
—
30
ns
—
SP40
TdiV2scH,
TdiV2scL
Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
to SCKX Edge
20
—
—
ns
—
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
to SCKX Edge
20
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 189
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-15:
SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE =1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP36
SCKX
(CKP = 0)
SP11
SP10
SP21
SP20
SP20
SP21
SCKX
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP40
SDIX
LSb
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
MSb
SDOX
SP30,SP31
MSb IN
Bit 14 - - - -1
LSb IN
SP41
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-31: SPI MODULE MASTER MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
SP10
Symbol
TscL
Characteristic(1)
SCKX output low time(3)
time(3)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
TCY/2
—
—
ns
—
SP11
TscH
SCKX output high
TCY/2
—
—
ns
—
SP20
TscF
SCKX output fall time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
SP21
TscR
SCKX output rise time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP30
TdoF
SDOX data output fall time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
SP31
TdoR
SDOX data output rise time(4)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP35
TscH2do,
TscL2doV
SDOX data output valid after
SCKX edge
—
—
30
ns
—
SP36
TdoV2sc, SDOX data output setup to
TdoV2scL first SCKX edge
30
—
—
ns
—
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup time of SDIX data input
TdiV2scL to SCKX edge
20
—
—
ns
—
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
20
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Hold time of SDIX data input
to SCKX edge
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
DS70138E-page 190
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-16:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SSX
SP52
SP50
SCKX
(CKP = 0)
SP71
SP70
SP73
SP72
SP72
SP73
SCKX
(CKP = 1)
SP35
MSb
SDOX
LSb
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
SP51
SP30,SP31
SDIX
MSb IN
Bit 14 - - - -1
SP41
LSb IN
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
SP40
TABLE 23-32: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
SP70
TscL
SCKX Input Low Time
30
—
—
ns
—
SP71
TscH
SCKX Input High Time
30
—
—
ns
—
SP72
TscF
SCKX Input Fall Time(3)
—
—
25
ns
—
SP73
TscR
SCKX Input Rise Time(3)
—
—
25
ns
—
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
Time(3)
SP30
TdoF
SDOX Data Output Fall
SP31
TdoR
SDOX Data Output Rise Time(3)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP35
TscH2do,
TscL2doV
SDOX Data Output Valid after
SCKX Edge
—
—
30
ns
—
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
TdiV2scL to SCKX Edge
20
—
—
ns
—
SP41
TscH2diL,
TscL2diL
20
—
—
ns
—
SP50
TssL2scH, SSX↓ to SCKX↑ or SCKX↓ Input
TssL2scL
120
—
—
ns
—
SP51
TssH2doZ
10
—
50
ns
—
SP52
TscH2ssH SSX after SCK Edge
TscL2ssH
1.5 TCY +40
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
3:
Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
to SCKX Edge
SSX↑ to SDOX Output
High-impedance(3)
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 191
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-17:
SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
SP60
SSX
SP52
SP50
SCKX
(CKP = 0)
SP71
SP70
SP73
SP72
SP72
SP73
SCKX
(CKP = 1)
SP35
SP52
MSb
SDOX
Bit 14 - - - - - -1
LSb
SP30,SP31
SDIX
MSb IN
Bit 14 - - - -1
SP51
LSb IN
SP41
SP40
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
DS70138E-page 192
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-33: SPI MODULE SLAVE MODE (CKE = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
SP70
SP71
SP72
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
TscL
SCKX Input Low Time
30
—
—
ns
—
TscH
SCKX
Input High Time
30
—
—
ns
—
—
—
25
ns
—
TscF
SCKX Input Fall Time
(3)
(3)
SP73
TscR
SCKX Input Rise Time
—
—
25
ns
—
SP30
TdoF
SDOX Data Output Fall Time(3)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D032
SP31
TdoR
SDOX Data Output Rise Time(3)
—
—
—
ns
See parameter
D031
SP35
TscH2do, SDOX Data Output Valid after
TscL2doV SCKX Edge
—
—
30
ns
—
SP40
TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDIX Data Input
TdiV2scL to SCKX Edge
20
—
—
ns
—
SP41
TscH2diL, Hold Time of SDIX Data Input
TscL2diL to SCKX Edge
20
—
—
ns
—
SP50
TssL2scH, SSX↓ to SCKX↓ or SCKX↑ input
TssL2scL
120
—
—
ns
—
SP51
TssH2doZ SS↑ to SDOX Output
High-impedance(4)
10
—
50
ns
—
SP52
TscH2ssH
TscL2ssH
1.5 TCY + 40
—
—
ns
—
SP60
TssL2doV SDOX Data Output Valid after
SCKX Edge
—
—
50
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
SSX↑ after SCKX Edge
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
The minimum clock period for SCK is 100 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not
violate this specification.
Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI pins.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 193
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-18:
I2C BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
SCL
IM31
IM34
IM30
IM33
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
FIGURE 23-19:
I2C BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE)
IM20
IM21
IM11
IM10
SCL
IM11
IM26
IM10
IM33
IM25
SDA
In
IM45
IM40
IM40
SDA
Out
Note: Refer to Figure 23-3 for load conditions.
TABLE 23-34: I2C BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Min(1)
Max
Units
Conditions
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
—
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
—
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
—
Clock High Time 100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
—
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
—
(2)
Characteristic
TLO:SCL Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode
IM10
IM11
THI:SCL
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
—
300
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
—
100
ns
1 MHz mode
IM20
TF:SCL
Note 1:
2:
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
—
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
BRG is the value of the I2C Baud Rate Generator. Refer to Section 21 “Inter-Integrated Circuit™ (I2C)”
in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
DS70138E-page 194
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-34: I2C BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE) (CONTINUED)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
IM21
TR:SCL
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
TSU:DAT Data Input
Setup Time
IM25
THD:DAT Data Input
Hold Time
IM26
TSU:STA
IM30
Start Condition
Setup Time
THD:STA Start Condition
Hold Time
IM31
TSU:STO Stop Condition
Setup Time
IM33
THD:STO Stop Condition
IM34
Hold Time
TAA:SCL
IM40
Output Valid
From Clock
TBF:SDA Bus Free Time
IM45
IM50
CB
Note 1:
2:
Min(1)
Max
Units
100 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
—
300
ns
100 kHz mode
250
—
ns
Characteristic
400 kHz mode
100
—
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
0
0.9
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
μs
Conditions
CB is specified to be
from 10 to 400 pF
—
—
Only relevant for
repeated Start
condition
After this period the
first clock pulse is
generated
—
100 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
400 kHz mode
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
1 MHz mode(2)
TCY/2 (BRG + 1)
—
ns
100 kHz mode
—
3500
ns
400 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
—
1 MHz mode(2)
—
—
ns
—
Time the bus must be
free before a new
transmission can start
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
μs
1 MHz mode(2)
TBD
—
μs
—
400
pF
Bus Capacitive Loading
—
—
BRG is the value of the I2C Baud Rate Generator. Refer to Section 21 “Inter-Integrated Circuit™ (I2C)”
in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046).
Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 195
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-20:
I2C BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
SCL
IS34
IS31
IS30
IS33
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
FIGURE 23-21:
I2C BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE)
IS20
IS21
IS11
IS10
SCL
IS30
IS26
IS31
IS25
IS33
SDA
In
IS40
IS40
IS45
SDA
Out
DS70138E-page 196
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-35: I2C BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
IS10
IS11
IS20
IS21
IS25
IS26
IS30
IS31
IS33
IS34
IS40
IS45
IS50
Note 1:
Symbol
TLO:SCL
THI:SCL
TF:SCL
TR:SCL
TSU:DAT
THD:DAT
TSU:STA
THD:STA
TSU:STO
THD:STO
TAA:SCL
TBF:SDA
CB
Characteristic
Clock Low Time
Clock High Time
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
Data Input
Setup Time
Min
Max
Units
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
0.5
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz.
—
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
μs
Device must operate at a
minimum of 10 MHz
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
0.5
—
—
300
μs
ns
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
20 + 0.1 CB
—
300
100
ns
ns
—
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
—
20 + 0.1 CB
1000
300
ns
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
—
250
300
—
ns
ns
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
100
100
—
—
ns
ns
Data Input
Hold Time
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
0
0
0.9
0.3
μs
μs
Start Condition
Setup Time
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
4.7
0.6
—
—
μs
μs
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
0.25
4.0
—
—
μs
μs
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
0.6
0.25
—
—
μs
μs
Stop Condition
Setup Time
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
4.7
0.6
—
—
μs
μs
Stop Condition
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
0.6
4000
—
—
μs
ns
Hold Time
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
600
250
—
ns
ns
Output Valid
From Clock
100 kHz mode
400 kHz mode
0
0
3500
1000
ns
ns
Bus Free Time
1 MHz mode(1)
100 kHz mode
0
4.7
350
—
ns
μs
400 kHz mode
1 MHz mode(1)
1.3
0.5
—
—
μs
μs
—
400
pF
Start Condition
Hold Time
Bus Capacitive
Loading
Conditions
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
—
—
Only relevant for repeated
Start condition
After this period the first
clock pulse is generated
—
—
—
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission
can start
—
Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins (for 1 MHz mode only).
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 197
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-22:
CXTX Pin
(output)
CAN MODULE I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
New Value
Old Value
CA10 CA11
CXRX Pin
(input)
CA20
TABLE 23-36: CAN MODULE I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
Characteristic(1)
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Units
Conditions
—
10
25
ns
—
CA10
TioF
Port Output Fall Time
CA11
TioR
Port Output Rise Time
—
10
25
ns
—
CA20
Tcwf
Pulse Width to Trigger
CAN Wake-up Filter
500
—
—
ns
—
Note 1:
2:
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and
are not tested.
DS70138E-page 198
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-37: 12-BIT A/D MODULE SPECIFICATIONS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Device Supply
AD01
AVDD
Module VDD Supply
Greater of
VDD - 0.3
or 2.7
—
Lesser of
VDD + 0.3
or 5.5
V
—
AD02
AVSS
Module VSS Supply
VSS - 0.3
—
VSS + 0.3
V
—
Reference Inputs
AD05
VREFH
Reference Voltage High
AVSS + 2.7
—
AVDD
V
—
AD06
VREFL
Reference Voltage Low
AVSS
—
AVDD - 2.7
V
—
AD07
VREF
Absolute Reference
Voltage
AVSS - 0.3
—
AVDD + 0.3
V
—
AD08
IREF
Current Drain
—
200
.001
300
2
μA
μA
A/D operating
A/D off
AD10
VINH-VINL
Full-Scale Input Span
VREFL
—
VREFH
V
See Note 1
AD11
VIN
Absolute Input Voltage
AVSS - 0.3
—
AVDD + 0.3
V
AD12
—
Leakage Current
—
±0.001
±0.610
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
Source Impedance =
2.5 kΩ
AD13
—
Leakage Current
—
±0.001
±0.610
μA
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
Source Impedance =
2.5 kΩ
AD15
RSS
Switch Resistance
—
3.2K
—
Ω
AD16
CSAMPLE
Sample Capacitor
—
18
AD17
RIN
Recommended Impedance
of Analog Voltage Source
—
—
AD20
Nr
Resolution
AD21
INL
Integral Nonlinearity
—
—
<±1
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD21A INL
Integral Nonlinearity
—
—
<±1
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD22
DNL
Differential Nonlinearity
—
—
<±1
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD22A DNL
Differential Nonlinearity
—
—
<±1
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD23
GERR
Gain Error
+1.25
+1.5
+3
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD23A GERR
Gain Error
+1.25
+1.5
+3
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
Analog Input
2.5K
—
—
pF
—
Ω
—
DC Accuracy
Note 1:
12 data bits
bits
The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage, and has no missing
codes.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 199
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-37: 12-BIT A/D MODULE SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED)
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.5V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
AD24
Symbol
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
EOFF
Offset Error
-2
-1.5
-1.25
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 5V
AD24A EOFF
Offset Error
-2
-1.5
-1.25
LSb
VINL = AVSS = VREFL =
0V, AVDD = VREFH = 3V
AD25
—
Monotonicity(1)
—
—
—
—
AD30
THD
Total Harmonic Distortion
—
-71
—
dB
—
AD31
SINAD
Signal to Noise and
Distortion
—
68
—
dB
—
AD32
SFDR
Spurious Free Dynamic
Range
—
83
—
dB
—
AD33
FNYQ
Input Signal Bandwidth
—
—
100
kHz
—
AD34
ENOB
Effective Number of Bits
10.95
11.1
—
bits
—
Guaranteed
Dynamic Performance
Note 1:
The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage, and has no missing
codes.
DS70138E-page 200
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
FIGURE 23-23:
12-BIT A/D CONVERSION TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
(ASAM = 0, SSRC = 000)
AD50
ADCLK
Instruction
Execution
Set SAMP
Clear SAMP
SAMP
ch0_dischrg
ch0_samp
eoc
AD61
AD60
TSAMP
AD55
DONE
ADIF
ADRES(0)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1 - Software sets ADCON. SAMP to start sampling.
2 - Sampling starts after discharge period.
TSAMP is described in the “dsPIC30F Family Reference Manual” (DS70046, Section 18).
3 - Software clears ADCON. SAMP to start conversion.
4 - Sampling ends, conversion sequence starts.
5 - Convert bit 11.
6 - Convert bit 10.
7 - Convert bit 1.
8 - Convert bit 0.
9 - One TAD for end of conversion.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 201
dsPIC30F3014/4013
TABLE 23-38: 12-BIT A/D CONVERSION TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions: 2.7V to 5.5V
(unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for Industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for Extended
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min.
Typ
Max.
Units
Conditions
Clock Parameters
AD50
TAD
A/D Clock Period
AD51
tRC
A/D Internal RC Oscillator Period
—
334
—
ns
VDD = 3-5.5V (Note 1)
1.2
1.5
1.8
μs
—
Conversion Rate
AD55
tCONV
Conversion Time
—
14 TAD
AD56
FCNV
Throughput Rate
—
200
—
ksps
ns
AD57
TSAMP
Sampling Time
—
1 TAD
—
ns
AD60
tPCS
Conversion Start from Sample
Trigger
AD61
tPSS
AD62
AD63
—
VDD = VREF = 5V
VDD = 3-5.5V source
resistance
RS = 0-2.5 kΩ
Timing Parameters
Note 1:
2:
—
1 TAD
—
ns
—
Sample Start from Setting
Sample (SAMP) Bit
0.5 TAD
—
1.5
TAD
ns
—
tCSS
Conversion Completion to
Sample Start (ASAM = 1)
—
0.5 TAD
—
ns
—
tDPU
Time to Stabilize Analog Stage
from A/D Off to A/D On
—
20
—
μs
—
Because the sample caps will eventually lose charge, clock rates below 10 kHz can affect linearity
performance, especially at elevated temperatures.
These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.
DS70138E-page 202
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
24.0
PACKAGING INFORMATION
24.1
Package Marking Information
40-Lead PDIP
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
0710017
Example
44-Lead TQFP
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
44-Lead QFN
dsPIC
30F4013
-301/PT e3
0710017
Example
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
Legend: XX...X
Y
YY
WW
NNN
e3
*
Note:
dsPIC30F4013
-30I/P e3
dsPIC
30F4013
-30I/ML e3
0710017
Customer-specific information
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator ( e3 )
can be found on the outer packaging for this package.
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 203
dsPIC30F3014/4013
40-Lead Plastic Dual In-Line (P) – 600 mil Body [PDIP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
N
NOTE 1
E1
1 2 3
D
E
A2
A
L
c
b1
A1
b
e
eB
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
INCHES
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
40
Pitch
e
Top to Seating Plane
A
–
–
.250
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.125
–
.195
Base to Seating Plane
A1
.015
–
–
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
E
.590
–
.625
Molded Package Width
E1
.485
–
.580
Overall Length
D
1.980
–
2.095
Tip to Seating Plane
L
.115
–
.200
Lead Thickness
c
.008
–
.015
b1
.030
–
.070
b
.014
–
.023
eB
–
–
Upper Lead Width
Lower Lead Width
Overall Row Spacing §
.100 BSC
.700
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. § Significant Characteristic.
3. Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010" per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-016B
DS70138E-page 204
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
44-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) – 10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
D1
E
e
E1
N
b
NOTE 1
1 2 3
NOTE 2
α
A
c
φ
β
L
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Leads
A2
L1
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
44
Lead Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
–
0.80 BSC
–
Molded Package Thickness
A2
0.95
1.00
1.05
Standoff
A1
0.05
–
0.15
Foot Length
L
0.45
0.60
0.75
Footprint
L1
1.20
1.00 REF
Foot Angle
φ
Overall Width
E
12.00 BSC
Overall Length
D
12.00 BSC
Molded Package Width
E1
10.00 BSC
Molded Package Length
D1
10.00 BSC
0°
3.5°
7°
Lead Thickness
c
0.09
–
0.20
Lead Width
b
0.30
0.37
0.45
Mold Draft Angle Top
α
11°
12°
13°
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
β
11°
12°
13°
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Chamfers at corners are optional; size may vary.
3. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.25 mm per side.
4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-076B
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 205
dsPIC30F3014/4013
44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) – 8x8 mm Body [QFN]
Note:
For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at
http://www.microchip.com/packaging
D
D2
EXPOSED
PAD
e
E
E2
b
2
2
1
N
1
N
NOTE 1
TOP VIEW
K
L
BOTTOM VIEW
A
A3
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
Number of Pins
MILLIMETERS
MIN
N
NOM
MAX
44
Pitch
e
Overall Height
A
0.80
0.65 BSC
0.90
1.00
Standoff
A1
0.00
0.02
0.05
Contact Thickness
A3
0.20 REF
Overall Width
E
Exposed Pad Width
E2
Overall Length
D
Exposed Pad Length
D2
6.30
6.45
6.80
b
0.25
0.30
0.38
Contact Length
L
0.30
0.40
0.50
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
K
0.20
–
–
Contact Width
8.00 BSC
6.30
6.45
6.80
8.00 BSC
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Package is saw singulated.
3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
Microchip Technology Drawing C04-103B
DS70138E-page 206
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
APPENDIX A:
REVISION HISTORY
Revision D (June 2006)
Previous versions of this data sheet contained
Advance or Preliminary Information. They were distributed with incomplete characterization data.
This revision reflects these changes:
• Revised I2C Slave Addresses
(see Table 14-1)
• Updated example for ADC Conversion Clock
selection (see Section 19.0 “12-bit Analog-toDigital Converter (ADC) Module”)
• Base instruction CP1 eliminated from instruction
set (seeTable 21-2 )
• Revised electrical characteristics:
- Operating Current (IDD) Specifications
(see Table 23-5)
- Idle Current (IIDLE) Specifications
(see Table 23-6)
- Power-down Current (IPD) Specifications
(see Table 23-7)
- I/O pin Input Specifications
(see Table 23-8)
- Brown Out Reset (BOR) Specifications
(see Table 23-11)
- Watchdog Timer time-out limits
(see Table 23-20)
Revision E (January 2007)
This revision includes updates to the packaging
diagrams.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 207
dsPIC30F3014/4013
NOTES:
DS70138E-page 208
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
INDEX
Numerics
12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Module ............. 125
A
A/D .................................................................................... 125
Aborting a Conversion .............................................. 127
ADCHS Register ....................................................... 125
ADCON1 Register..................................................... 125
ADCON2 Register..................................................... 125
ADCON3 Register..................................................... 125
ADCSSL Register ..................................................... 125
ADPCFG Register..................................................... 125
Configuring Analog Port Pins.............................. 52, 132
Connection Considerations....................................... 132
Conversion Operation ............................................... 126
Effects of a Reset...................................................... 131
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................. 131
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode.......................... 131
Output Formats ......................................................... 131
Power-down Modes .................................................. 131
Programming the Sample Trigger............................. 127
Register Map............................................................. 133
Result Buffer ............................................................. 126
Sampling Requirements............................................ 130
Selecting the Conversion Sequence......................... 126
AC Characteristics ............................................................ 174
Load Conditions ........................................................ 174
AC Temperature and Voltage Specifications .................... 174
AC-Link Mode Operation .................................................. 122
16-bit Mode ............................................................... 122
20-bit Mode ............................................................... 123
ADC
Selecting the Conversion Clock ................................ 127
ADC Conversion Speeds .................................................. 128
Address Generator Units .................................................... 35
Alternate Vector Table ........................................................ 59
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See A/D.
Assembler
MPASM Assembler................................................... 162
Automatic Clock Stretch...................................................... 88
During 10-bit Addressing (STREN = 1)....................... 88
During 7-bit Addressing (STREN = 1)......................... 88
Receive Mode ............................................................. 88
Transmit Mode ............................................................ 88
B
Bandgap Start-up Time
Requirements............................................................ 180
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 180
Barrel Shifter ....................................................................... 21
Bit-Reversed Addressing .................................................... 38
Example ...................................................................... 38
Implementation ........................................................... 38
Modifier Values Table ................................................. 39
Sequence Table (16-Entry)......................................... 39
Block Diagrams
12-bit A/D Functional ................................................ 125
16-bit Timer1 Module .................................................. 63
16-bit Timer2............................................................... 69
16-bit Timer3............................................................... 69
16-bit Timer4............................................................... 74
16-bit Timer5............................................................... 74
32-bit Timer2/3............................................................ 68
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
32-bit Timer4/5 ........................................................... 73
CAN Buffers and Protocol Engine ............................ 106
DCI Module............................................................... 116
Dedicated Port Structure ............................................ 51
DSP Engine ................................................................ 18
dsPIC30F3014.............................................................. 9
dsPIC30F4013............................................................ 10
External Power-on Reset Circuit .............................. 147
I2C .............................................................................. 86
Input Capture Mode.................................................... 77
Oscillator System...................................................... 137
Output Compare Mode ............................................... 81
Reset System ........................................................... 145
Shared Port Structure................................................. 52
SPI.............................................................................. 94
SPI Master/Slave Connection..................................... 94
UART Receiver........................................................... 98
UART Transmitter....................................................... 97
BOR Characteristics ......................................................... 173
BOR. See Brown-out Reset.
Brown-out Reset
Characteristics.......................................................... 172
Timing Requirements ............................................... 180
C
C Compilers
MPLAB C18.............................................................. 162
MPLAB C30.............................................................. 162
CAN Module ..................................................................... 105
Baud Rate Setting .................................................... 110
CAN1 Register Map.................................................. 112
Frame Types ............................................................ 105
I/O Timing Characteristics ........................................ 198
I/O Timing Requirements.......................................... 198
Message Reception.................................................. 108
Message Transmission............................................. 109
Modes of Operation .................................................. 107
Overview................................................................... 105
CLKO and I/O Timing
Characteristics.......................................................... 178
Requirements ........................................................... 178
Code Examples
Data EEPROM Block Erase ....................................... 48
Data EEPROM Block Write ........................................ 50
Data EEPROM Read.................................................. 47
Data EEPROM Word Erase ....................................... 48
Data EEPROM Word Write ........................................ 49
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ........................... 43
Initiating a Programming Sequence ........................... 44
Loading Write Latches ................................................ 44
Code Protection ................................................................ 135
Control Registers ................................................................ 42
NVMADR .................................................................... 42
NVMADRU ................................................................. 42
NVMCON.................................................................... 42
NVMKEY .................................................................... 42
Core Architecture
Overview..................................................................... 13
CPU Architecture Overview ................................................ 13
Customer Change Notification Service............................. 215
Customer Notification Service .......................................... 215
Customer Support............................................................. 215
DS70138E-page 209
dsPIC30F3014/4013
D
Data Accumulators and Adder/Subtracter........................... 19
Data Accumulators and Adder/Subtractor
Data Space Write Saturation ...................................... 21
Overflow and Saturation ............................................. 19
Round Logic ................................................................ 20
Write-Back .................................................................. 20
Data Address Space ........................................................... 28
Alignment .................................................................... 31
Alignment (Figure) ...................................................... 31
Effect of Invalid Memory Accesses (Table)................. 31
MCU and DSP (MAC Class) Instructions Example..... 30
Memory Map ......................................................... 28, 29
Near Data Space ........................................................ 32
Software Stack ............................................................ 32
Spaces ........................................................................ 31
Width ........................................................................... 31
Data Converter Interface (DCI) Module ............................ 115
Data EEPROM Memory ...................................................... 47
Erasing ........................................................................ 48
Erasing, Block ............................................................. 48
Erasing, Word ............................................................. 48
Protection Against Spurious Write .............................. 50
Reading....................................................................... 47
Write Verify ................................................................. 50
Writing ......................................................................... 49
Writing, Block .............................................................. 49
Writing, Word .............................................................. 49
DC Characteristics ............................................................ 165
BOR .......................................................................... 173
Brown-out Reset ....................................................... 172
I/O Pin Input Specifications ....................................... 171
I/O Pin Output Specifications .................................... 171
Idle Current (IIDLE) .................................................... 168
Low-Voltage Detect................................................... 171
LVDL ......................................................................... 172
Operating Current (IDD)............................................. 167
Power-Down Current (IPD) ........................................ 169
Program and EEPROM............................................. 173
Temperature and Voltage Specifications .................. 165
DCI Module
Bit Clock Generator................................................... 119
Buffer Alignment with Data Frames .......................... 121
Buffer Control ............................................................ 115
Buffer Data Alignment ............................................... 115
Buffer Length Control ................................................ 121
COFS Pin .................................................................. 115
CSCK Pin .................................................................. 115
CSDI Pin ................................................................... 115
CSDO Mode Bit ........................................................ 122
CSDO Pin ................................................................. 115
Data Justification Control Bit ..................................... 120
Device Frequencies for Common Codec
CSCK Frequencies (Table)............................... 119
Digital Loopback Mode ............................................. 122
Enable ....................................................................... 117
Frame Sync Generator ............................................. 117
Frame Sync Mode Control Bits ................................. 117
I/O Pins ..................................................................... 115
Interrupts ................................................................... 122
Introduction ............................................................... 115
Master Frame Sync Operation .................................. 117
Operation .................................................................. 117
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................. 122
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode .......................... 122
DS70138E-page 210
Receive Slot Enable Bits .......................................... 120
Receive Status Bits................................................... 121
Register Map ............................................................ 124
Sample Clock Edge Control Bit ................................ 120
Slave Frame Sync Operation.................................... 118
Slot Enable Bits Operation with Frame Sync............ 120
Slot Status Bits ......................................................... 122
Synchronous Data Transfers .................................... 120
Timing Characteristics
AC-Link Mode................................................... 187
Multichannel, I2S Modes................................... 185
Timing Requirements
AC-Link Mode................................................... 188
Multichannel, I2S Modes................................... 185
Transmit Slot Enable Bits ......................................... 120
Transmit Status Bits.................................................. 121
Transmit/Receive Shift Register ............................... 115
Underflow Mode Control Bit...................................... 122
Word Size Selection Bits .......................................... 117
Development Support ....................................................... 161
Device Configuration
Register Map ............................................................ 152
Device Configuration Registers
FBORPOR ................................................................ 150
FGS .......................................................................... 150
FOSC........................................................................ 150
FWDT ....................................................................... 150
Device Overview................................................................... 9
Disabling the UART ............................................................ 99
Divide Support .................................................................... 16
Instructions (Table) ..................................................... 16
DSP Engine ........................................................................ 17
Multiplier ..................................................................... 19
Dual Output Compare Match Mode .................................... 82
Continuous Pulse Mode.............................................. 82
Single Pulse Mode...................................................... 82
E
Electrical Characteristics .................................................. 165
AC............................................................................. 174
DC ............................................................................ 165
Enabling and Setting Up UART
Alternate I/O ............................................................... 99
Setting Up Data, Parity and Stop Bit Selections ......... 99
Enabling the UART ............................................................. 99
Equations
ADC Conversion Clock ............................................. 127
Baud Rate................................................................. 101
Bit Clock Frequency.................................................. 119
COFSG Period.......................................................... 117
Serial Clock Rate ........................................................ 90
Time Quantum for Clock Generation ........................ 111
Errata .................................................................................... 7
Exception Sequence
Trap Sources .............................................................. 58
External Clock Timing Characteristics
Type A, B and C Timer ............................................. 181
External Clock Timing Requirements ............................... 175
Type A Timer ............................................................ 181
Type B Timer ............................................................ 182
Type C Timer ............................................................ 182
External Interrupt Requests ................................................ 60
F
Fast Context Saving ........................................................... 60
Flash Program Memory ...................................................... 41
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
I
I/O Pin Specifications
Input .......................................................................... 171
Output ....................................................................... 171
I/O Ports .............................................................................. 51
Parallel (PIO) .............................................................. 51
I2C 10-bit Slave Mode Operation ........................................ 87
Reception.................................................................... 88
Transmission............................................................... 87
I2C 7-bit Slave Mode Operation .......................................... 87
Reception.................................................................... 87
Transmission............................................................... 87
I2C Master Mode Operation ................................................ 89
Baud Rate Generator.................................................. 90
Clock Arbitration.......................................................... 90
Multi-Master Communication, Bus Collision and
Bus Arbitration .................................................... 90
Reception.................................................................... 90
Transmission............................................................... 89
I2C Master Mode Support ................................................... 89
I2C Module .......................................................................... 85
Addresses ................................................................... 87
Bus Data Timing Characteristics
Master Mode ..................................................... 194
Slave Mode ....................................................... 196
Bus Data Timing Requirements
Master Mode ..................................................... 194
Slave Mode ....................................................... 197
Bus Start/Stop Bits Timing Characteristics
Master Mode ..................................................... 194
Slave Mode ....................................................... 196
General Call Address Support .................................... 89
Interrupts..................................................................... 89
IPMI Support ............................................................... 89
Operating Function Description .................................. 85
Operation During CPU Sleep and Idle Modes ............ 90
Pin Configuration ........................................................ 85
Programmer’s Model................................................... 85
Register Map............................................................... 91
Registers..................................................................... 85
Slope Control .............................................................. 89
Software Controlled Clock Stretching (STREN = 1).... 88
Various Modes ............................................................ 85
I2S Mode Operation .......................................................... 123
Data Justification....................................................... 123
Frame and Data Word Length Selection................... 123
Idle Current (IIDLE) ............................................................ 168
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ......................... 41, 135
Input Capture (CAPX) Timing Characteristics .................. 183
Input Capture Module ......................................................... 77
Interrupts..................................................................... 78
Register Map............................................................... 79
Input Capture Operation During Sleep and Idle Modes ...... 78
CPU Idle Mode............................................................ 78
CPU Sleep Mode ........................................................ 78
Input Capture Timing Requirements ................................. 183
Input Change Notification Module ....................................... 54
dsPIC30F3014 Register Map (Bits 15-8) .................... 54
dsPIC30F3014 Register Map (Bits 7-0) ...................... 54
dsPIC30F4013 Register Map (Bits 15-8) .................... 54
dsPIC30F4013 Register Map (Bits 7-0) ...................... 54
Instruction Addressing Modes............................................. 35
File Register Instructions ............................................ 35
Fundamental Modes Supported.................................. 35
MAC Instructions......................................................... 36
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
MCU Instructions ........................................................ 35
Move and Accumulator Instructions ........................... 36
Other Instructions ....................................................... 36
Instruction Set
Overview................................................................... 156
Summary .................................................................. 153
Internal Clock Timing Examples ....................................... 176
Internet Address ............................................................... 215
Interrupt Controller
Register Map .............................................................. 62
Interrupt Priority .................................................................. 56
Traps .......................................................................... 58
Interrupt Sequence ............................................................. 59
Interrupt Stack Frame................................................. 59
Interrupts ............................................................................ 55
L
Load Conditions................................................................ 174
Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) ................................................ 149
Low-Voltage Detect Characteristics.................................. 171
LVDL Characteristics ........................................................ 172
M
Memory Organization ......................................................... 23
Core Register Map ..................................................... 32
Microchip Internet Web Site.............................................. 215
Modes of Operation
Disable...................................................................... 107
Initialization............................................................... 107
Listen All Messages.................................................. 107
Listen Only................................................................ 107
Loopback .................................................................. 107
Normal Operation ..................................................... 107
Modulo Addressing ............................................................. 36
Applicability................................................................. 38
Incrementing Buffer Operation Example .................... 37
Start and End Address ............................................... 37
W Address Register Selection.................................... 37
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian ................... 162
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger ................................... 163
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator.................................................... 163
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator.................................................... 163
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment Software.. 161
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer .................................... 163
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ................ 162
N
NVM
Register Map .............................................................. 45
O
OC/PWM Module Timing Characteristics ......................... 184
Operating Current (IDD) .................................................... 167
Operating Frequency vs Voltage
dsPIC30FXXXX-20 (Extended) ................................ 165
Oscillator
Configurations .......................................................... 138
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor .................................... 140
Fast RC (FRC).................................................. 139
Initial Clock Source Selection ........................... 138
Low-Power RC (LPRC) .................................... 139
LP Oscillator Control......................................... 139
Phase Locked Loop (PLL) ................................ 139
Start-up Timer (OST)........................................ 138
DS70138E-page 211
dsPIC30F3014/4013
Control Registers ...................................................... 141
Operating Modes (Table) .......................................... 136
System Overview ...................................................... 135
Oscillator Selection ........................................................... 135
Oscillator Start-up Timer
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 179
Timing Requirements ................................................ 180
Output Compare Interrupts ................................................. 83
Output Compare Module..................................................... 81
Register Map dsPIC30F3014...................................... 84
Register Map dsPIC30F4013...................................... 84
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 183
Timing Requirements ................................................ 183
Output Compare Operation During CPU Idle Mode............ 83
Output Compare Sleep Mode Operation............................. 83
P
Packaging Information ...................................................... 203
Marking ..................................................................... 203
Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) Registers .................... 151
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer ..................... 164
Pinout Descriptions ............................................................. 11
POR. See Power-on Reset.
Port Register Map for dsPIC30F3014/4013 ........................ 53
Port Write/Read Example.................................................... 52
Power Saving Modes
Sleep and Idle ........................................................... 135
Power-Down Current (IPD) ................................................ 169
Power-Saving Modes ........................................................ 149
Idle ............................................................................ 150
Sleep ......................................................................... 149
Power-up Timer
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 179
Timing Requirements ................................................ 180
Program Address Space ..................................................... 23
Construction ................................................................ 24
Data Access from Program Memory Using
Program Space Visibility ..................................... 26
Data Access From Program Memory Using
Table Instructions................................................ 25
Data Access from, Address Generation...................... 24
Data Space Window into Operation ............................ 27
Data Table Access (lsw) ............................................. 25
Data Table Access (MS Byte) ..................................... 26
Memory Map ............................................................... 23
Table Instructions
TBLRDH.............................................................. 25
TBLRDL .............................................................. 25
TBLWTH ............................................................. 25
TBLWTL.............................................................. 25
Program and EEPROM Characteristics ............................ 173
Program Counter................................................................. 14
Programmable................................................................... 135
Programmer’s Model........................................................... 14
Diagram ...................................................................... 15
Programming Operations .................................................... 43
Algorithm for Program Flash ....................................... 43
Erasing a Row of Program Memory ............................ 43
Initiating the Programming Sequence ......................... 44
Loading Write Latches ................................................ 44
Protection Against Accidental Writes to OSCCON ........... 140
DS70138E-page 212
R
Reader Response............................................................. 216
Reset ........................................................................ 135, 145
BOR, Programmable ................................................ 147
Brown-out Reset (BOR)............................................ 135
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ................................ 135
POR
Operating without FSCM and PWRT................ 147
With Long Crystal Start-up Time ...................... 147
POR (Power-on Reset)............................................. 145
Power-on Reset (POR)............................................. 135
Power-up Timer (PWRT) .......................................... 135
Reset Sequence ................................................................. 57
Reset Sources ............................................................ 57
Reset Sources
Brown-out Reset (BOR).............................................. 57
Illegal Instruction Trap ................................................ 57
Trap Lockout............................................................... 57
Uninitialized W Register Trap ..................................... 57
Watchdog Time-out .................................................... 57
Reset Timing Characteristics............................................ 179
Reset Timing Requirements ............................................. 180
Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP) ................................. 41
S
Simple Capture Event Mode............................................... 77
Buffer Operation ......................................................... 78
Hall Sensor Mode ....................................................... 78
Prescaler .................................................................... 77
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode............................ 78
Simple OC/PWM Mode Timing Requirements ................. 184
Simple Output Compare Match Mode ................................ 82
Simple PWM Mode ............................................................. 82
Input Pin Fault Protection ........................................... 82
Period ......................................................................... 83
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM) .................................... 162
Software Stack Pointer, Frame Pointer .............................. 14
CALL Stack Frame ..................................................... 32
SPI Module ......................................................................... 93
Framed SPI Support ................................................... 93
Operating Function Description .................................. 93
Operation During CPU Idle Mode ............................... 95
Operation During CPU Sleep Mode............................ 95
SDOx Disable ............................................................. 93
Slave Select Synchronization ..................................... 95
SPI1 Register Map...................................................... 96
Timing Characteristics
Master Mode (CKE = 0).................................... 189
Master Mode (CKE = 1).................................... 190
Slave Mode (CKE = 1).............................. 191, 192
Timing Requirements
Master Mode (CKE = 0).................................... 189
Master Mode (CKE = 1).................................... 190
Slave Mode (CKE = 0)...................................... 191
Slave Mode (CKE = 1)...................................... 193
Word and Byte Communication .................................. 93
Status Bits, Their Significance and the Initialization
Condition for RCON Register, Case 1 ...................... 148
Status Bits, Their Significance and the Initialization
Condition for RCON Register, Case 2 ...................... 148
Status Register ................................................................... 14
Symbols Used in Opcode Descriptions ............................ 154
System Integration............................................................ 135
Register Map ............................................................ 152
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
T
Table Instruction Operation Summary ................................ 41
Temperature and Voltage Specifications
AC ............................................................................. 174
DC............................................................................. 165
Timer1 Module .................................................................... 63
16-bit Asynchronous Counter Mode ........................... 63
16-bit Synchronous Counter Mode ............................. 63
16-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 63
Gate Operation ........................................................... 64
Interrupt....................................................................... 64
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 64
Prescaler..................................................................... 64
Real-Time Clock ......................................................... 64
Interrupts............................................................. 65
Oscillator Operation ............................................ 65
Register Map............................................................... 66
Timer2 and Timer3 Selection Mode .................................... 81
Timer2/3 Module ................................................................. 67
16-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 67
32-bit Synchronous Counter Mode ............................. 67
32-bit Timer Mode....................................................... 67
ADC Event Trigger...................................................... 70
Gate Operation ........................................................... 70
Interrupt....................................................................... 70
Operation During Sleep Mode .................................... 70
Register Map............................................................... 71
Timer Prescaler........................................................... 70
Timer4/5 Module ................................................................. 73
Register Map............................................................... 75
Timing Characteristics
A/D Conversion
Low-speed (ASAM = 0, SSRC = 000) .............. 201
Bandgap Start-up Time............................................. 180
CAN Module I/O........................................................ 198
CLKO and I/O ........................................................... 178
DCI Module
AC-Link Mode ................................................... 187
Multichannel, I2S Modes ................................... 185
External Clock........................................................... 174
I2C Bus Data
Master Mode ..................................................... 194
Slave Mode ....................................................... 196
I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits
Master Mode ..................................................... 194
Slave Mode ....................................................... 196
Input Capture (CAPX) ............................................... 183
OC/PWM Module ...................................................... 184
Oscillator Start-up Timer ........................................... 179
Output Compare Module........................................... 183
Power-up Timer ........................................................ 179
Reset......................................................................... 179
SPI Module
Master Mode (CKE = 0) .................................... 189
Master Mode (CKE = 1) .................................... 190
Slave Mode (CKE = 0) ...................................... 191
Slave Mode (CKE = 1) ...................................... 192
Type A, B and C Timer External Clock ..................... 181
Watchdog Timer........................................................ 179
Timing Diagrams
CAN Bit ..................................................................... 110
Frame Sync, AC-Link Start-of-Frame ....................... 118
Frame Sync, Multichannel Mode .............................. 118
I2S Interface Frame Sync.......................................... 118
PWM Output ............................................................... 83
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR
Not Tied to VDD), Case 1.................................. 146
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR
Not Tied to VDD), Case 2.................................. 146
Time-out Sequence on Power-up (MCLR Tied
to VDD).............................................................. 146
Timing Diagrams and Specifications
DC Characteristics - Internal RC Accuracy .............. 176
Timing Diagrams.See Timing Characteristics
Timing Requirements
A/D Conversion
Low-speed ........................................................ 202
Bandgap Start-up Time ............................................ 180
Brown-out Reset....................................................... 180
CAN Module I/O ....................................................... 198
CLKO and I/O ........................................................... 178
DCI Module
AC-Link Mode................................................... 188
Multichannel, I2S Modes................................... 185
External Clock .......................................................... 175
I2C Bus Data (Master Mode) .................................... 194
I2C Bus Data (Slave Mode) ...................................... 197
Input Capture............................................................ 183
Oscillator Start-up Timer........................................... 180
Output Compare Module .......................................... 183
Power-up Timer ........................................................ 180
Reset ........................................................................ 180
Simple OC/PWM Mode ............................................ 184
SPI Module
Master Mode (CKE = 0).................................... 189
Master Mode (CKE = 1).................................... 190
Slave Mode (CKE = 0)...................................... 191
Slave Mode (CKE = 1)...................................... 193
Type A Timer External Clock .................................... 181
Type B Timer External Clock .................................... 182
Type C Timer External Clock.................................... 182
Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 180
Trap Vectors ....................................................................... 59
U
UART Module
Address Detect Mode ............................................... 101
Auto Baud Support ................................................... 102
Baud Rate Generator ............................................... 101
Enabling and Setting Up............................................. 99
Framing Error (FERR) .............................................. 101
Idle Status................................................................. 101
Loopback Mode ........................................................ 101
Operation During CPU Sleep and Idle Modes.......... 102
Overview..................................................................... 97
Parity Error (PERR) .................................................. 101
Receive Break .......................................................... 101
Receive Buffer (UxRXB)........................................... 100
Receive Buffer Overrun Error (OERR Bit) ................ 100
Receive Interrupt ...................................................... 100
Receiving Data ......................................................... 100
Receiving in 8-bit or 9-bit Data Mode ....................... 100
Reception Error Handling ......................................... 100
Transmit Break ......................................................... 100
Transmit Buffer (UxTXB) ............................................ 99
Transmit Interrupt ..................................................... 100
Transmitting Data ....................................................... 99
Transmitting in 8-Bit Data Mode ................................. 99
Transmitting in 9-bit Data Mode ................................. 99
UART1 Register Map ............................................... 103
UART2 Register Map ............................................... 103
DS70138E-page 213
dsPIC30F3014/4013
UART Operation
Idle Mode .................................................................. 102
Sleep Mode ............................................................... 102
Unit ID Locations............................................................... 135
Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter
(UART) Module ........................................................... 97
W
Wake-up from Sleep ......................................................... 135
Wake-up from Sleep and Idle.............................................. 60
Watchdog Timer
Timing Characteristics .............................................. 179
Timing Requirements ................................................ 180
Watchdog Timer (WDT) ............................................ 135, 149
Enabling and Disabling ............................................. 149
Operation .................................................................. 149
WWW Address.................................................................. 215
WWW, On-Line Support........................................................ 7
DS70138E-page 214
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following
information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata,
application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of
Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory
representatives
•
•
•
•
•
Distributor or Representative
Local Sales Office
Field Application Engineer (FAE)
Technical Support
Development Systems Information Line
Customers
should
contact
their
distributor,
representative or field application engineer (FAE) for
support. Local sales offices are also available to help
customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is
included in the back of this document.
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://support.microchip.com
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a
specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change
Notification and follow the registration instructions.
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 215
dsPIC30F3014/4013
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
RE:
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
From: Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
Device: dsPIC30F3014/4013
N
Literature Number: DS70138E
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS70138E-page 216
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
dsPIC30F3014/4013
PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
d s P I C 3 0 F 4 0 1 3 AT - 3 0 I / P T- E S
Custom ID (3 digits) or
Engineering Sample (ES)
Trademark
Architecture
Package
P = 40-pin PDIP
PT = 44-pin TQFP (10x10)
ML = 44-pin QFN (8x8)
S = Die (Waffle Pack)
W = Die (Wafers)
Flash
Memory Size in Bytes
0 = ROMless
1 = 1K to 6K
2 = 7K to 12K
3 = 13K to 24K
4 = 25K to 48K
5 = 49K to 96K
6 = 97K to 192K
7 = 193K to 384K
8 = 385K to 768K
9 = 769K and Up
Temperature
I = Industrial -40°C to +85°C
E = Extended High Temp -40°C to +125°C
Device ID
Speed
20 = 20 MIPS
30 = 30 MIPS
T = Tape and Reel
A,B,C… = Revision Level
Example:
dsPIC30F4013AT-30I/PT = 30 MIPS, Industrial temp., TQFP package, Rev. A
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.
DS70138E-page 217
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
ASIA/PACIFIC
ASIA/PACIFIC
EUROPE
Corporate Office
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://support.microchip.com
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
Asia Pacific Office
Suites 3707-14, 37th Floor
Tower 6, The Gateway
Habour City, Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-4182-8400
Fax: 91-80-4182-8422
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-4160-8631
Fax: 91-11-4160-8632
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-39
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
Fax: 45-4485-2829
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-2566-1512
Fax: 91-20-2566-1513
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Japan - Yokohama
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166
Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Atlanta
Duluth, GA
Tel: 678-957-9614
Fax: 678-957-1455
Boston
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
Detroit
Farmington Hills, MI
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
Kokomo
Kokomo, IN
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
Los Angeles
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
Santa Clara
Santa Clara, CA
Tel: 408-961-6444
Fax: 408-961-6445
Toronto
Mississauga, Ontario,
Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8528-2100
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8665-5511
Fax: 86-28-8665-7889
Korea - Gumi
Tel: 82-54-473-4301
Fax: 82-54-473-4302
China - Fuzhou
Tel: 86-591-8750-3506
Fax: 86-591-8750-3521
Korea - Seoul
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-646-8870
Fax: 60-4-646-5086
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-572-9526
Fax: 886-3-572-6459
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8203-2660
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
China - Shunde
Tel: 86-757-2839-5507
Fax: 86-757-2839-5571
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2500-6610
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7250
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
12/08/06
DS70138E-page 218
© 2007 Microchip Technology Inc.